BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
1. Field of the Invention
[0001] The present invention relates generally to the fields of blood vessels and tumor
biology. More particularly, it embodies the surprising findings that aminophospholipids,
such as phosphatidylserine and phosphatidylethanolamine, are accessible, stable and
specific markers of tumor vasculature. The invention thus provides therapeutic constructs
and conjugates that bind to aminophospholipids for use in delivering toxins and coagulants
to tumor blood vessels and for inducing thrombosis and tumor regression.
2. Description of the Related Art
[0002] Tumor cell resistance to chemotherapeutic agents represents a significant problem
in clinical oncology. In fact, this is one of the main reasons why many of the most
prevalent forms of human cancer still resist effective chemotherapeutic intervention,
despite certain advances in the field of chemotherapy.
[0003] A significant problem to address in tumor treatment regimens is the desire for a
"total cell kill". This means that the more effective treatment regimens come closer
to a total cell kill of all so-called "clonogenic" malignant cells,
i.e., cells that have the ability to grow uncontrolled and replace any tumor mass that
might be removed by the therapy. Due to the goal of developing treatments that approach
a total cell kill, certain types of tumors have been more amenable to therapy than
others. For example, the soft tissue tumors,
e.g., lymphomas, and tumors of the blood and blood-forming organs,
e.g., leukemias, have generally been more responsive to chemotherapeutic therapy than
have solid tumors, such as carcinomas.
[0004] One reason for the susceptibility of soft and blood-based tumors to chemotherapy
is the greater accessibility of lymphoma and leukemic cells to chemotherapeutic intervention.
Simply put, it is much more difficult for most chemotherapeutic agents to reach all
of the cells of a solid tumor mass than it is the soft tumors and blood-based tumors,
and therefore much more difficult to achieve a total cell kill. Increasing the dose
of chemotherapeutic agents most often results in toxic side effects, which generally
limits the effectiveness of conventional anti-tumor agents.
[0005] Another tumor treatment strategy is the use of an "immunotoxin", in which an anti-tumor
cell antibody is used to deliver a toxin to the tumor cells. However, in common with
the chemotherapeutic approaches described above, immunotoxin therapy also suffers
from significant drawbacks. For example, antigen-negative or antigen-deficient cells
can survive and repopulate the tumor or lead to further metastases. Also, in the treatment
of solid tumors, the tumor mass is generally impermeable to molecules of the size
of antibodies and immunotoxins. Both the physical diffusion distances and the interstitial
pressure within the tumor are significant limitations to this type of therapy.
[0006] A more recent strategy has been to target the vasculature of solid tumors. Targeting
the blood vessels of the tumors, rather than the tumor cells themselves, has certain
advantages in that it is not likely to lead to the development of resistant tumor
cells, and that the targeted cells are readily accessible. Moreover, destruction of
the blood vessels leads to an amplification of the anti-tumor effect, as many tumor
cells rely on a single vessel for their oxygen and nutrients (Denekamp, 1990). Exemplary
vascular targeting strategies are described in U.S. Patents Nos. 5,855,866 and 5,965,132,
which particularly describe the targeted delivery of anti-cellular agents and toxins
to protein markers of tumor vasculature.
[0007] Another effective version of the vascular targeting approach is to target a coagulation
factor to a protein marker expressed or adsorbed within the tumor vasculature (Huang
et al., 1997; U.S. Patents 5,877,289, 6,004,555 and 6,093,399). The delivery of coagulants,
rather than toxins, to tumor vasculature has the further advantages of reduced immunogenicity
and even lower risk of toxic side effects. As disclosed in U.S. Patent 5,877,289,
a preferred coagulation factor for use in such tumor-specific thrombogens, or "coaguligands",
is a truncated version of the human coagulation-inducing protein, Tissue Factor (TF).
TF is the major initiator of blood coagulation (Ruf
et al., 1991; Edgington
et al., 1991; Ruf and Edgington, 1994). Treatment of tumor-bearing mice with such coaguligands
results in significant tumor necrosis and even complete tumor regression in many animals
(Huang
et al., 1997; U.S. Patents 5,877,289, 6,004,555 and 6,093,399).
[0008] Although the specific delivery of therapeutic agents, such as anti-cellular agents,
toxins and coagulation factors, to protein markers of tumor vessels represents a significant
advance in tumor treatment protocols, there is still room for additional vascular
targeting therapies. The identification of additional stable targets to allow specific
tumor vessel destruction
in vivo would naturally be of benefit in expanding the number of targeting options. More
particularly, the development of targeting agents for delivering therapeutics even
closer to the tumor vascular endothelial cell membrane would represent an important
advance.
SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
[0009] The present invention addresses the needs of the prior art by providing new compositions
for use in methods for tumor vasculature imaging and destruction. The invention is
based, in part, on the finding that aminophospholipid membrane components, such as
phosphatidylserine and phosphatidylethanolamine, are accessible, stable markers of
tumor vasculature. The invention thus provides binding ligands and antibodies against
aminophospholipids that are operatively attached to therapeutic agents, and constructs
for use in the specific delivery of diagnostics and therapeutics to the actual surface
of tumor vascular endothelial cell membranes.
[0010] According to the present invention there is provided a binding ligand comprising
a targeting agent that binds to an aminophospholipid operatively attached to a therapeutic
agent; wherein the targeting agent is not an antiphosphatidylserine antibody obtained
from a patient with an antiphospholipid autoimmune disease that is conjugated to a
cytotoxic agent.
[0011] Important aspects of the invention are that therapeutic agents can be delivered in
intimate contact with the tumor vascular endothelial cell membrane, allowing either
rapid entry into the target cell or rapid association with effector cells, components
of the coagulation cascade, and such like. Certain surprising features of the invention
include the discovery that translocation of aminophospholipids, such as phosphatidylserine
(PS), to the surface of tumor vascular endothelial cells occurs, at least in a significant
part, independently of cell damage and apoptopic or other cell-death mechanisms. Thus,
PS surface expression in this environment is not a consequence of cell death, nor
does it trigger immediate cell destruction.
[0012] The discovery of sufficiently stable PS expression on morphologically intact tumor-associated
vascular endothelial cells is important to the targeting nature of the present invention.
Should PS translocation to the outer surface of tumor vascular endothelium occur only
in dying cells, or should it inevitably trigger cell death then PS expression would
be expected to be transient and PS would not likely be a good candidate target for
therapeutic intervention. Surprisingly, the person invention shows that significant
stable PS expression occurs in viable endothelial cells in a tumor environment, thus
providing ample targeting opportunities.
[0013] The present invention therefore basically provides compositions for use in methods
for delivering selected diagnostic and therapeutic agents to tumor or intratumoral
vasculature, comprising administering to an animal having a vascularized tumor a biologically
effective amount of a binding ligand that comprises a selected diagnostic or therapeutic
agent operatively attached to a targeting agent that binds to an aminophospholipid,
preferably one that binds to phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylethanolamine, on the
luminal surface of blood vessels or intratumoral blood vessels of the vascularized
tumor.
[0014] The methods provide for killing, or specifically killing, tumor or intratumoral vascular
endothelial cells, and comprise administering to an animal or patient having a vascularized
tumor a biologically effective amount of at least a first pharmaceutical composition
comprising a binding ligand that comprises a selected therapeutic agent operatively
attached to a targeting agent that binds to an aminophospholipid, preferably one that
binds to phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylethanolamine, on the luminal surface of
tumor or intratumoral vascular endothelial cells.
[0015] The "binding ligands" of the present invention are thus "aminophospholipid binding
ligands", "therapeutic aminophospholipid binding ligand constructs", "aminophospholipid-targeted
therapeutic agents", "aminophospholipid-targeted therapeutics", "aminophospholipid-targeted
therapeutic agent constructs", or "therapeutic agent-aminophospholipid targeting agent
constructs". For simplicity, these agents are referred to herein as "binding ligands"
or "therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs", with the understanding that such
terms are used as a succinct way of referring to a conjugate or other operative association
of a selected therapeutic agent and a targeting agent, antibody, binding protein or
active fragment thereof, that binds to an aminophospholipid, preferably phosphatidylserine
or phosphatidylethanolamine, expressed on the luminal surface of tumor or intratumoral
vascular endothelial cells.
[0016] "Biologically effective amounts" are amounts of the therapeutic agent-targeting agent
construct effective to specifically kill at least a portion, and preferably a significant
portion, of the tumor or intratumoral vascular endothelial cells, as opposed to endothelial
cells in normal vessels, upon binding to an aminophospholipid, preferably phosphatidylserine
or phosphatidylethanolamine, expressed on the luminal surface of the tumor or intratumoral
vascular endothelial cells. As such, it is an "endothelial cell killing amount" or
a "tumor vascular endothelial cell killing amount" of a therapeutic agent-targeting
agent construct.
[0017] As used throughout the entire application, the terms "a" and "an" are used in the
sense that they mean "at least one", "at least a first", "one or more" or "a plurality"
of the referenced components or steps, except in instances wherein an upper limit
is thereafter specifically stated. Therefore a "therapeutic agent-targeting agent
construct" means "at least a first therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct". The
operable limits and parameters of combinations, as with the amounts of any single
agent, will be known to those of ordinary skill in the art in light of the present
disclosure.
[0018] The "a" and "an" terms are also used to mean "at least one", "at least a first",
"one or more" or "a plurality" of steps in the recited methods, except where specifically
stated. This is particularly relevant to the administration steps in the treatment
methods. Thus, not only may different doses be employed with the present invention,
but different numbers of doses, e.g., injections, may be used, up to and including
multiple injections.
[0019] An "aminophospholipid", as used herein, means a phospholipid that includes within
its structure at least a first primary amino group. Preferably, the term "aminophospholipid"
is used to refer to a primary amino group-containing phospholipid that occurs naturally
in mammalian cell membranes. However, this is not a limitation on the meaning of the
term "aminophospholipid", as this term also extends to non-naturally occurring or
synthetic aminophospholipids that nonetheless have uses in the invention,
e.g., as an immunogen in the generation of anti-aminophospholipid antibodies ("cross-reactive
antibodies") that do bind to aminophospholipids of mammalian plasma membranes. The
aminophospholipids of U.S. Patent No. 5,767,298, are appropriate examples.
[0020] The prominent aminophospholipids found in mammalian biological systems are the negatively-charged
phosphatidylserine ("PS") and the neutral or zwitterionic phosphatidylethanolamine
("PE"), which are therefore preferred aminophospholipids for targeting by the present
invention. However, the invention is by no means limited to the targeting of phosphatidylserines
and phosphatidylethanolamines, and any other aminophospholipid target may be employed
(White
et al., 1978; incorporated herein by reference) so long as it is expressed, accessible or
complexed on the luminal surface of tumor vascular endothelial cells.
[0021] All aminophospholipid-, phosphatidylserine- and phosphatidylethanolamine-based components
are encompassed as targets of the invention irrespective of the type of fatty acid
chains involved, including those with short, intermediate or long chain fatty acids,
and those with saturated, unsaturated and polyunsaturated fatty acids. Preferred compositions
for raising antibodies for use in the present invention may be aminophospholipids
with fatty acids of C18, with C18:1 being more preferred (Levy
et al., 1990; incorporated herein by reference). To the extent that they are accessible
on tumor vascular endothelial cells, aminophospholipid degradation products having
only one fatty acid (lyso derivatives), rather than two, may also be targeted (Qamar
et al., 1990; incorporated herein by reference).
[0022] Another group of potential aminophospholipid targets include, for example, phosphatidal
derivatives (plasmalogens), such as phosphatidalserine and phosphatidalethanolamine
(having an ether linkage giving an alkenyl group, rather than an ester linkage giving
an acyl group). Indeed, the targets for therapeutic intervention by the present invention
include any substantially lipid-based component that comprises a nitrogenous base
and that is present, expressed, translocated presented or otherwise complexed in a
targetable form on the luminal surface of tumor vascular endothelial cells, not excluding
phosphatidylclloline ("PC"). Lipids not containing glycerol may also form appropriate
targets, such as the sphingolipids based upon sphingosine and derivatives.
[0023] The biological basis for including a range of lipids in the group of targetable components
lies, in part, with the observed biological phenomena of lipids and proteins combining
in membranous environments to form unique lipid-protein complexes. Such lipid-protein
complexes extend to antigenic and immunogenic forms of lipids such as phosphatidylserine,
phosphatidylethanolamine and phosphatidylcholine with,
e.g., proteins such as β
2-glycoprotein I, prothrombin, kininogens and prekallikrein. Therefore, as proteins
and polypeptides can have one or more free primary amino groups, it is contemplated
that a range of effective "aminophospholipid targets" may be formed
in vivo from lipid components that are not aminophospholipids in the strictest sense. Nonetheless,
all such targetable complexes that comprise lipids and primary amino groups constitute
an "aminophospholipid" within the scope of the present invention.
[0024] The disclosed methods also act to arrest blood flow, or specifically arrest blood
flow, in tumor vasculature. This is achieved by administering to an animal or patient
having a vascularized tumor at least one dose of at least a first pharmaceutical composition
comprising a coagulation-inducing amount, or a vessel-occluding amount, of at least
a first cytotoxic or coagulative agent operatively attached to a targeting agent that
binds to an aminophospholipid, preferably phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylethanolamine,
translocated to the luminal surface of tumor vasculature.
[0025] The "coagulation-inducing amount" or "vessel-occluding amount" is an amount of the
therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct effective to specifically promote coagulation
in, and hence occlude, at least a portion, and preferably a significant portion, of
tumor or intratumoral blood vessels, as opposed to normal blood vessels, upon binding
to an aminophospholipid, preferably phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylethanolamine,
translocated to the luminal surface of tumor or intratumoral blood vessels. The "vessel-occluding
amount" is therefore a functionally effective amount, and is not a physical mass of
therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct sufficient to span the breadth of a vessel.
[0026] Methods for destroying, or specifically destroying, tumor vasculature are provided
that comprise administering to an animal or patient having a vascularized tumor one
or more doses of at least a first pharmaceutical composition comprising a tumor-destructive
amount of at least a first occluding or destructive agent operatively attached to
a targeting agent that binds to an aminophospholipid, preferably phosphatidylserine
or phosphatidylethanolamine, presented on the luminal surface of tumor or intratumoral
vasculature. The "tumor-destructive amount" is an amount of the therapeutic agent-targeting
agent construct effective to specifically destroy or occlude at least a portion, and
preferably a significant portion, of tumor or intratumoral blood vessels, as opposed
to normal blood vessels, upon binding to an aminophospholipid, preferably phosphatidylserine
or phosphatidylethanolamine, presented on the luminal surface of the vascular endothelial
cells of the tumor or intratumoral blood vessels.
[0027] The invention further encompasses compositions for use in methods for treating cancer
and solid tumors, comprising administering to an animal or patient having a vascularized
tumor a tumor necrosis-inducing amount or amounts of at least a first pharmaceutical
composition comprising at least a first therapeutic or necrotic agent operatively
attached to a targeting agent that binds to an aminophospholipid, preferably phosphatidylserine
or phosphatidylethanolamine, on the luminal surface of blood vessels or intratumoral
blood vessels of the vascularized tumor. The "tumor necrosis-inducing amount" is an
amount of the therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct effective to specifically
induce hemorrhagic necrosis in at least a portion, and preferably a significant portion,
of the tumor upon binding to an aminophospholipid, preferably phosphatidylserine or
phosphatidylethanolamine, complexed at the luminal surface of the vascular endothelial
cells of the tumor or intratumoral blood vessels, while exerting little adverse side
effects on normal, healthy tissues.
[0028] The methods may thus be summarized as methods for treating an animal or patient having
a vascularized tumor, comprising administering to the animal or patient a therapeutically
effective amount of at least a first pharmaceutical composition comprising at least
a first therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct that binds to an aminophospholipid,
preferably phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylethanolamine, present, expressed, translocated,
presented or complexed at the luminal surface of blood transporting vessels of the
vascularized tumor.
[0029] The essence of the invention may also be defined as a composition comprising at least
a first diagnostic agent-targeting agent construct, or preferably a therapeutic agent-targeting
agent construct, preferably that binds to phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylethanolamine,
for use in the preparation of a medicament for use in tumor vasculature imaging and/or
destruction and for human tumor diagnosis and/or treatment. This can also be defined
as a composition comprising at least a first diagnostic agent-targeting agent construct,
or preferably a therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct, for use in the preparation
of a medicament for use in binding to an aminophospholipid, preferably phosphatidylserine
or phosphatidylethanolamine, present, expressed, translocated, presented or complexed
at the luminal surface of blood transporting vessels of a vascularized tumor and for
use in forming an image of tumor vasculature and/or for use in inducing tumor vasculature
destruction and for human tumor diagnosis and/or treatment.
[0030] In the medicaments and uses of the present invention, one of the advantages lies
in the fact that the provision of the diagnostic or therapeutic agent-targeting agent
construct, preferably one that binds to phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylethanolamine,
into the systemic circulation of an animal or patient results in the preferential
or specific localization to the tumor vascular surface membranes themselves, and not
to some protein complex more distant from the membrane. The invention thus provides
for more intimate cell contact than the methods and anti-vascular agents of the prior
art.
[0031] In the context of the present invention, the term "a vascularized tumor" most preferably
means a vascularized, malignant tumor, solid tumor or "cancer". The invention is particularly
advantageous in treating vascularized tumors of at least about intermediate size,
and in treating large vascularized tumors - - although this is by no means a limitation
on the invention. The invention may therefore be used in the treatment of any tumor
that exhibits aminophospholipid-positive blood vessels, preferably phosphatidylserine-
and/or phosphatidylethanolamine-positive blood vessels.
[0032] In preferred embodiments, the tumors to be treated by the present invention will
exhibit a killing effective number of aminophospholipid-positive blood vessels. "A
killing effective number of aminophospholipid-positive blood vessels", as used herein,
means that at least about 3% of the total number of blood vessels within the tumor
will be positive for aminophospholipid expression, preferably phosphatidylserine and/or
phosphatidylethanolamine expression. Preferably, at least about 5%, at least about
8%, or at least about 10% or so, of the total number of blood vessels within the tumor
will be positive for aminophospholipid expression. Given the aminophospholipid-negative,
particularly PS-negative, nature of the blood vessels within normal tissues, the tumor
vessels will act as sink for the administered antibodies. Furthermore, as destruction
of only a minimum number of tumor vessels can cause widespread thrombosis, necrosis
and an avalanche of tumor cell death, antibody localization to all, or even a majority,
of the tumor vessels is not necessary for effective therapeutic intervention.
[0033] Nonetheless, in more preferred embodiments, tumors to be treated by this invention
will exhibit a significant number of aminophospholipid-positive blood vessels. "A
significant number of aminophospholipid-positive blood vessels", as used herein, means
that at least about 10-12% of the total number of blood vessels within the tumor will
be positive for aminophospholipid expression, preferably phosphatidylserine and/or
phosphatidylethanolamine expression. Even more preferably, the % of aminophospholipid-expressing
tumor vessels will be at least about 15%, at least about 20%, at least about 30%,
at least about 40%, at least about 50%, at least about 60%, at least about 70%, or
at least about 80% or so of the total number of blood vessels within the tumor, up
to and including even at least about 90% or 95% of the vessels.
[0034] The "therapeutically effective amounts" for use in the invention are amounts of therapeutic
agent-targeting agent constructs, preferably PS- or PE-binding constructs, effective
to specifically kill at least a portion of tumor or intratumoral vascular endothelial
cells; to specifically promote coagulation in at least a portion of tumor or intratumoral
blood vessels; to specifically occlude or destroy at least a portion of blood transporting
vessels of the tumor; to specifically induce necrosis in at least a portion of a tumor;
and/or to induce tumor regression or remission upon administration to selected animals
or patients. Such effects are achieved while exhibiting little or no binding to or
little or no killing of, vascular endothelial cells in normal. healthy tissues; little
or no coagulation in, occlusion or destruction of blood vessels in healthy, normal
tissues; and exerting negligible or manageable adverse side effects on normal. healthy
tissues of the animal or patient.
[0035] The terms "preferentially" and "specifically", as used herein in the context of promoting
coagulation in, or destroying, tumor vasculature. and/or in the context of causing
tumor necrosis, thus mean that the therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs function
to achieve coagulation, destruction and/or tumor necrosis that is substantially confined
to the tumor vasculature and tumor site, and does not substantially extend to causing
coagulation, destruction and/or tissue necrosis in normal, healthy tissues of the
animal or subject. The structure and function of healthy cells and tissues is therefore
maintained substantially unimpaired by the practice of the invention.
[0036] Although understanding the mechanism of action is not necessary to the practice of
the present invention, the methods will generally operate on the basis of the mode
of action of the particular therapeutic agent or agents chosen for attachment to the
targeting agent. As such, the aminophospholipid binding agents that are conjugated
to, or operatively associated with, cytotoxic or anticellular agents ("anti-aminophospholipid
immunotoxins") will act initially via cellular destruction. Likewise, aminophospholipid
binding agents that are conjugated to, or operatively associated with, coagulation
factors ("anti-aminophospholipid coaguligands") will act initially via coagulation.
However, these mechanisms will have some cross-over, as cell destruction exposes basement
membranes and results in coagulation, and as coagulation deprives the cells of oxygen
and nutrients and results in cell destruction.
[0037] Naked or unconjugated antibodies against aminophospholipid components are also capable
of specifically inducing tumor blood vessel destruction and tumor necrosis
in vivo. Such methods of tumor treatment are also contemplated by the present inventors, and
are disclosed and claimed in WO-A-0002584. In light of the beneficial effects of naked
anti-aminophospholipid antibodies, the mechanism of action of the present conjugates
may extend beyond the mode of action of the particular therapeutic agent or agents
employed.
[0038] Therefore, the following mechanisms may contribute to the success of the invention:
cell-mediated cytotoxicity, complement-mediated lysis, apoptosis, antibody-induced
cell signaling (direct signaling), or mimicking or altering signal transduction pathways
(indirect signaling).
[0039] The treatment methods thus include administering to an animal or patient having a
vascularized tumor at least a first pharmaceutical composition comprising an amount
of at least a first therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct effective to induce,
or specifically induce, cell-mediated cytotoxicity of at least a portion of the tumor
or intratumoral vascular endothelial cells. Herein, the first therapeutic agent targeting
agent construct binds to an aminophospholipid, preferably phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylethanolamine,
present, expressed, translocated, presented or complexed at the luminal surface of
tumor or intratumoral vascular endothelial cells and induces cell-mediated cytotoxicity
of at least a portion of the tumor or intratumoral vascular endothelial cells, as
opposed to endothelial cells in normal vessels. As used herein, "cell-mediated cytotoxicity
or destruction" includes ADCC (antibody-dependent, cell-mediated cytotoxicity) and
NK (natural killer) cell killing.
[0040] The methods further include administering to an animal or patient having a vascularized
tumor at least a first pharmaceutical composition comprising an amount of at least
a first therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct effective to induce, or specifically
induce, complement-mediated lysis of at least a portion of the tumor or intratumoral
vascular endothelial cells. Herein, the first therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct
binds to an aminophospholipid, preferably phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylethanolamine,
present, expressed, translocated, presented or complexed at the luminal surface of
tumor or intratumoral vascular endothelial cells and induces complement-mediated lysis
of at least a portion of the tumor or intratumoral vascular endothelial cells, as
opposed to endothelial cells in normal vessels.
[0041] As used herein, "complement-mediated or complement-dependent lysis or cytotoxicity"
means the process by which the complement-dependent coagulation cascade is activated,
multi-component complexes arc assembled, ultimately generating a lytic complex that
has direct lytic action, causing cell permeabilization. Therapeutic agent-targeting
agents for use in inducing complement-mediated lysis will generally include an antibody
Fc portion.
[0042] The complement-based mechanisms by which the present invention may operate further
include "complement-activated ADCC". In such aspects, the administered therapeutic
agent-targeting agent contains an antibody, or fragment thereof, that binds to an
aminophospholipid, preferably phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylethanolamine, present,
expressed, translocated, presented or complexed at the luminal surface of tumor or
intratumoral vascular endothelial cells and induces complement-activated ADCC of at
least a portion of the tumor or intratumoral vascular endothelial cells, as opposed
to endothelial cells in normal vessels. "Complement-activated ADCC" is used to refer
to the process by which complement, not an antibody Fc portion
per se, holds a multi-component complex together and in which cells such as neutrophils lyse
the target cell.
[0043] In other embodiments, the methods include administering to an animal or patient having
a vascularized tumor at least a first pharmaceutical composition comprising an amount
of at least a first therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct effective to induce,
or specifically induce, apoptosis in at least a portion of the tumor or intratumoral
vascular endothelial cells. Herein, the first therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct
binds to an aminophospholipid, preferably phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylethanolamine,
present, expressed, translocated, presented or complexed at the luminal surface of
tumor or intratumoral vascular endothelial cells and induces apoptosis in least a
portion of the tumor or intratumoral vascular endothelial cells, as opposed to endothelial
cells in normal vessels.
[0044] As used herein, "induces apoptosis" means induces the process of programmed cell
death that, during the initial stages, maintains the integrity of the cell membrane,
yet transmits the death-inducing signals into the cell. This is opposed to the mechanisms
of cell necrosis, during which the cell membrane loses its integrity and becomes leaky
at the onset of the process.
[0045] Therapeutic benefits may be realized by the administration of at least two, three
or more therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs. The therapeutic agent-targeting
agent constructs may also be combined with other therapies to provide combined therapeutically
effective amounts, as disclosed herein.
[0046] The treatment methods will generally involve the administration of the pharmaceutically
effective composition to the animal systemically, such as via intravenous injection.
However, any route of administration that allows the therapeutic agent-targeting agent
construct to localize to the tumor or intratumoral vascular endothelial cells will
be acceptable.
[0047] "Administration", as used herein, therefore means provision or delivery of therapeutic
agent-targeting agent constructs in an amount(s) and for a period of time(s) effective
to allow binding to an aminophospholipid, preferably phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylethanolamine,
present, expressed, translocated, presented or complexed at the luminal surface of
blood transporting vessels of the vascularized tumor, and to exert a tumor vasculature
destructive and tumor-regressive effect. The passive administration of proteinaceous
therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs is generally preferred, in part, for
its simplicity and reproducibility.
[0048] However, the term "administration" is herein used to refer to any and all means by
which therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs are delivered or otherwise provided
to the tumor vasculature. "Administration" therefore includes the provision of cells
that produce the therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs in a manner effective
to result in the delivery of the therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs to the
tumor vasculature, and/or their localization to such vasculature. In such embodiments,
it may be desirable to formulate or package the cells in a selectively permeable membrane,
structure or implantable device, generally one that can be removed to cease therapy.
Exogenous therapeutic agent-targeting agent administration will still generally be
preferred, as this represents a non-invasive method that allows the dose to be closely
monitored and controlled.
[0049] The "therapeutic agent-targeting agent administration methods" also extend to the
provision of nucleic acids that encode therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs
in a manner effective to result in the expression of the therapeutic agent-targeting
agent constructs in the vicinity of the tumor vasculature, and/or in the expression
of therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs that can localize to the tumor vasculature.
Any gene therapy technique may be employed, such as naked DNA delivery, recombinant
genes and vectors, cell-based delivery, including
ex vivo manipulation of patients' cells, and the like.
[0050] One of the benefits of the present invention is that aminophospholipids, particularly
phosphatidylserine and phosphatidylethanolamine, are generally expressed or available
throughout the tumor vessels. Aminophospholipid expression on established, intratumoral
blood vessels is advantageous as targeting and destroying such vessels will rapidly
lead to anti-tumor effects. However, so long as the administered therapeutic agent-targeting
agent constructs bind to at least a portion of the blood transporting vessels, significant
anti-tumor effects will ensue. This will not be problematical as aminophospholipids,
such as phosphatidylserine and phosphatidylethanolamine, are expressed on the large,
central vessels, and also on veins, venules, arteries, arterioles and blood transporting
capillaries in all regions of the tumor.
[0051] In any event, the ability of the therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs to
destroy the tumor vasculature means that tumor regression can be achieved, rather
than only tumor stasis. Tumor stasis is most often the result of anti-angiogenic therapies
that target only the budding vessels at the periphery of a solid tumor and stop the
vessels proliferating. Even if the present invention targeted more of the peripheral
regions of the tumor in certain tumor types, which is not currently believed to be
the case, destruction of the blood transporting vessels in such areas would still
lead to widespread thrombosis and tumor necrosis.
[0052] The targeting portions of the diagnostic and/or therapeutic agent-targeting agent
constructs of the present invention, whether binding to phosphatidylethanolamine or
phosphatidylserine, may be either antibody-based or binding ligand or binding protein
based. Any aminophospholipid binding ligand or protein known in the art may thus now
be advantageously used in the delivery of therapeutic agents to tumor vasculature.
[0053] By way of example only, suitable aminophospholipid binding ligands and proteins include
low and high molecular weight kininogens and other rat, bovine, monkey or human phosphatidylethanolamine
binding proteins; and any one or more of a number of phosphatidylserine-serine binding
annexins. The protein and DNA sequences for such binding ligands are known in the
art and incorporated herein by reference, facilitating the production of recombinant
fusion proteins for use in the present invention.
[0054] Aminophospholipid binding reagents encompassed by the term "aminophospholipid binding
ligands or binding proteins" extend to all aminophospholipid binding ligands and proteins
from all species, and aminophospholipid binding fragments thereof, including dimeric,
trimeric and multimeric ligands and proteins: bispecific ligands and proteins; chimeric
ligands and proteins; human ligands and proteins; recombinant and engineered ligands
and proteins, and fragments thereof.
[0055] Where antibody-based targeting portions are employed, whether binding to phosphatidylethanolamine
or phosphatidylserine, the term "anti-aminophospholipid antibody", as used herein,
refers broadly to any immunologic binding agent, such as polyclonal and monoclonal
IgG, IgM, IgA, IgD and IgE antibodies. Generally, IgG and/or IgM are preferred. because
they are the most common antibodies in the physiological situation and because they
are most easily made in a laboratory setting.
[0056] Polyclonal anti-aminophospholipid antibodies, obtained from antisera, may be employed
in the invention. However, the use of monoclonal anti-aminophospholipid antibodies
(MAbs) will generally be preferred. MAbs are recognized to have certain advantages,
e.g., reproducibility and large-scale production, that makes them suitable for clinical
treatment. The invention thus provides monoclonal antibodies of the murine, human,
monkey, rat, hamster, rabbit and even frog or chicken origin. Due to the ease of preparation
and ready availability of reagents, murine monoclonal antibodies will be used in certain
embodiments.
[0057] As will be understood by those in the art, the immunologic binding reagents encompassed
by the term "anti-aminophospholipid antibody" extend to all anti-aminophospholipid
antibodies from all species, and antigen binding fragments thereof, including dimeric,
trimeric and multimeric antibodies; bispecific antibodies; chimeric antibodies; human
and humanized antibodies; recombinant and engineered antibodies, and fragments thereof.
[0058] The term "anti-aminophospholipid antibody" is thus used to refer to any anti-aminophospholipid
antibody-like molecule that has an antigen binding region, and includes antibody fragments
such as Fab', Fab. F(ab')
2, single domain antibodies (DABs), Fv, scFv (single chain Fv), and the like. The techniques
for preparing and using various antibody-based constructs and fragments are well known
in the art.
[0059] In certain embodiments, the antibodies employed in the therapeutic agent-targeting
agent constructs will be "humanized" or human antibodies. "Humanized" antibodies are
generally chimeric monoclonal antibodies from mouse, rat, or other non-human species,
bearing human constant and/or variable region domains ("part-human chimeric antibodies").
Mostly, humanized monoclonal antibodies for use in the present invention will be chimeric
antibodies wherein at least a first antigen binding region, or complementarity determining
region (CDR), of a mouse, rat or other non-human anti-aminophospholipid monoclonal
antibody is operatively attached to, or "grafted" onto, a human antibody constant
region or "framework".
[0060] "Humanized" monoclonal antibodies for use herein may also be anti-aminophospholipid
monoclonal antibodies from non-human species wherein one or more selected amino acids
have been exchanged for amino acids more commonly observed in human antibodies. This
can be readily achieved through the use of routine recombinant technology, particularly
site-specific mutagenesis.
[0061] Entirely human, rather than "humanized". anti-aminophospholipid antibodies may also
be prepared and used in the therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs of the present
invention. Such human antibodies may be polyclonal antibodies, as obtained from human
patients that have any one or more of a variety of diseases, disorders or clinical
conditions associated with the production of anti-aminophospholipid antibodies. Such
antibodies may be concentrated, partially purified or substantially purified for use
herein.
[0062] A range of techniques are also available for preparing human monoclonal antibodies.
As human patients with anti-aminophospholipid antibody-producing diseases exist, the
anti-aminophospholipid antibody-producing cells from such patients may be obtained
and manipulated
in vitro to provide a human monoclonal antibody for use in a therapeutic agent-targeting agent
construct. The
in vitro manipulations or techniques include fusing to prepare a monoclonal antibody-producing
hybridoma, and/or cloning the gene(s) encoding the anti-aminophospholipid antibody
from the cells ("recombinant human antibodies").
[0063] Human anti-aminophospholipid antibody-producing cells may also be obtained from human
subjects without an anti-aminophospholipid antibody-associated disease,
i.e. "healthy subjects" in the context of the present invention. To achieve this, one
would simply obtain a population of mixed peripheral blood lymphocytes from a human
subject, including antigen-presenting and antibody-producing cells, and stimulate
the cell population
in vitro by admixing with an immunogenically effective amount of an aminophospholipid sample.
Again, the human anti-aminophospholipid antibody-producing cells, once obtained, could
be used in hybridoma and/or recombinant antibody production prior to therapeutic agent-targeting
agent construct preparation.
[0064] Further techniques for human monoclonal antibody production include immunizing a
transgenic animal, preferably a transgenic mouse, that comprises a human antibody
library with an immunogenically effective amount of an aminophospholipid sample. This
also generates human anti-aminophospholipid antibody-producing cells for further manipulation
in hybridoma and/or recombinant antibody production, with the advantage that spleen
cells, rather than peripheral blood cells, can be readily obtained from the transgenic
animal or mouse.
[0065] Preferred anti-aminophospholipid antibodies for use in the therapeutic agent-targeting
agent constructs of the present invention are anti-phosphatidylserine (anti-PS) and
anti-phosphatidylethanolamine (anti-PE) antibodies. Anti-PS antibodies will generally
recognize, bind to or have immunospecificity for the PS molecule present, expressed,
translocated, presented or complexed at the luminal surface of tumor vascular endothelial
cells. Suitable antibodies will thus bind to phosphatidyl-L-serine (Umeda
et al., 1989). Anti-PE antibodies will generally recognize, bind to or have immunospecificity
for the PE molecule present, expressed, translocated, presented or complexed at the
luminal surface of tumor vascular endothelial cells.
[0066] Administering diagnostic and/or therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs to an
animal with a tumor will result in specific binding to the aminophospholipid molecules
present, expressed or translocated to the luminal surface of the tumor blood vessels,
i.e., the therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs will bind to the aminophospholipid
molecules in a natural, biological environment. Therefore, no particular manipulation
will be necessary to ensure binding.
[0067] However, in terms of antibody binding, it is of scientific interest to note that
aminophospholipids may be most frequently recognized, or bound, by anti-aminophospholipid
antibodies when the aminophospholipid molecules are associated with one or more proteins
or other non-lipid biological components. For example, anti-PS antibodies that occur
as a sub-set of anti-phospholipid (anti-PL) antibodies in patients with certain diseases
and disorders are now believed to bind to PS in combination with proteins such as
β
2-glycoprotein I (β
2-GPI or apolipoprotein H, apoH) and prothrombin (U.S. Patent No. 5,344,758; Rote,
1996). Similarly, anti-PE antibodies that occur in disease states are now believed
to bind to PE in combination with proteins such as low and high molecular weight kininogen
(HK), prekallikrein and even factor XI (Sugi and McIntyre, 1995; 1996a; 1996b).
[0068] This is the meaning of the terms "presented" and "complexed at" the luminal surface
of tumor blood vessels, as used herein, which mean that the aminophospholipid molecules
are present at the surface of tumor blood vessels in a binding competent state, or
antibody-binding competent state, irrespective of the molecular definition of that
particular state. PS may even be targeted as a complex with factor II/IIa, VII/VIIa,
IX/IXa and X/Xa. Moreover, the nature of the aminophospholipid target may change during
practice of the invention, as the initial aminophospholipid antibody binding, anti-endothelial
cell and anti-tumor effects may result in biological changes that alter the number,
conformation and/or type of the aminophospholipid target epitope(s).
[0069] The term "anti-aminophospholipid antibody", as used in the context of the present
invention, therefore means any antibody, immunological binding agent or antisera;
monoclonal, human, humanized, dimeric, trimeric, multimeric, chimeric, bispecific,
recombinant or engineered antibody; or Fab', Fab, F(ab')
2, DABs, Fv or scFv antigen binding fragment thereof; that at least binds to a lipid
and amino group-containing complex or aminophospholipid target, preferably a phosphatidylserine-
or phosphatidylethanolamine-based target.
[0070] The requirement that the antibody "at least bind to an aminophospholipid target"
is met by the antibody binding to any and/or all physiologically relevant forms of
aminophospholipids, including so-called "hexagonal" and "hexagonal phase II" PS and
PE (HexII PS and HexII PE) (Rauch
et al., 1986; Rauch and Janoff, 1990; Berard
et al., 1993) and PS and PE in combination with any other protein, lipid, membrane component,
plasma or serum component, or any combination thereof. Thus, an "anti-aminophospholipid
antibody" is an antibody that binds to an aminophospholipid in the tumor blood vessels,
notwithstanding the fact that bilayer or micelle aminophospholipids may be considered
to be immunogenically neutral.
[0071] The anti-aminophospholipid antibodies may recognize, bind to or have immunospecificity
for aminophospholipid molecules, or an immunogenic complex thereof (including hexagonal
aminophospholipids and protein combinations), to the exclusion of other phospholipids
or lipids. Such antibodies may be termed "aminophospholipid-specific or aminophospholipid-restricted
antibodies", and their use in the therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs of
the invention will often be preferred. "Aminophospholipid-specific or aminophospholipid-restricted
antibodies" will generally exhibit significant binding to aminophospholipids, while
exhibiting little or no significant binding to other lipid components, such as phosphatidylinositol
(PI), phosphatidylglycerol (PG) and even phosphatidylcholine (PC) in certain embodiments.
[0072] "PS-specific or PS-restricted antibodies" will generally exhibit significant binding
to PS, while exhibiting little or no significant binding to lipid components such
as phosphatidylethanolamine and cardiolipin (CL), as well as PC, PI and PG. "PE-specific
or PE-restricted antibodies" will generally exhibit significant binding to PE, while
exhibiting little or no significant binding to lipid components such as phosphatidylserine
and cardiolipin, as well as PC, PI and PG. The preparation of specific anti-aminophospholipid
antibodies is readily achieved,
e.g., as disclosed by Rauch
et al. (1986); Umeda
et al. (1989); Rauch and Janoff (1990); and Rote
et al. (1993).
[0073] "Cross-reactive anti-aminophospholipid antibodies" that recognize, bind to or have
immunospecificity for an aminophospholipid molecule, or an immunogenic complex thereof
(including hexagonal aminophospholipids and protein combinations), in addition to
exhibiting lesser but detectable binding to other phospholipid or lipid components
are by no means excluded from use in the invention. Such "cross-reactive anti-aminophospholipid
antibodies" may be employed so long as they bind to an aminophospholipid present,
expressed, translocated, presented or complexed at the luminal surface of tumor vascular
endothelial cells
in vivo.
[0074] Further suitable aminophospholipid-specific or aminophospholipid-restricted antibodies
are those anti-aminophospholipid antibodies that bind to both PS and PE. While clearly
being specific or restricted to aminophospholipids, as opposed to other lipid components,
antibodies exist that bind to each of the preferred targets of the present invention.
Examples of such antibodies for use in the therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs
of the invention include, but are not limited to, PS3A, PSF6, PSF7, PSB4, PS3H1 and
PS3E10 (Igarashi
et al., 1991).
[0075] Further exemplary anti-PS antibodies for use in the therapeutic agent-targeting agent
constructs include, but are not limited to BA3B5C4, PS4A7, PS1G3 and 3SB9b; with PS4A7,
PS1G3 and 3SB9b generally being preferred. Monoclonal antibodies, humanized antibodies
and/or antigen-binding fragments based upon the 3SB9b antibody (Rote
et al., 1993) are currently most preferred.
[0076] Although aminophospholipids, such as PS and PE, in bilayer or micelle form have been
reported to be non- or weakly antigenic, or non- or weakly-immunogcnic, the scientific
literature has reported no difficulties in generating anti-aminophospholipid antibodies,
such as anti-PS and anti-PE antibodies. Anti-aminophospholipid antibodies or monoclonal
antibodies may therefore be readily prepared by preparative processes and methods
that comprise:
(a) preparing an anti-aminophospholipidantibody-producing cell; and
(b) obtaining an anti-aminophospholipid antibody or monoclonal antibody from the antibody-producingcell.
[0077] The processes of preparing anti-aminophospholipid antibody-producing cells and obtaining
anti-aminophospholipidantibodies therefrom may be conduced
in situ in a given patient. That is, simply providing an immunogenically effective amount
of an immunogenic aminophospholipid sample to a patient will result in anti-aminophospholipid
antibody generation. Thus, the anti-aminophospholipidantibody is still "obtained"
from the antibody-producing cell, but it does not have to be isolated away from a
host and subsequently provided to a patient, being able to spontaneously localize
to the tumor vasculature and exert its biological anti-tumor effects.
[0078] As disclosed herein, anti-aminophospholipid antibody-producing cells may be obtained,
and antibodies subsequently isolated and/or purified, from human patients with anti-aminophospholipid
antibody-producing diseases, from stimulating peripheral blood lymphocytes with aminophospholipids
in vitro, and also by immunization processes and methods. The latter of which generally comprise:
(a) immunizing an animal by administering to the animal at least one dose, and optionally
more than one dose, of an immunogenically effective amount of an immunogenic aminophospholipid
sample (such as a hexagonal, or hexagonal phase II form of an aminophospholipid),
preferably an immunogenic PS or PE sample; and
(b) obtaining an anti-aminophospholipid antibody-producing cell from the immunized
animal.
[0079] The immunogenically effective amount of the aminophospholipid sample or samples may
be a
Solmonella-coated aminophospholipid sample (Umeda
el al., 1989); an aminophospholipid micelle, liposome, lipid complex or lipid formulation
sample; or an aminophospholipid sample fabricated with SDS. Any such aminophospholipid
sample may be administered in combination with any suitable adjuvant, such as Freund's
complete adjuvant (Rote
et al., 1993). Any empirical technique or variation may be employed to increase immunogenicity,
and/or hexagonal or hexagonal phase II forms of the aminophospholipids may be administered.
[0080] The immunization may be based upon one or more intrasplenic injections of an immunogenically
effective amount of an aminophospholipid sample (Umeda
et al., 1989).
[0081] Irrespective of the nature of the immunization process, or the type of immunized
animal, anti-aminophospholipidantibody-producingcells are obtained from the immunized
animal and, preferably, further manipulated by the hand of man. "An immunized animal",
as used herein, is a non-human animal, unless otherwise expressly stated. Although
any antibody-producing cell may be used, most preferably, spleen cells are obtained
as the source of the antibody-producing cells. The anti-aminophospholipid antibody-producing
cells may be used in a preparative process that comprises:
(a) fusing an anti-aminophospholipid antibody-producing cell with an immortal cell
to prepare a hybridoma that produces an anti-aminophospholipidmonoclonal antibody
and
(b) obtaining an anti-aminophospholipid monoclonal antibody from the hybridoma.
[0082] Hybridoma-based monoclonal antibody preparative methods thus include those that comprise:
(a) immunizing an animal by administering to the animal at least one dose. and optionally
more than one dose, of an immunogenically effective amount of an immunogenic aminophospholipid
sample (such as a hexagonal, or hexagonal phase II form of an aminophospholipid),
preferably an immunogenic PS or PE sample;
(b) preparing a collection of monoclonal antibody-producing hybridomas from the immunized
animal;
(c) selecting from the collection at least a first hybridoma that produces at least
a first anti-aminophospholipid monoclonal antibody. and preferably, at least a first
aminophospholipid-specific monoclonal antibody: and
(d) culturing the at least a first anti-aminophospholipid-producing or aminophospholipid-specific
hybridoma to provide the at least a first anti-aminophospholipid monoclonal antibody
or aminophospholipid-specific monoclonal antibody; and preferably
(e) obtaining the at least a first anti-aminophospholipid monoclonal antibody or aminophospholipid-specific
monoclonal antibody from the cultured at least a first hybridoma.
[0083] As non-human animals are used for immunization, the anti-aminophospholipid monoclonal
antibodies obtained from such a hybridoma will often have a non-human make up. Such
antibodies may be optionally subjected to a humanization process, grafting or mutation,
as known to those of skill in the art and further disclosed herein. Alternatively,
transgenic animals, such as mice, may be used that comprise a human antibody gene
library. Immunization of such animals will therefore directly result in the generation
of human anti-aminophospholipid antibodies.
[0084] After the production of a suitable antibody-producing cell. most preferably a hybridoma,
whether producing human or non-human antibodies, the monoclonal antibody-encoding
nucleic acids may be cloned to prepare a "recombinant" monoclonal antibody. Any recombinant
cloning technique may be utilized, including the use of PCR to prime the synthesis
of the antibody-encoding nucleic acid sequences. Therefore, yet further appropriate
monoclonal antibody preparative methods include those that comprise using the anti-aminophospholipid
antibody-producing cells as follows:
(a) obtaining at least a first anti-aminophospholipid antibody-encoding nucleic acid
molecule or segment from an anti-aminophospholipid antibody-producingcell, preferably
a hybridoma; and
(b) expressing the nucleic acid molecule or segment in a recombinant host cell to
obtain a recombinant anti-aminophospholipid monoclonal antibody.
[0085] However, other powerful recombinant techniques are available that are ideally suited
to the preparation of recombinant monoclonal antibodies. Such recombinant techniques
include the phagemid library-based monoclonal antibody preparative methods comprising:
(a) immunizing an animal by administering to the animal at least one dose, and optionally
more than one dose, of an immunogenically effective amount of an immunogenic aminophospholipid
sample (such as a hexagonal, or hexagonal phase II form of an aminophospholipid).
preferably an immunogenic PS or PE sample;
(b) preparing a combinatorial immunoglobulin phagemid library expressing RNA isolated
from the antibody-producing cells, preferably from the spleen, of the immunized animal;
(c) selecting from the phagemid library at least a first clone that expresses at least
a first anti-aminophospholipid antibody, and preferably, at least a first aminophospholipid-specific
antibody;
(d) obtaining anti-aminophospholipid antibody-encoding nucleic acids from the at least
a first selected clone and expressing the nucleic acids in a recombinant host cell
to provide the at least a first anti-aminophospholipid antibody or aminophospholipid-specific
antibody; and preferably
(e) obtaining the at least a first anti-aminophospholipid antibody or aminophospholipid-specific
antibody expressed by the nucleic acids obtained from the at least a first selected
clone.
[0086] Again, in such phagemid library-based techniques, transgenic animals bearing human
antibody gene libraries may be employed, thus yielding recombinant human monoclonal
antibodies.
[0087] Irrespective of the manner of preparation of a first anti-aminophospholipid antibody
nucleic acid segment, further suitable anti-aminophospholipid antibody nucleic acid
segments may be readily prepared by standard molecular biological techniques. In order
to confirm that any variant, mutant or second generation anti-aminophospholipid antibody
nucleic acid segment is suitable for use in the present invention, the nucleic acid
segment will be tested to confirm expression of an antibody that binds to an aminophospholipid.
Preferably, the variant, mutant or second generation anti-aminophospholipid antibody
nucleic acid segment will also be tested to confirm hybridization to an anti-aminophospholipid
antibody nucleic acid segment under standard, more preferably, standard stringent
hybridization conditions. Exemplary suitable hybridization conditions include hybridization
in about 7% sodium dodecyl sulfate (SDS), about 0.5 M NaPO
4, about 1 mM EDTA at about 50°C; and washing with about 1% SDS at about 42°C.
[0088] As a variety of recombinant monoclonal antibodies, whether human or non-human in
origin, may be readily prepared, the treatment methods of the invention may be executed
by providing to the animal or patient at least a first nucleic acid segment that expresses
a biologically effective amount of at least a first therapeutic agent-targeting agent
construct in the patient. The "nucleic acid segment that expresses a therapeutic agent-targeting
agent construct" will generally be in the form of at least an expression construct,
and may be in the form of an expression construct comprised within a virus or within
a recombinant host cell. Preferred gene therapy vectors of the present invention will
generally be viral vectors. such as comprised within a recombinant retrovirus, herpes
simplex virus (HSV). adenovirus, adeno-associated virus (AAV), cytomegalovirus (CMV),
and the like.
[0089] Once a targeting agent has been selected, whether antibody-based or binding ligand-based,
and whether binding to phosphatidylethanolamine and/or phosphatidylserine,the targeting
agent is operatively attached to one or more diagnostic and/or therapeutic agents
or "effector" portions. The therapeutic agents of the present constructs will generally
be either anti-cellular, cytotoxic or anti-angiogenic agents, or coagulation factors
(coagulants).
[0090] The use of anti-cellular, cytotoxic and/or anti-angiogenic agents results in "aminophospholipid
immunotoxins" (or anti-aminophospholipid immunotoxins), whereas the use of coagulation
factors results in "aminophospholipid coaguligands" (or anti-aminophospholipid coaguligands).
These terms are again used for simplicity and succinctly refer to aminophospholipid
binding ligands or therapeutic agent-aminophospholipid targeting agent constructs
in terms of their attached therapeutic moiety.
[0091] The present invention further provides binding ligands, and their use, comprising
at least two therapeutic agents operatively attached to a targeting agent comprising
a single aminophospholipid binding site. The binding ligands may comprise at least
two therapeutic agents operatively attached to a targeting agent that comprises at
least two aminophospholipid binding sites; or a plurality of therapeutic agents operatively
attached to a targeting agent that comprises a plurality of aminophospholipid binding
sites, generally at regions distinct from the aminophospholipidbinding sites.
[0092] Combinations of anti-cellular and cytotoxic agents with coagulation factors are also
contemplated, irrespective of the number of aminophospholipid binding sites. The combined
use of therapeutic agents of different classes, such as cytotoxins and coagulants,
is also contemplated in embodiments where two or more binding ligands are administered
to the animal, each containing a single type of therapeutic agent. Different cytotoxins
may also be employed in one or more binding ligands or methods, such as DNA synthesis
inhibitors combined with classic cytotoxins, such as ricin.
[0093] In certain applications, the aminophospholipid-targeted constructs will be operatively
attached to cytotoxic, cytostatic or otherwise anti-cellular agents that have the
ability to kill or suppress the growth or cell division of endothelial cells. Suitable
anti-cellular agents include chemotherapeutic agents, as well as cytotoxins and cytostatic
agents. Cytostatic agents are generally those that disturb the natural cell cycle
of a target cell, preferably so that the cell is taken out of the cell cycle.
[0094] Exemplary chemotherapeutic agents include: steroids; cytokines; anti-metabolites,
such as cytosine arabinoside, fluorouracil, methotrexate or aminopterin; anthracyclines;
mitomycin C; vinca alkaloids; antibiotics; demecolcine; etoposide; mithramycin; and
anti-tumor alkylating agents, such as chlorambucil or melphalan. Indeed, any of the
agents disclosed herein in Table C could be used. Certain preferred anti-cellular
agents are DNA synthesis inhibitors, such as daunorubicin, doxorubicin, adriamycin,
and the like.
[0095] In other embodiments, aminophospholipid-targeted constructs of the invention may
be operatively attached to anti-angiogenic agents that, acting either alone or in
concert with other host factors, or administered therapeutic agents, have the ability
to prevent or inhibit vascularization and/or to induce regression of blood vessels.
Suitable anti-angiogenic agents include those listed in Table D, as well as other
anti-angiogenic agents known to those of skill in the art. By way of example only,
one may mention the angiopoietins, preferably, angiopoietin-2 (Ang-2; SEQ ID NO:3
and SEQ ID NO:4), but also angiopoietin-1 (Ang-1; SEQ ID NO:1 and SEQ ID NO:2), angiopoietin
fusion proteins (for example, as in SEQ ID NO:5), and even angiopoietin-3 and angiopoietin-4.
[0096] In certain therapeutic applications, toxin moieties will be preferred, due to the
much greater ability of most toxins to deliver a cell killing effect, as compared
to other potential agents. Therefore, certain preferred anti-cellular agents for aminophospholipid-targeted
constructs are plant-, fungus- or bacteria-derived toxins. Exemplary toxins include
epipodophyllotoxins; bacterial endotoxin or the lipid A moiety of bacterial endotoxin;
ribosome inactivating proteins, such as saporin or gelonin; α-sarcin; aspergillin;
restrictocin; ribonucleases, such as placental ribonuclease; diphtheria toxin and
pseudomonas exotoxin.
[0097] Preferred toxins for certain embodiments are gelonin and/or the A chain toxins, such
as ricin A chain. The most preferred toxin moiety is often ricin A chain that has
been treated to modify or remove carbohydrate residues, so called "deglycosylated
A chain" (dgA). Deglycosylated ricin A chain is preferred because of its extreme potency,
longer half-life, and because it is economically feasible to manufacture it a clinical
grade and scale. Recombinant and/or truncated ricin A chain may also be used.
[0098] For tumor targeting and treatment with immunotoxins, the following patents and patent
applications are useful for the purposes of even further supplementing the present
teachings regarding anticellular and cytotoxic agents: U.S. Patents Nos. 5,855,866;
5,776,427; 5,863,538; 5,660,827, 6,004,554, 5,965,132, and 6,051,230.
[0099] The aminophospholipid-targeted constructs of the invention may comprise a component
that is capable of promoting coagulation,
i.e., a coagulant. Here, the targeting antibody or ligand may be directly or indirectly,
e.g., via another antibody, linked to a factor that directly or indirectly stimulates coagulation.
[0100] Preferred coagulation factors for such uses are Tissue Factor (TF) and TF derivatives,
such as truncated TF (tTF), dimeric, trimeric, polymeric/multimeric TF, and mutant
TF deficient in the ability to activate Factor VII. Other suitable coagulation factors
include vitamin K-dependent coagulants, such as Factor II/IIa, Factor VII/VIIa, Factor
IX/IXa and Factor X/Xa; vitamin K-dependent coagulation factors that lack the Gla
modification; Russell's viper venom Factor X activator; platelet-activating compounds,
such as thromboxane A
2 and thromboxane A
2 synthase; and inhibitors of fibrinolysis, such as α2-antiplasmin.
[0101] Tumor targeting and treatment with coaguligands is described in the following patents
and patent applications, each of which are useful for the purposes of even further
supplementing the present teachings regarding coaguligands and coagulation factors:
U.S. Patent Nos. 5,855,866, 5,965,132, 6,036,955, 6,093,399 and 5,877,289.
[0102] As somewhat wider distribution of a coagulating agent will not be associated with
severe side effects. there is a less stringent requirement imposed on the targeting
element of coaguligands than with immunotoxins. Therefore, to achieve specific targeting
means that coagulation is promoted in the tumor vasculature relative to the vasculature
in non-tumor sites. Thus, specific targeting of a coaguligand is a functional term,
rather than a purely physical term relating to the biodistribution properties of the
targeting agent.
[0103] The preparation of immunotoxins is generally well known in the art (see,
e.g., U.S. Patent 4,340,535). Each of the following patents and patent applications are
useful for the purposes of even further supplementing the present teachings regarding
immunotoxin generation, purification and use: U.S. Patents Nos. 5,855,866; 5,776,427;
5,863,538; 6,004,554, 5,965,132, 6,051,230 and 5,660,827; and U.S. Applications Serial
No. 07/846,349.
[0104] In the preparation of immunotoxins, advantages may be achieved through the use of
certain linkers. For example, linkers that contain a disulfide bond that is sterically
"hindered" are often preferred, due to their greater stability
in vivo, thus preventing release of the toxin moiety prior to binding at the site of action.
It is generally desired to have a conjugate that will remain intact under conditions
found everywhere in the body except the intended site of action, at which point it
is desirable that the conjugate have good "release" characteristics.
[0105] Depending on the specific toxin compound used, it may be necessary to provide a peptide
spacer operatively attaching the targeting agent and the toxin compound, wherein the
peptide spacer is capable of folding into a disulfide-bonded loop structure. Proteolytic
cleavage within the loop would then yield a heterodimeric polypeptide wherein the
targeting agent and the toxin compound are linked by only a single disulfide bond.
[0106] When certain other toxin compounds are utilized, a non-cleavable peptide spacer may
be provided to operatively attach the targeting agent and the toxin compound. Toxins
that may be used in conjunction with non-cleavable peptide spacers are those that
may, themselves, be converted by proteolytic cleavage, into a cytotoxic disulfide-bonded
form. An example of such a toxin compound is a
Pseudonomas exotoxin compound.
[0107] A variety of chemotherapeutic and other pharmacological agents can also be successfully
conjugated to aminophospholipid antibodies or targeting ligands. Exemplary antineoplastic
agents that have been conjugated to antibodies include doxorubicin, daunomycin, methotrexate
and vinblastine. Moreover, the attachment of other agents such as neocarzinostatin,
macromycin, trenimon and α-amanitin has been described (see U.S. Patent Nos. 5,855,866;
and 5,965,132).
[0108] In light of one of the present inventors earlier work, the preparation of coaguligands
is now also easily practiced. The operable association of one or more coagulation
factors with an aminophospholipid targeting agent may be a direct linkage, such as
those described above for the immunotoxins. Alternatively, the operative association
may be an indirect attachment, such as where the targeting agent is operatively attached
to a second binding region, preferably and antibody or antigen binding region of an
antibody, that binds to the coagulation factor. The coagulation factor should be attached
to the targeting agent at a site distinct from its functional coagulating site, particularly
where a covalent linkage is used to join the molecules.
[0109] Indirectly linked coaguligands are often based upon bispecific antibodies. The preparation
of bispecific antibodies is also well known in the art. One preparative method involves
the separate preparation of antibodies having specificity for the targeted tumor component,
on the one hand, and the coagulating agent on the other. Peptic F(ab'γ)
2 fragments from the two chosen antibodies are then generated, followed by reduction
of each to provide separate Fab'γ
SH fragments. The SH groups on one of the two partners to be coupled are then alkylated
with a cross-linking reagent, such as o-phenylenedimaleimide, to provide free maleimide
groups on one partner. This partner may then be conjugated to the other by means of
a thioether linkage, to give the desired F(ab'γ)
2 heteroconjugate (Glennie
et al., 1987; incorporated herein by reference). Other approaches, such as cross-linking
with SPDP or protein A may also be carried out.
[0110] Another method for producing bispecific antibodies is by the fusion of two hybridomas
to form a quadroma. As used herein, the term "quailroma" is used to describe the productive
fusion of two B cell hybridomas. Using now standard techniques, two antibody producing
hybridomas are fused to give daughter cells, and those cells that have maintained
the expression of both sets of clonotype immunoglobulin genes are then selected.
[0111] A preferred method of generating a quadroma involves the selection of an enzyme deficient
mutant of at least one of the parental hybridomas. This first mutant hybridoma cell
line is then fused to cells of a second hybridoma that had been lethally exposed,
e.g., to iodoacetamide, precluding its continued survival. Cell fusion allows for the rescue
of the first hybridoma by acquiring the gene for its enzyme deficiency from the lethally
treated hybridoma, and the rescue of the second hybridoma through fusion to the first
hybridoma. Preferred, but not required, is the fusion of immunoglobulins of the same
isotype, but of a different subclass. A mixed subclass antibody permits the use if
an alternative assay for the isolation of a preferred quadroma.
[0112] Microtiter identification embodiments, FACS, immunofluorescence staining, idiotype
specific antibodies, antigen binding competition assays, and other methods common
in the art of antibody characterization may be used to identify preferred quadromas.
Following the isolation of the quadroma, the bispecific antibodies are purified away
from other cell products. This may be accomplished by a variety of antibody isolation
procedures, known to those skilled in the art of immunoglobulin purification (see,
e.g., Antibodies: A Laboratory Manual, 1988). Protein A or protein G sepharose columns
are preferred.
[0113] In the preparation of both immunotoxins and coaguligands, recombinant expression
may be employed. The nucleic acid sequences encoding the chosen targeting agent, and
toxin or coagulant, are attached in-frame in an expression vector. Recombinant expression
thus results in translation of the nucleic acid to yield the desired targeting agent-toxin/coagulant
compound. Chemical cross-linkers and avidin:biotin bridges may also join the therapeutic
agent(s) to the targeting agent(s).
[0114] The following patents and patent applications are each useful for the purposes of
even further supplementing the present teachings regarding coaguligand preparation,
purification and use, including bispecific antibody coaguligands: U.S. Patent Nos.
5,855,866 5,965,132, 6,004,555, 6,036,955, 6,039,399, and 5,877,289.
[0115] In certain embodiments, the vasculature of the vascularized tumor of the animal or
patient to be treated may be first imaged. Generally this is achieved by first administering
to the animal or patient a diagnostically effective amount of at least a first pharmaceutical
composition comprising at least a first detectably-labeled aminophospholipid binding
construct that binds to and identifies an aminophospholipid, preferably phosphatidylserine
or phosphatidylethanolamine, present, expressed, translocated, presented or complexed
at the luminal surface of blood vessels or intratumoral blood vessels of the vascularized
tumor. The invention thus further provides compositions for use in, and methods of,
distinguishing between tumor and/or intratumoral blood vessels and normal blood vessels.
The "distinguishing" is achieved by administering one or more of the detectably-labeled
aminophospholipidbinding constructs described.
[0116] The derectably-labeled aminophospholipid binding construct may comprise an X-ray
detectable compound, such as bismuth (III), gold (III), lanthanum (III) or lead (II);
a radioactive ion, such as copper
67, gallium
67, gallium
68, indium
111, indium
113, iodine
123, iodine
125, iodine
131, mercury
197, mercury
203, rhenium
186, rhenium
188, rubidium
97, rubidium
103, technetium
99m or yttrium
90: a nuclear magnetic spin-resonance isotope, such as cobalt (II), copper (II), chromium
(III), dysprosium (III), erbium (III), gadolinium (III), holmium (III), iron (II),
iron (III), manganese (II), neodymium (III), nickel (II), samarium (III), terbium
(III), vanadium (II) or ytterbium (III); or rhodamine or fluorescein.
[0117] Pre-imaging before tumor treatment may thus be carried out by:
(a) administering to the animal or patient a diagnostically effective amount of a
pharmaceutical composition comprising at least a first detectably-labeled aminophospholipid
binding construct that comprises a diagnostic agent operatively attached to an antibody,
binding protein or ligand, or aminophospholipid binding fragment thereof, that binds
to an aminophospholipid, preferably phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylethanolamine,
present, expressed, translocated, presented or complexed at the luminal surface of
blood vessels or intratumoral blood vessels of the vascularized tumor; and
(b) subsequently detecting the detectably-labeled aminophospholipid binding construct
bound to an aminophospholipid, preferably phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylethanolamine,
on the luminal surface of tumor or intratumoral blood vessels, thereby obtaining an
image of the tumor vasculature.
[0118] Cancer treatment may also be carried out by:
(a) forming an image of a vascularized tumor by administering to an animal or patient
having a vascularized tumor a diagnostically minimal amount of at least a first detectably-labeled
aminophospholipid binding construct comprising a diagnostic agent operatively attached
to an antibody, binding protein or ligand, or aminophospholipid binding fragment thereof,
that binds to an aminophospholipid, preferably phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylethanolamine,
on the luminal surface of tumor or intratumoral blood vessels of the vascularized
tumor, thereby forming a detectable image of the tumor vasculature; and
(b) subsequently administering to the same animal or patient a therapeutically optimized
amount of at least a first therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct that binds
to an aminophospholipid, preferably phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylethanolamine,
on the tumor or intratumoral blood vessel luminal surface and thereby destroys the
tumor vasculature.
[0119] Imaging and treatment formulations or medicaments are thus provided, which generally
comprise:
(a) a first pharmaceutical composition comprising a diagnostically effective amount
of a detectably-labeled aminophospholipid binding construct that comprises a detectable
agent operatively attached to an antibody, binding protein or ligand; or aminophospholipid
binding fragment thereof, that binds to an aminophospholipid, preferably phosphatidylserine
or phosphatidylethanolamine, on the luminal surface of tumor or intratumoral blood
vessels of the vascularized tumor; and
(b) a second pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount
of at least one therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct, preferably one that binds
to phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylethanolamine.
[0120] In such methods and medicaments, advantages will be realized wherein the first and
second pharmaceutical compositions comprise the same targeting agents,
e.g., anti-aminophospholipid antibodies, or fragments thereof, from the same antibody
preparation, or preferably, from the same antibody-producing hybridoma. The foregoing
medicaments may also further comprise one or more anti-cancer agents.
[0121] In the vasculature imaging aspects of the invention, it is recognized that the administered
detectably-labeled aminophospholipid binding construct, or anti-aminophospholipid
antibody-detectable agent, may itself have a therapeutic effect. Whilst this would
not be excluded from the invention, the amounts of the detectably-labeled constructs
to be administered would generally be chosen as "diagnostically effective amounts",
which are typically lower than the amounts required for therapeutic benefit.
[0122] In the imaging embodiments, as with the therapeutics, the targeting agent may be
either antibody-based or binding ligand- or binding protein-based. Although not previously
connected with tumors or tumor vasculature. detectably labeled aminophospholipid binding
ligand compositions are known in the art and can now, in light of this motivation
and the present disclosure, be used in the present invention. The detectably-labeled
annexins of U.S. Patent No. 5,627,036; WO 95/19791; WO 95/27903; WO 95/34315; WO 96/17618;
and WO 98/04294; may thus be employed.
[0123] In still further embodiments, the animals or patients to be treated by the present
invention are further subjected to surgery or radiotherapy, or are provided with a
therapeutically effective amount of at least a first anti-cancer agent. The "at least
a first anti-cancer agent" in this context means "at least a first anti-cancer agent
in addition to the therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct of the invention. The
"at least a first anti-cancer agent" may thus be considered to be "at least a second
anti-cancer agent", where the therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct is a first
anti-cancer agent. However, this is purely a matter of semantics, and the practical
meaning will be clear to those of ordinary skill in the art.
[0124] The at least a first anti-cancer agent may be administered to the animal or patient
substantially simultaneously with the therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct:
such as from a single pharmaceutical composition or from two pharmaceutical compositions
administered closely together.
[0125] Alternatively, the at least a first anti-cancer agent may be administered to the
animal or patient at a time sequential to the administration of the at least a first
therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct. "At a time sequential", as used herein,
means "staggered", such that the at least a first anti-cancer agent is administered
to the animal or patient at a time distinct to the administration of the at least
a first therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct. Generally, the two agents are
administered at times effectively spaced apart to allow the two agents to exert their
respective therapeutic effects,
i.e., they are administered at "biologically effective time intervals".
[0126] The at least a first anti-cancer agent may be administered to the animal or patient
at a biologically effective time prior to the therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct,
or at a biologically effective time subsequent to the therapeutic agent-targeting
agent construct. Administration of a non-aminophospholipid targeted anti-cancer agent
at a therapeutically effective time subsequent to the therapeutic agent-targeting
agent construct may be particularly desired wherein the anti-cancer agent is an anti-tumor
cell immunotoxin designed to kill tumor cells at the outermost rim of the tumor, and/or
wherein the anti-cancer agent is an anti-angiogenic agent designed to prevent micrometastasis
of any remaining tumor cells. Such considerations will be known to those of skill
in the art.
[0127] Administration of one or more non-aminophospholipid targeted anti-cancer agents at
a therapeutically effective time prior to a therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct
may be particularly employed where the anti-cancer agent is designed to increase aminophospholipid
expression. This may be achieved by using anti-cancer agents that injure, or induce
apoptosis in, the tumor endothelium. Exemplary anti-cancer agent include,
e.g., taxol, vincristine, vinblastine, neomycin, combretastatin(s), podophyllotoxin(s),
TNF-α, angiostatin, endostatin, vasculostatin, α
vβ
3 antagonists, calcium ionophores, calcium-flux inducing agents, any derivative or
prodrug thereof.
[0128] The one or more additional anti-cancer agents may be chemotherapeutic agents, radiotherapeutic
agents. cytokines, anti-angiogenic agents, apoptosis-inducing agents or anti-cancer
immunotoxins or coaguligands. "Chemotherapeutic agents". as used herein, refer to
classical chemotherapeutic agents or drugs used in the treatment of malignancies.
This term is used for simplicity notwithstanding the fact that other compounds may
be technically described as chemotherapeutic agents in that they exert an anti-cancer
effect. However, "chemotherapeutic" has come to have a distinct meaning in the art
and is being used according to this standard meaning.
[0129] A number of exemplary chemotherapeuticagents are described herein. Those of ordinary
skill in the art will readily understand the uses and appropriate doses of chemotherapeutic
agents, although the doses may well be reduced when used in combination with the present
invention. A new class of drugs that may also be termed "chemotherapeutic agents"
are agents that induce apoptosis. Any one or more of such drugs, including genes,
vectors and antisense constructs, as appropriate, may also be used in conjunction
with the present invention.
[0130] Anti-cancer immunotoxins or coaguligands are further appropriate anti-cancer agents.
"Anti-cancer immunotoxins or coaguligands", or targeting-agent/therapeutic agent constructs.
are based upon targeting agents, including antibodies or antigen binding fragments
thereof, that bind to a targetable component of a tumor cell. tumor vasculature or
tumor stroma, and that are operatively attached to a therapeutic agent, generally
a cytotoxic agent (immunotoxin) or coagulation factor (coaguligand). A "targetable
component" of a tumor cell, tumor vasculature or tumor stroma, is preferably a surface-expressed,
surface-accessible or surface-localized component, although components released from
necrotic or otherwise damaged tumor cells or vascular endothelial cells may also be
targeted, including cytosolic and/or nuclear tumor cell antigens.
[0131] Both antibody and non-antibody targeting agents may be used, including growth factors,
such as VEGF and FGF; peptides containing the tripeptide R-G-D, that bind specifically
to the tumor vasculature; and other targeting components such as annexins and related
ligands.
[0132] Anti-tumor cell immunotoxins or coaguligands may comprise antibodies exemplified
by the group consisting of B3 (ATCC HB 10573), 260F9 (ATCC HB 8488), D612 (ATCC HB
9796) and KS1/4, said KS1/4 antibody obtained from a cell comprising the vector pGKC2310
(NRRL B-18356) or the vector pG2A52 (NRRL B-18357).
[0133] Anti-tumor stroma immunotoxins or coaguligands will generally comprise antibodies
that bind to a connective tissue component, a basement membrane component or an activated
platelet component; as exemplified by binding to fibrin, RIBS or LIBS.
[0134] Anti-tumor vasculature immunotoxins or coaguligands may comprise ligands. antibodies,
or fragments thereof, that bind to a surface-expressed, surface-accessible or surface-localized
component of the blood transporting vessels, preferably the intratumoral blood vessels,
of a vascularized tumor. Such antibodies include those that bind to surface-expressed
components of intratumoral blood vessels of a vascularized tumor, including aminophospholipids
themselves, and intratumoral vasculature cell surface receptors, such as endoglin
(TEC-4 and TEC-11 antibodies), a TGFβ receptor, E-selectin, P-selectin, VCAM-1, ICAM-1,
PSMA, a VEGF/VPF receptor, an FGF receptor, a TIE, α
vβ
3 integrin, pleiotropin, endosialin and MHC Class II proteins. The antibodies may also
bind to cytokine-inducible or coagulant-inducible components of intratumoral blood
vessels.
[0135] Other anti-tumor vasculature immunotoxins or coaguligands may comprise antibodies,
or fragments thereof, that bind to a ligand or growth factor that binds to an intratumoral
vasculature cell surface receptor. Such antibodies include those that bind to VEGF/VPF
(GV39 and GV97 antibodies), FGF, TGFβ, a ligand that binds to a TIE, a tumor-associated
fibronectin isoform, scatter factor/hepatocyte growth factor (HGF), platelet factor
4 (PF4), PDGF and TIMP. The antibodies, or fragments thereof, may also bind to a ligand:receptor
complex or a growth factor:receptor complex, but not to the ligand or growth factor,
or to the receptor, when the ligand or growth factor or the receptor is not in the
ligand:receptor or growth factor:receptor complex.
[0136] Anti-tumor cell, anti-tumor stroma or anti-tumor vasculature antibody-therapeutic
agent constructs may comprise cytotoxic agents such as plant-, fungus- or bacteria-derived
toxins (immunotoxins). Ricin A chain and deglycosylated ricin A chain will often be
preferred, and gelonin and angiopoietins are also contemplated. Anti-tumor cell, anti-tumor
stroma or anti-tumor vasculature antibody-therapeutic agent constructs may comprise
coagulation factors or second antibody binding regions that bind to coagulation factors
(coaguligands). The operative association with Tissue Factor or Tissue Factor derivatives,
such as truncated Tissue Factor, will often be preferred.
[0137] The invention still further provides a series of novel therapeutic binding ligands,
binding ligand compositions and pharmaceutical compositions, each of which comprise
at least a first targeting agent that binds to an aminophospholipid, operatively attached
to at least a first therapeutic agent, such as a cytotoxin, anti-angiogenic agent
or coagulant. Radiolabels are generally excluded from the binding ligands and binding
ligand compositions; although not from the diagnostic methods, or even from the therapeutic
methods described above.
[0138] The targeting agents of the binding ligands preferably bind to phosphatidylethanolamine
and/or phosphatidylserine. The entire range of binding ligands described above in
the context of the therapeutic and combined methods may be employed in the present
compositions. Annexin conjugates and constructs; anti-PS, anti-PE, human, humanized
and monoclonal antibody conjugates and constructs; ricin conjugates; and Tissue Factor
conjugates and constructs are currently preferred. Compositions comprising one or
more anti-PS antibodies operatively attached to one or more Tissue Factor derivatives,
preferably, truncated Tissue Factor, are currently particularly preferred.
[0139] Direct or indirect attachment and linkages may be employed in the binding ligand
compositions, including all variations of bispecific antibodies. Operative combinations
of a first antigen-binding region of an antibody that binds to an aminophospholipid,
with a second antigen-binding region of an antibody that binds Tissue Factor or a
Tissue Factor derivative are also preferred. In the aminophospholipid binding protein
constructs or conjugates, annexins are preferred, with Annexin V being more preferred,
and Annexin V operatively attached to truncated Tissue Factor currently being most
preferred.
[0140] Components of the invention therefore include an antibody construct, comprising at
least a first anti-aminophospholipid antibody, or antigen-binding fragment thereof,
operatively attached to at least a first therapeutic agent; and a bispecific antibody,
comprising a first antigen-binding region that binds to an aminophospholipid operatively
attached to a second antigen-binding region that binds to a therapeutic agent.
[0141] The compositions and pharmaceutical compositions may comprise at least a first and
second binding ligand that each comprise at least a first targeting agent operatively
attached to at least a first therapeutic agent; wherein each targeting agent binds
to an aminophospholipid. Compositions and pharmaceutical compositions that comprise
at least a first binding ligand that binds to phosphatidylethanolamine and at least
a second binding ligand that binds to phosphatidylscrine are exemplary combined compositions.
[0142] The present invention yet further provides a series of novel therapeutic kits, medicaments
and/or cocktails for use in conjunction with the methods. The kits, medicaments and/or
cocktails generally comprise a combined effective amount of an anti-cancer agent and
a therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct, preferably one that binds to phosphatidylserine
or phosphatidylethanolamine. Imaging components may also be included.
[0143] The kits and medicaments will comprise, preferably in suitable container means, a
biologically effective amount of at least a first therapeutic agent-targeting agent
construct, preferably binding to phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylethanolamine; in
combination with a biologically effective amount of at least a first anti-cancer agent.
The components of the kits and medicaments may be comprised within a single container
or container means, or comprised within distinct containers or container means. The
cocktails will generally be admixed together for combined use.
[0144] The entire range of therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct, as described above,
may be employed in the kits, medicaments and/or cocktails, with annexin conjugates
and constructs; anti-PS, anti-PE, human, humanized and monoclonal antibody conjugates
and constructs; ricin conjugates; and Tissue Factor conjugates and constructs being
preferred. The anti-cancer agents arc also those as described above, including chemotherapeutic
agents, radiotherapeutic agents, anti-angiogenic agents, apoptopic agents, immunotoxins
and coaguligands. Agents formulated for intravenous administration will often be preferred.
BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
[0145] The following drawings form part of the present specification and are included to
further demonstrate certain aspects of the present invention. The invention may be
better understood by reference to one or more of these drawings in combination with
the detailed description of specific embodiments presented herein.
[0146] FIG. 1A and
FIG. 1B. Activity of cell-bound anti-VCAM-1•tTF
in vitro.
FIG. 1A. Binding of anti-VCAM-1•tTF coaguligand to unstimulated (control) and IL-1α-activated
bEnd.3 cells.
FIG. 1B. Generation of factor Xa by cell-bound anti-VCAM-1•tTF coaguligand.
[0147] FIG. 2. Retardation of growth of L540 tumors in mice treated with anti-VCAM-1•tTF. L540 tumor
hearing mice were injected i.v. with either saline, 20 µg of anti-VCAM-1•tTF, 4 µg
of unconjugated tTF or 20 µg of control IgG•tTF. Injections were repeated on day 4
and 8 after the first treatment. Tumors were measured daily. Mean tumor volume and
SD of 8 mice per group is shown.
[0148] FIG. 3. Annexin V blocks coaguligand activation of Factor X
in vitro. IL-1α-stimulated bEnd.3 cells were incubated with anti-VCAM-•tTF coaguligand in 96-well
microtiter plates, as described in Example V. Annexin V was added at concentrations
ranging from 0.1 to 10 µg/ml (as shown) and cells were incubated for 30 min. before
addition of diluted Proplex T. The amount of Factor Xa generated in the presence or
absence of Annexin V was determined using a chromogenic substrate. as described in
Example V.
[0149] FIG. 4A and
FIG. 4B. Anti-tumor effects of naked anti-PS antibodies in animals with syngeneic and xenogeneic
tumors. 1x10
7 cells of murine colorectal carcinoma Colo 26
(FIG. 4A) or human Hodgkin's lymphoma L540
(FIG. 4B) were injected subcutaneously into the right flank of Balb/c mice
(FIG. 4A) or male CB17 SCID mice
(FIG. 4B), respectively. Tumors were allowed to grow to a size of about 0.6-0.9 cm
3 and then the mice (4 animals per group) were injected i.p. with 20 µg of naked anti-PS
antibody (open squares) or saline (open circles) (control mouse IgM gave similar results
to saline.). Treatment was repeated 3 times with a 48 hour interval. Animals were
monitored daily for tumor measurements and body weight. Tumor volume was calculated
as described in Example VII. Mice were sacrificed when tumors had reached 2 cm
3, or earlier if tumors showed signs of necrosis or ulceration.
DESCRIPTION OF ILLUSTRATIVE EMBODIMENTS
A. Tumor Destruction using VCAM-1 Coaguligand
[0150] Solid tumors and carcinomas account for more than 90% of all cancers in man. Although
the use of monoclonal antibodies and immunotoxins has been investigated in the therapy
of lymphomas and leukemias (Vitetta
et al., 1991), these agents have been disappointingly ineffective in clinical trials against
carcinomas and other solid tumors (Abrams and Oldham, 1985). A principal reason for
the ineffectiveness of antibody-based treatments is that macromolecules are not readily
transported into solid tumors. Even once within a tumor mass, these molecules fail
to distribute evenly due to the presence of tight junctions between tumor cells, fibrous
stroma, interstitial pressure gradients and binding site barriers (Dvorak
et al., 1991).
[0151] In developing new strategies for treating solid tumors, the methods that involve
targeting the vasculature of the tumor, rather than the tumor cells, offer distinct
advantages. An effective destruction or blockade of the tumor vessels arrests blood
flow through the tumor and results in an avalanche of tumor cell death. Antibody-toxin
and antibody-coagulant constructs have already been effectively used in the specific
targeting and destruction of tumor vessels, resulting in tumor necrosis (Burrows
et al., 1992; Burrows and Thorpe, 1993; WO 93/17715; WO 96/01653; U.S. Patents 5,855,866;
5,877,289; 5,965,132, 6,004,555, and 6,093,399).
[0152] Where antibodies, growth factors or other binding ligands are used to specifically
deliver a coagulant to the tumor vasculature, such agents are termed "coaguligands".
A currently preferred coagulant for use in coaguligands is truncated Tissue Factor
(tTF) (Huang
et al., 1997; WO 96/01653; U.S. Patcnt 5,877,289). TF is the major initiator of blood coagulation
(Ruf
et al., 1991). At sites of injury, Factor VII/VIIa in the blood comes into contact with,
and binds to, TF on cells in the perivascular tissues. The TF:VIIa complex, in the
presence of the phospholipid surface, activates factors IX and X. This, in turn, leads
to the formation of thrombin and fibrin and, ultimately, a blood clot (Ruf and Edgington,
1994).
[0153] The recombinant, truncated form of tissue factor (tTF), lacking the cytosolic and
transmembrane domains, is a soluble protein that has about five orders of magnitude
lower coagulation inducing ability than native TF (Stone
et al., 1995; Huang
et al., 1997). This is because TF needs to be associated with phospholipids for the complex
with VIIa to activate IXa or Xa efficiently. However, when tTF is delivered to tumor
vascular endothelium by means of a targeting antibody or agent, it is brought back
into proximity to a lipid surface and regains thrombogenic activity (Huang
et al., 1997; U.S. Patents 5,877,289, 6,004,555 and 6,093,399). A coaguligand is thus created
that selectively thromboses tumor vasculature.
[0154] Truncated TF has several advantages that commend its use in vascular targeted coaguligands:
human tTF is readily available, and the human protein will have negligible or low
immunogenicity in man; human tTF is fully functional in experimental animals, including
mice; and targeted tTF is highly potent because it triggers the activation of a cascade
of coagulation proteins, giving a greatly amplified effect (U.S. Patents 5,877,289,
6,004,555 and 6,093,399).
[0155] A range of suitable target molecules that arc available on tumor endothelium, but
largely absent from normal endothelium, have been described. For example, expressed
targets may be utilized, such as endoglin, E-sclectin, P-selectin, VCAM-1, ICAM-1,
PSMA, a TIE, a ligand reactive with LAM-1, a VEGF/VPF receptor, an FGF receptor, α
vβ
3 integrin, pleiotropin or endosialin (U.S. Patents 5,855,866; 5,5,877,289 and 5,
,
; corresponding to U.S. Serial No. 08/487,427; Burrows
el al., 1992; Burrows and Thorpe, 1993; Huang
et al., 1997; Liu
et al., 1997; Ohizumi
et al., 1997).
[0156] Adsorbed targets are another suitable group, such as VEGF, FGF, TGFβ, HGF, PF4, PDGF,
TIMP, a ligand that binds to a TIE or a tumor-associated fibronectin isoform (U.S.
Patents 5,877,289; 5,965,132 and 6,004,555). Fibronectin isoforms are ligands that
bind to the integrin family of receptors. Tumor-associated fibronectin isoforms are
targetable components of both tumor vasculature and tumor stroma. The monoclonal antibody
BC-1 (Carnemolla
et al., 1989) specifically binds to tumor-associated fibronectin isoforms.
[0157] Other targets inducible by the natural tumor environment or following intervention
by man are also targetable entities, as described in U.S. Patent Nos. 5,776,427, 5,863,538
and 6,036,955. When used in conjunction with prior suppression in normal tissues and
tumor vascular induction, MHC Class II antigens may also be employed as targets (U.S.
Patent Nos. 5,776,427; 5,863,538; 6,004,554 and 6,036,955).
[0158] One currently preferred target for clinical applications is vascular endothelial
adhesion molecule-I (VCAM-1) (U.S. Patents 5,855,866, 5,877,289, 6,004,555 and 6,093,399).
VCAM-1 is a cell adhesion molecule that is induced by inflammatory cytokines IL-1α.
IL-4 (Thomhill
et al., 1990) and TNFα (Munro, 1993) and whose role
in vivo is to recruit lcukocytes to sites of acute inflammation (Bevilacqua. 1993).
[0159] VCAM-1 is present on vascular endothelial cells in a number of human malignant tumors
including neuroblastoma (Patey
et al., 1996), renal carcinoma (Droz
et al., 1994), non-small lung carcinoma (Staal-van den Brekel
et al., 1996), Hodgkin's disease (Patey
et al., 1996), and angiosarcoma (Kuzu
et al., 1993), as well as in benign tumors, such as angioma (Patey
et al., 1996) and hemangioma (Kuzu
et al., 1993). Constitutive expression of VCAM-1 in man is confined to a few vessels in the
thyroid, thymus and kidney (Kuzu
et al., 1993; Bruijn and Dinklo, 1993), and in the mouse to vessels in the heart and lung
(Fries
et al., 1993).
[0160] Certain of the data presented herein even further supplement those provided in U.S.
Patents 5,855,866, 5,877,289 and 6,004,555 and show the selective induction of thrombosis
and tumor infarction resulting from administration of an anti-VCAM-1•tTF coaguligand.
The results presented were generated using mice bearing L540 human Hodgkin lymphoma.
When grown as a xenograft in SCID mice, this tumor shows close similarity to the human
disease with respect to expression of inflammatory cytokines (Diehl
et al., 1985) and the presence of VCAM-1 and other endothelial cell activation molecules
on its vasculature.
[0161] Using a covalently-linked anti-VCAM-1•tTF coaguligand, in which tTF was directly
linked to the anti-VCAM-1 antibody, it is shown herein that the coaguligand localizes
selectively to tumor vessels, induces thrombosis of those vessels, causes necrosis
to develop throughout the tumor and retards tumor growth in mice bearing solid L540
Hodgkin tumors. Tumors generally needed to be at least about 0.3 cm in diameter to
respond to the coaguligand, because VCAM-1 was absent from smaller tumors. Presumably,
in small tumors, the levels of cytokines secreted by tumor cells or host cells that
infiltrate the tumor are too low for VCAM-1 induction. This is in accordance with
the studies in U.S. Patents 5,855,866, 5,877,289, 5,776,427, 6,004,555 and 6,036,955
where the inventions were shown to be most useful in larger solid tumors.
[0162] Although VCAM-1 staining was initially observed more in the periphery of the tumor,
the coaguligand evidently bound to and occluded blood transporting vessels - - as
it was capable of curtailing blood flow in all tumor regions. Furthermore, one of
the inventors contemplates that the thrombin generation caused by the initial administration
of the coaguligand likely leads to further VCAM-1 induction on central vessels (Sluiter
et al., 1993), resulting in an amplified signal and evident destruction of the intratumoral
region. This type of coagulant-induced expression of further targetable markers, and
hence signal amplification, is also disclosed in U.S. Patent 6,036,955.
B. Mechanism of VCAM-1-Targeted Tumor Destruction
[0163] As shown herein, although localization to VCAM-1-expressing vessels in the heart
and lungs of mice was observed upon administration of an anti-VCAM-1 coaguligand,
this construct did not induce thrombosis in such non-tumor sites. Furthermore, the
anti-VCAM-1 coaguligand was no more toxic to mice than was a control coaguligand of
irrelevant specificity, again indicating that the constitutive expression of VCAM-1
on heart and lung vessels did not lead to toxicity. This data is important to the
immediate clinical progress of coaguligand therapy, given that VCAM-1 is a naturally
occurring marker of tumor vascular endothelium in humans. However, this phenomenon
also provided the inventors with a unique insight, leading to other approaches for
tumor vasculature destruction.
[0164] The inventors sought to understand the mechanism behind the ability of the anti-VCAM-1
coaguligand to bind to the VCAM-1 constitutively expressed on blood vessels in the
heart and lungs, and yet not to cause thrombosis in those vessels. There are numerous
scientific possibilities for this empirical observation, generally connected with
the prothrombotic nature of the tumor environment any fibrinolytic predisposition
in the heart and lungs.
[0165] Generally, there is a biological equilibrium between the coagulation system (fibrin
deposition) and the fibrinolytic system (degradation of fibrin by enzymes). However,
in malignant disease, particularly carcinomas, this equilibrium is disrupted, resulting
in the abnormal activation of coagulation (hypercoagulability or the "prothrombotic
state"). Evidence also indicates that various components of these pathways may contribute
to the disorderly characteristics of malignancy, such as proliferation, invasion,
and metastasis (Zacharski
et al., 1993).
[0166] Donati (1995) reviewed the complex interplay between the original clinical observations
of thrombotic complications of malignant diseases, and the subsequent progress in
the cell biology and biochemistry of tumor cell activities. However, despite extensive
research, a clear molecular explanation for the prothrombotic nature of the tumor
environment could not be provided (Donati, 1995). Donati did emphasize, though, the
role of tumor cells in this process. It was explained that tumor cells express procoagulant
activities, such as tissue thromboplastin and cancer procoagulant (CP) (Donati, 1995).
WO 91/07187 also reported a procoagulant activity of tumor cells.
[0167] Numerous other studies have also identified the tumor cells themselves as being responsible
for the prothrombotic state within a tumor. For example, Nawroth
et al. (1988) reported that factor(s) elaborated by sarcoma cells enhance the procoagulant
response of nearby endothelium to TNF. These authors reported that fibrin formation
occurred throughout the tumor vascular bed 30 minutes after TNF infusion, but that
fibrin deposition and platelet aggregates were not observed in normal vasculature
(Nawroth
et al., 1988). TNF was later shown to enhance the expression of tissue factor on the surface
of endothelial cells (Murray
et al., 1991). This was proposed to explain earlier studies showing that cultured endothelial
cells incubated with recombinant TNF have enhanced procoagulant activity, tissue factor,
and concomitant suppression of the protein C pathway, an anti-thrombotic mechanism
that functions on the surface of quiescent endothelial cells (Nawroth
et al., 1985; Nawroth and Stern, 1986).
[0168] Data from Sugimura
et al. (1994) also implicated tumor cells as the key components of the procoagulant activity
of the tumor. It was reported that four tumor cell lines were able to support different
stages of the extrinsic pathway of coagulation (Sugimura
et al., 1994). Another study reported that a human ovarian carcinoma cell line, OC-2008,
constitutively expressed surface membrane Tissue Factor activity and exhibited cell
surface-dependent prothrombinase complex activity (Rao
et al., 1992). Connor
et al. (1989) further suggested that it is the pathologic cells that control coagulation.
Their results indicated that tumorigenic, undifferentiated murine crythroleukemic
cells exhibit a 7- to 8-fold increase in the potency of their procoagulant activity
(Connor
et al., 1989).
[0169] Zacharski
et al. (1993) also focused on tumor cells and sought to define the mode of interaction of
ovarian carcinoma cells with the coagulation (procoagulant-initiated) and fibrinolysis
(urokinase-type plasminogen activator-initiated, u-PA) pathways. They reported that
tumor cells expressed Tissue Factor and coagulation pathway intermediates that resulted
in local thrombin generation - - as evidenced by the conversion of fibrinogen, present
in tumor connective tissue, to fibrin that was found to hug the surfaces of tumor
nodules and individual tumor cells. Detected fibrin could not be accounted for on
the basis of necrosis or a local inflammatory cell infiltrate (Zacharski
et al., 1993). These authors concluded that there exists a dominant tumor cell-associated
procoagulant pathway that leads to thrombin generation and hypercoagulability.
[0170] Other hypotheses have proposed that it is changes in the tumor blood vessels that
render these vessels better able to support the formation of thrombi and/or less able
to dissolve fibrin. For example, tumor vessels have been reported to exhibit upregulation
of Tissue Factor, down-regulation of plasminogen activators and/or upregulation of
the inhibitor of plasminogen activators, PAI-1 (Nawroth and Stern, 1986; Nawroth
et al., 1988). Such effects are believed to be magnified by tumor derived factors (Murray
et al., 1991: Ogawa
et al., 1990), possibly VEGF.
[0171] For example. Ogawa
et al. (1990) reported that hypoxia caused endothelial cell surface coagulant properties
to be shifted to promote activation of coagulation. This was accompanied by suppression
of the anticoagulant cofactor, thrombomodulin, and induction of an activator of factor
X, distinct from the classical extrinsic and intrinsic systems (Ogawa
et al., 1990). Also, there could be an increase in the local concentration of Factors VIIa,
IXa, Xa, or other molecules that interact with TF, within the tumor vessels, thus
encouraging thrombosis.
[0172] Additionally, platelets are a major component of any procoagulant state. Recently.
the procoagulant potential of platelets has been linked to their ability to shed procoagulant
microparticles from the plasma membrane (Zwaal
et al., 1989; 1992; Dachary-Prigent
et al., 1996). It has been proposed that an increased proportion of circulating microparticles,
vesicles or membrane fragments from platelets contributes to 'prethrombotic' (prothrombotic)
states in various pathological conditions (Zwaal
et al., 1989; 1992; Dachary-Prigent
et al., 1996, pp. 159 and references cited therein). McNeil et al. (1990) also reported that
β
2-GPI exerts multiple inhibitory effects on coagulation and platelet aggregation. Tumor
platelet biology could thus explain the effectiveness of the anti-VCAM-1 coaguligand.
[0173] Further tenable explanations include the simple possibility that VCAM-1 is expressed
at higher levels in tumor vessels than on blood vessels in the heart and lungs, probably
due to induction by tumor-derived cytokines, and that binding to the healthy vessels
cannot tip the balance into sustained thrombosis. Also the fibrinolytic mechanisms
could be upregulated in the heart, as exemplified by increased Tissue Factor pathway
inhibitor (TFPI), increased plasminogen activators, and/or decreased plasminogen activator
inhibitors. Should the fibrinolytic physiology of the heart and lung vessels prove
to be the major reason underlying the tumor-specific effects of the anti-VCAM-1 coaguligand,
this would generally preclude the development of additional anti-tumor therapies targeted
to unique aspects of tumor biology.
[0174] Despite all the possible options, the inventors reasoned that the failure of the
anti-VCAM-1 coaguligand to cause thrombosis in vessels of normal tissues was due to
the absence of the aminophospholipid, phosphatidylserine (PS), from the luminal surface,
of such vessels. To complete the theory, therefore, not only would phosphatidylserine
have to be shown to be absent from these normal vessels, but its presence on the luminal
side of tumor-associated vessels would have to be conclusively demonstrated.
[0175] The inventors therefore used immunohistochemical staining to evaluate the distribution
of a monoclonal anti-phosphatidylserine (anti-PS) antibody injected intravenously
into tumor-bearing mice. These studies revealed that the VCAM-1 expressing vessels
in the heart and lungs lacked PS, whereas the VCAM-1 expressing vessels in the tumor
expressed PS. The need for surface PS expression in coaguligand action is further
indicated by the inventors finding that annexin V, which binds to PS. blocks anti-VCAM-
1•tTF coaguligand action, both
in vitro and
in vivo.
[0176] The lack of thrombotic effect of the anti-VCAM-1 coaguligand on normal heart and
lung vessels can thus be explained. at least in part: the absence of the aminophospholipid,
phosphatidylserine, means that the normal vessels lack a procoagulant surface upon
which coagulation complexes can assemble. In the absence of surface PS, anti-VCAM-1•tTF
binds to VCAM-1 expressing heart and lung vessels, but cannot induce thrombosis. In
contrast, VCAM-1 expressing vessels in the tumor show coincident expression of surface
PS. The coaguligand thus binds to tumor vessels and activates coagulation factors
locally to form an occlusive thrombus.
[0177] In addition to delineating the tumor-specific thrombotic effects of anti-VCAM-1 coaguligands,
the specific expression of the aminophospholipid. phosphatidylserine, on the luminal
surface of tumor blood vessels also allowed the inventors to explain the prothrombotic
phenotype observed, but not understood, in earlier studies (Zacharski
et al., 1993: Donati, 1995). Rather than being predominantly due to tumor cells or elaborated
factors; platelets, procoagulant microparticles or membrane fragments; or due to imbalances
in thromboplastin, thrombomodulin, cancer procoagulant, Tissue Factor, protein C pathway,
plasminogen activators or plasminogen activator inhibitors (
e.g., PAI-1), the inventors' studies indicate that it is PS expression that plays a significant
role in the prothrombotic state of tumor vasculature.
C. Aminophospholipids as Markers of Tumor Vasculature
[0178] Following their discovery that the representative aminophospholipid. phosphatidylserine,
was specifically expressed on the luminal surface of tumor blood vessels, but not
in normal blood vessels, the inventors reasoned that aminophospholipids had potential
as targets for therapeutic intervention. The present invention therefore provides
compositions and methods for the targeted delivery of therapeutic agents to aminophospholipid
membrane constituents, particularly phosphatidylserine (PS) and phosphatidylethanolamine
(PE). Although anti-tumor effects from aminophospholipid-targeted delivery are demonstrated
herein, using art-accepted animal models, the ability of aminophospholipids to act
as safe and effective targetable markers of tumor vasculature could not have been
predicted from previous studies.
[0179] For example, although tumor vessels are generally prothrombotic in nature, as opposed
to other blood vessels, it is an inherent property of the tumor to maintain a network
of blood vessels in order to deliver oxygen and nutrients to the tumor cells. Evidently,
tumor-associated blood vessels cannot be so predisposed towards thrombosis that they
spontaneously and readily support coagulation, as such coagulation would necessarily
cause the tumor to self-destruct. It is thus unexpected that any thrombosis-associated
tumor vessel marker, such as the presently identified phosphatidylserine, could be
discovered that is expressed in quantities sufficient to allow effective therapeutic
intervention by targeting, and yet is expressed at levels low enough to ordinarily
maintain blood flow through the tumor.
[0180] The present identification of aminophospholipids as safe and effective tumor vasculature
targets is even more surprising given (1) the previous speculations regarding the
role of other cell types and/or various factors, activators and inhibitors underlying
the complex, prothrombotic state of the tumor (as discussed above); and (2) the confusing
and contradictory state of the art concerning aminophospholipid biology, in terms
of both expression and function in various cell types.
[0181] Phosphatidylserine and phosphatidylethanolamine are normally segregated to the inner
surface of the plasma membrane bilayer in different cells (Gaffet
et al., 1995; Julien
et al., 1995). In contrast, the outer leaflet of the bilayer membrane is rich in phosphatidylcholine
analogs (Zwaal
et al., 1989; Gaffet
et al., 1995). This lipid segregation creates an asymmetric transbilayer.. Although the
existence of membrane asymmetry has been discussed for some time, the reason for its
existence and the mechanisms for its generation and control are poorly understood
(Williamson and Schlegel, 1994), particularly in cells other than platelets.
[0182] There are even numerous conflicting reports regarding the presence or absence of
PS and PE in different cells and tissues, let alone concerning the likely role that
these aminophospholipids may play. For example, the many PS studies conducted with
platelets, key components in blood coagulation (Dachary-Prigent
et al., 1996). have yielded highly variable results. Bevers
et al. (1982) measured the platelet prothrombin-converting activity of non-activated platelets
after treatment with various phospholipases or proteolytic enzymes. They concluded
that negatively charged phosphatidylserine, and possibly phosphatidylinositol, were
involved in the prothrombin-converting activity of non-activated platelets (Bevers
et al., 1982).
[0183] Bevers
et al. (1983) then reported an increased exposure of phosphatidylserine, and a decreased exposure
of sphingomyelinase, in activated platelets. However, these alterations were much
less apparent in platelets activated either by thrombin or by collagen alone, in contrast
to collagen plus thrombin. diamide, or a calcium ionophore (Bevers
et at., 1983). The surface expression of PS in response to diamide was contradicted by studies
in erythrocytes, which showed no diamide-stimulated PS exposure (de Jong
et al., 1997). While echoing their earlier results, Bevers and colleagues then later reported
that changes in the plasma membrane-cytoskeleton interaction, particularly increased
degradation of cytoskeletal actin-binding protein, was important to platelet surface
changes (Bevers
et al., 1985; pages 368-369).
[0184] Maneta-Peyret
et al. (1989) also reported the detection of PS on human platelets. These authors noted
that the platelet procoagulant surface could be formed by negatively charged phospholipids,
such as phosphatidylserine and phosphatidylethanolamine (generally neutral or zwitterionic),
or both. The role of phosphatidylserine in the process of coagulation has been questioned
in favor of phosphatidylethanolamine (Maneta-Peyret
et al., 1989; Schick
et al., 1976; 1978). For example, studies have reported that 18% of phosphatidylethanolamine
becomes surface-accessible after 2 hours, in contrast to zero phosphatidylserine (Schick
et al., 1976).
[0185] Ongoing studies with platelets were also reported as showing a further 16% increase
in phosphatidylethanolamine exposure after thrombin treatment, with no increase in
the phosphatidylserine levels (Schick
et al., 1976). Therefore, PS was said not to be a component of the functional surface of
the platelet plasma membrane (Schick
et al., 1976; 1978). Nonetheless, current evidence does seem to indicate that both PS and
PE are involved in the phospholipid asymmetry observed in the outer membrane of platelets
and erythrocytes, and that PS is involved in the procoagulant activity of platelets
(Gaffet
et al., 1995; de Jong
et al., 1997; U.S. Patent No. 5,627,036).
[0186] The mechanisms for achieving and maintaining differential aminophospholipid distribution,
let alone the functional significance of doing so, have long been the subject of controversial
speculations. In reviewing the regulation of transbilayer phospholipid movement, Williamson
and Schlegel (1994) indicated that elevating intracellular Ca
2+ allows the major classes of phospholipids to move freely across the bilayer, scrambling
lipids and dissipating asymmetry de Jong
et al. (1997) also reported that an increase of intracellular calcium leads to a rapid scrambling
of the lipid bilayer and the exposure of PS, which could be partially inhibited by
cellular oxidation. The interaction of aminophospholipids with cytoskeletal proteins
has also been proposed as a mechanism for regulating membrane phospholipid asymmetry
(Zwaal
et al., 1989).
[0187] Gaffet
et al. (1995) stated that the transverse redistribution of phospholipids during human platelet
activation is achieved by a vectorial outflux of aminophospholipids. not counterbalanced
by a rapid reciprocal influx of choline head phospholipids,
i.e. not scrambling. They suggested that the specific vectorial outflux of aminophospholipids
could be catalyzed by a "reverse aminophospholipid translocase" activity (Gaffet
et al., 1995). An alternative hypothesis would be that the activity of an inward translocase
was inhibited. Zwaal
et al. (1989) proposed the involvement of a phospholipid-translocase that catalyzed both
the outward and inward movement of aminophospholipids.
[0188] The presence of an energy- and protein-dependent aminophospholipid translocase activity
that transports phosphatidylethanolamine from the outer to the inner leaflet of the
lipid bilayer was reported by Julien
et al. (1993). They then showed that the aminophospholipid translocase activity could also
transfer phosphatidylserine, and that the activity could be maintained, suppressed
and restored depending on the conditions of cell incubation (Julien
et al., 1993), and inhibited by the tumor promoter, 12-
O-tetradecanoylphorbol-13-acetate (TPA) (Julien
et al., 1997).
[0189] A 35 kD phospholipid scramblase that promotes the Ca
2+-dependent bidirectional movement of phosphatidylserine and other phospholipids was
recently cloned from a cDNA library (Zhou
et al., 1997). This "PL scramblase" protein is a proline-rich, type II plasma membrane
protein with a single transmembrane segment near the C terminus. Subsequent studies
confirmed that this protein was responsible for the rapid movement of phospholipids
from the inner to the outer plasma membrane leaflets in cells exposed to elevated
cytosolic calcium concentrations (Zhao
et al., 1998).
[0190] The aminophospholipid translocase activity reported by Julien
et al. (1993; 1997), which transports PS and PE from the outer to the inner leaflet, is
different to the bidirectional Ca
2--dependent scramblase (Zhou
et al., 1997; Zhao
et al., 1998). The scramblase is activated by Ca
2+, and mostly functions to move PS from the inner to the outer leaflet in response
to increased Ca
2+ levels. It is now generally believed that the aminophospholipid translocase maintains
membrane asymmetry during normal conditions, but that the scramblase is activated
by Ca
2+ influx, over-riding the translocase and randomizing aminophospholipid distribution.
[0191] The normal segregation of PS and PE to the inner surface of the plasma membrane is
thus now generally accepted, and certain membrane components involved in the asymmetric
processes have even been identified. However, doubts remain about the conditions,
mechanisms and cell types that are capable of re-locating aminophospholipids to the
outer leaflet of the membrane, and the biological implications of such events.
[0192] Contradictory reports concerning aminophospholipid expression are not limited to
studies of platelets. Phosphatidylserine and phosphatidylethanolamine are generally
about 7% and about 10%, respectively, of the phospholipid composition of cultured
human endothelial cells from human artery, saphenous and umbilical vein (7.1% and
10.2%, respectively; Murphy
et al., 1992). However, an important example of the contradictions in the literature concerns
the ability of anti-PS antibodies to bind to endothelial cells (Lin
et al., 1995).
[0193] The anti-PS antibodies present in recurrent pregnancy loss (Rote
et al., 1995; Rote, 1996; Vogt
et al., 1996: Vogt
et al., 1997) were believed to modulate endothelial cell function, without evidence of binding
to endothelial cells. In an attempt to explain this discrepancy, Lin
et al. (1995) tried but failed to demonstrate anti-PS antibody binding to resting endothelial
cells. They concluded that PS antigenic determinants are not expressed on the surface
of resting endothelial cells, although a PS-dependent antigenic determinant was associated
with cytoskeletal-like components in acetone-fixed cells (Lin
et al., 1995).
[0194] Van Heerde
et al. (1994) reported that vascular endothelial cells
in vitro can catalyze the formation of thrombin by the expression of binding sites at which
procoagulant complexes can assemble. In contrast to other studies with activated platelets
(Bevers
et al., 1982; 1983: 1985: Maneta-Peyret
et al., 1989; Schick
et al., 1976; 1978), stimulated HUVEC endothelial cells did not exhibit an increase in
PS binding sites as compared to quiescent cells (Van Heerde
et al., 1994). Phosphatidylserine was reported to be necessary for Factor Xa formation
via the extrinsic as well as the intrinsic route (Van Heerde
et al., 1994). Nonetheless, Brinkman
et al. (1994) published contradictory results, indicating that other membrane constituents
besides negatively charged phospholipids are involved in endothelial cell mediated,
intrinsic activation of factor X.
[0195] Ravanat
et al. (1992) also studied the catalytic potential of phospholipids in pro- and anti-coagulant
reactions in purified systems and at the surface of endothelial cells in culture after
stimulation. Their seemingly contradictory results were proposed to confirm a role
for phospholipid-dependent mechanisms in both procoagulant Tissue-Factor activity
and anticoagulant activities (activation of protein C by the thrombin-thrombomodulin
complex and by Factor Xa) (Ravanat
et al., 1992). The Ravanat
et al. (1992) results were also said to provide evidence of phospholipid exposure during
activation of human endothelial cells, which was not observed by Van Heerde
et al, (1994) or Brinkman
et al. (1994). However, they did note that anionic phospholipids are of restricted accessibility
in the vicinity of cellular Tissue Factor. The situation is further complicated as.
even after Tissue Factor induction, other events are likely necessary for coagulation.
as the Tissue Factor remains inaccessible, being under the cell.
[0196] Ravanat
et al. (1992) went on to suggest that the different extent of inhibition of Tissue Factor
and thrombomodulin activities on stimulated endothelial cells means that the cofactor
environments differ for the optimal expression of these opposite cellular activities.
However, the acknowledged difficulties in trying to reproduce exact cellular phospholipid
environments (Ravanat
et al., 1992), raise the possibility of artifactual data from these
in vitro studies. Indeed, irrespective of the Ravanat
et al. (1992) data, it is generally acknowledged that meaningful information regarding
tumor biology, and particularly therapeutic intervention, can only be gleaned from
in vivo studies in tumor-bearing animals, such as those conducted by the present inventors.
[0197] In addition to the disagreements regarding aminophospholipid expression, as discussed
above, there are also conflicting reports concerning the function of aminophospholipids
in various cell types. Although it is now generally accepted that PS expression on
activated platelets is connected with the procoagulant surface, in discussing the
physiological significance of membrane phospholipid asymmetry in platelets and red
blood cells, Zwaal
et al. (1989) highlighted other important functions. Moreover, Toti
et al. (1996) stated that the physiological implications of a loss of asymmetric phospholipid
distribution remain poorly understood in cell types other than blood cells.
[0198] Zwaal
et al. (1989) stated that the membrane phospholipid asymmetry of platelets and red cells
is undone when the cells are activated in various ways, presumably mediated by the
increased transbilayer movement of phospholipids. These changes, coupled with the
release of shed microparticles, were explained to play a role in local blood clotting
reactions. A similar phenomenon was described to occur in sickled red cells: phospholipid
vesicles breaking off from reversibly sickled cells contribute to intravascular clotting
in the crisis phase of sickle cell disease (Zwaal
et al., 1989)
[0199] Both Zwaal
et al. (1989) and Williamson and Schlegel (1994) have indicated that the physiological significance
of surface phospholipid changes is not restricted to hemostasis. In fact, the surface
exposure of PS by blood cells was said to significantly alter their recognition by
the reticuloendothelial system, and was to likely represent at least part of the homeostatic
mechanism for the clearance of blood cells from the circulation (Zwaal
et al., 1989). Thus, PS acts as a signal for the elimination of activated platelets after
bleeding has stopped. Recognition of PS exposed on sickle cells and malarially infected
cells by phagocytes and macrophages explains their counter-pathophysiological effects
(Zwaal
et al., 1989). Furthermore, PS-dependent phagocytosis marks virally infected cells for
phagocytic uptake (WO 97/17084). The surface expression of aminophospholipids could
also confer "fusion competence" to a cell (Williamson and Schlegel, 1994).
[0200] Williamson and Schlegel (1994) also speculated that there is a more general
raison d'être for lipid asymmetry. For example, although the different head groups have received
most attention. it could well be that fatty acid asymmetry is the important factor
(Williamson and Schlegel, 1994). A further hypothesis is that the asymmetric distribution
of transbilayer phospholipids has no function in itself, but that it is the dynamic
process of lipid movement that is important to biological systems (Williamson and
Schlegel, 1994).
[0201] Many groups have reported that tumor cells are responsible for the prothrombinase
activity of the tumor (Connor
et al., 1989; Rao
et al., 1992; Zacharski
et al., 1993; Sugimura
et al., 1994; Donati, 1995). This could have been reasoned to be due to PS (WO 91/07187).
However, the results of Sugimura
et al. (1994) argue against this: they reported that although both the prothrombinase activity
and total procoagulant activity of the tumorigenic cells, HepG2 and MKN-28, fell on
reaching confluency, the PS levels remained constant.
[0202] Rather than supporting a role for tumor cell PS in prothrombinase activity, Connor
et al. (1989) suggested that the increased expression of PS in tumorigenic cells is relevant
to their ability to be recognized and bound by macrophages. Utsugi
et al. (1991) similarly proposed that the presence of PS in the outer membrane of human
tumor cells explains their recognition by monocytes.
[0203] Jamasbi
et al. (1994) suggested a totally different role for lipid components in tumorigenic cells,
proposing that the lipids interfere with tumor antigen accessibility. Thus, tumor
cell lipids would act to modify the tumor cell surface antigen(s), thus protecting
the tumor cells from host immune destruction (Jamasbi
et al., 1994). This hypothesis is not unlike that proposed by Qu
et al. (1996), in terms of endothelial cells. These authors showed that T cells adhered
to thrombin-treated human umbilical endothelial cells by virtue of binding to PS (Qu
et al., 1996).
[0204] It has thus been proposed that PS-mediated T cell adhesion to endothelial cells
in vivo is important to both immune surveillance, and also to the disease processes of atherosclerosis
(Qu
et al., 1996; Moldovan
et al., 1994). Bombeli
et al. (1997) and Flynn
et al. (1997) also suggested that cells within atherosclerotic plaques may contribute to
disease progression by exposing PS, although this was based solely on
in vitro studies. Qu
et al. (1996) and Moldovan
et al. (1994) even hinted at an approach opposite to that of the present invention,
i.e., the manipulation of phosphatidylserine interactions as an anticoagulant approach.
U S Patent No. 5,658,877 and No. 5,296,467 have proposed annexin (or "annexine") for
use as anti-endotoxins and anti-coagulants. U.S. Patent No. 5,632,986 suggests the
use of the phosphatidylserine-binding ligand, annexin V, as a conjugate with a component,
such as urokinase, that lyses thrombi.
[0205] Toti
et al. (1996) suggested that Scott syndrome, an inherited bleeding disorder, may reflect
the deletion or mutation of a putative outward phosphatidylserine translocase or "scramblase".
Although an interesting notion, Stout
et al. (1997) later isolated a membrane protein from Scott erythrocytes that exhibited normal
PL scramblase activity when reconstituted in vesicles with exogenous PLs. It was suggested
that the defect in Scott syndrome is related to an altered interaction of Ca
2+ with PL scramblase on the endofacial surface of the cell membrane, due either to
an intrinsic constraint upon the protein, preventing interaction with Ca
2+ in situ, or due to an unidentified inhibitor or cofactor in the Scott cell that is dissociated
by detergent (Stout
et al., 1997).
[0206] More variable results have been reported in connection with the possible role of
PS in apoptosis. Williamson and Schlegel (1994) discussed the theme of PS as a marker
of programmed cell death (PCD or apoptosis). It is generally accepted that programmed
cell death, at least in the hematopoietic system, requires the phagocytic sequestration
of the apoptopic cells before the loss of membrane integrity or "rupture". The loss
of membrane asymmetry in apoptopic cells, and particularly the appearance of PS in
the external leaflet, was proposed to be the trigger for their recognition by phagocytic
macrophages (Williamson and Schlegel. 1994).
[0207] Martin
et al. (1995) further reported PS externalization to be an early and widespread event during
apoptosis of a variety of murine and human cell types. regardless of the initiating
stimulus. They also indicated that, under conditions in which the morphological features
of apoptosis were prevented (macromolecular synthesis inhibition, overexpression of
Bcl-2 or Abl), the appearance of PS on the external leaflet of the plasma membrane
was similarly prevented (Martin
et al., 1995).
[0208] However, other analyses argue against the Williamson and Schlegel (1994) and Martin
et al. (1995) proposals to some extent (Vermes
et al., 1995). Although these authors indicate that the translocation of PS to the outer
membrane surface is a marker of apoptosis, they reason that this is not unique to
apoptosis, but also occurs during cell necrosis. The difference between these two
forms of cell death is that during the initial stages of apoptosis the cell membrane
remains intact, while at the very moment that necrosis occurs the cell membrane loses
its integrity and becomes leaky. Therefore, according to this reasoning, PS expression
at the cell surface does not indicate apoptosis unless a dye exclusion assay has been
conducted to establish cell membrane integrity (Vermes
et al., 1995).
[0209] Nonetheless, the body of literature prior to the present invention does seem to indicate
that the appearance of PS on the outer surface of a cell identifies an apoptotic cell
and signals that cell's ingestion (Hampton
et al., 1996; WO 95/27903). Hampton
et al. (1996) concluded that while an elevation of intracellular Ca
2+ was an ineffective trigger of apoptosis in the cells investigated, extracellular
Ca
2+ was required for efficient PS exposure during apoptosis. In contrast, the proposal
of Martin
et al. (1995) that activation of an inside-outside PS translocase is an early widespread
event during apoptosis would seem to require at least some intracellular Ca
2+ (Zhou
et al., 1997; Zhao
et al., 1998).
[0210] Blankenberg
et al. (1998) very recently reported that annexin V, an endogenous human protein with a
high affinity for PS, can be used to concentrate at sites of apoptotic cell death
in vivo. Radiolabeled annexin V localized to sites of apoptosis in three models, including
acute cardiac allograft rejection (Blankenberg
et al., 1998). Staining of cardiac allografts for exogenously administered annexin V revealed
myocytes at the periphery of mononuclear infiltrates, of which only a few demonstrated
positive apoptotic nuclei.
[0211] Finally, the transbilayer movement of phospholipids in the plasma membrane has even
been analyzed in ram sperm cells, where the existence of a transverse segregation
of phospholipids has been implicated in the fertilization process (Müller
et al., 1994). Phospholipid asymmetry has thus been receiving increasing attention. although
a clear understanding of this phenomenon, or its relationship to health or disease,
has not been realized.
[0212] Irrespective of the confusing state of the art regarding aminophospholipid biology,
the present inventors discovered, in controlled
in vivo studies, that aminophospholipids, such as PS and PE, were specific markers of tumor
blood vessels. This is surprising in light of the earlier studies of aminophospholipid
function, particularly those indicating that the cell surface expression of PS is
accompanied by binding of circulating cells. such as T cells (Qu
et al., 1996), macrophages (Connor
et al., 1989), monocytes (Utsugi
et al., 1991) or phagocytes (Zwaal
et al., 1989; Williamson and Schlegel, 1994) and is a marker of apoptopic cells (Hampton
et al., 1996; Martin
et al., 1995; Zhou et
al., 1997; Zhao
et al., 1998).
[0213] Thus, prior to this invention, the possibility of using aminophospholipids as targetable
markers of any disease, let alone of tumor vasculature, would be unlikely to be contemplated,
due to the perceived masking of these molecules by the binding of one or more cell
types. In fact, speculative suggestions have concerned the disruption of PS-cellular
interactions, such as in preventing leukocyte binding, an initial event in atherosclerosis
(Qu
et al., 1996).
[0214] Other surprising aspects of this discovery are evident in a comparison to earlier
work concerning the shedding of procoagulant microparticles from plasma membranes
and the demarcation of cells for phagocytosis (WO 97/17084). Zwaal
et al. (1989; 1992) and Dachary-Prigent
et al. (1996) explained that PS translocation to the plasma membrane is followed by release
of microparticles, microvesicles or microspheres from the cells. Zwaal
et al. (1989) and Williamson and Schlegel (1994) indicated that PS surface expression prompts
clearance by the reticuloendothelial system. In light of these fates of PS-expressing
cells, and the various documented bilayer translocase activities (Julien
et al., 1995; Zhou
et al., 1997; Zhao
et al., 1998), it is surprising that cell surface aminophospholipids such as PS and PE can
form static and stable enough markers to allow antibody localization and binding.
[0215] Prior to the present invention, there was mounting evidence that surface PS appears
as part of the apoptopic process, marking cells for rapid destruction (Hampton
et al., 1996; Martin
et al., 1995). Therefore, although reasonable for use as a diagnostic marker for certain
disease states, such as graft rejection (Blankenberg
et al., 1998), the apparently limited life time of surface PS would also advise against
its use as a viable marker for targeting in therapeutic intervention.
[0216] Nonetheless. the present study did indeed discover aminophospholipids to be markers
of tumor vascular endothelial cells suitable for targeting. After postulating that
PS expression was necessary for VCAM coaguligand action, the presence of PS on tumor
blood vessels, but normal vessels, was demonstrated
in vivo. The
in vivo observations allowed the inventors to explain the safety and effectiveness of the
anti-VCAM coaguligands. This is due to the requirement for coincident expression of
a targeted marker (e.g., VCAM) and PS on tumor endothelium. Even if the target molecule
is present on endothelium in normal or pathological conditions, thrombosis will not
result if surface PS expression is lacking.
[0217] The value of the present invention is not limited to explaining coaguligand action,
nor to the surprising development of naked antibody therapies (provisional applications
Serial Nos. 60/092,672 and 60/110,608). In fact, the present discoveries have allowed
the inventors to show, for the first time, that PS translocation in endothelial cells
can occur without significant cell damage or cell death (Example XIV). In the inventors'
new model of tumor biology, the translocation of PS to the surface of tumor blood
vessel endothelial cells occurs, at least in a significant part, independently of
apoptopic or other cell-death mechanisms. Thus, PS surface expression in the tumor
environment is not a consequence of cell death, nor does it trigger immediate cell
destruction. This is of fundamental importance and represents a breakthrough in the
scientific understanding of PS biology, membrane translocation, cell signaling and
apoptosis pathways.
[0218] The separation of endothelial cell PS translocation from apoptosis (Example XIV)
is also integral to methods of therapeutic intervention based upon PS surface expression.
Should PS translocation to the outer membrane in tumor vascular endothelial cells
occur only in dying cells. or should it inevitably trigger cell death, then the PS
marker would not likely be sufficiently available to serve as a target for the delivery
of therapeutic agents. That is not to say that PS expression on certain tumor vascular
endothelial cells is not transient, and that turnover and cell death do not occur
in this endothelial cell population, but the finding that significant stable PS expression
can be achieved without cell death is a landmark discovery important to various fields
of biology and to the new targeted therapeutics described below.
D. Aminophospholipid-Targeted Therapeutics
[0219] The
in vivo aminophospholipid tumor vasculature expression studies further support the use of
coaguligands directed against previously identified tumor vasculature markers,
e.g., VCAM-1 and E-selectin, as selective thrombotic agents for the treatment of solid
tumors. However, these observations also led the inventors to develop additional tumor
treatment methods. For example, naked or unconjugated antibodies against aminophospholipid
components were surprisingly found to be capable of specifically inducing tumor blood
vessel destruction and tumor necrosis
in vivo in the absence of additional effector moieties. Such uses are disclosed and claimed
in WO-A-02584.
[0220] The studies of WO-A-02584 are in contrast to those recently reported by Nakamura
et al. (1998). These authors analyzed antibody fractions from patients with lupus anticoagulant
(LAC), a disorder associated with arterial and venous thrombosis, thrombocytopenia,
and recurrent fetal loss. Plasma with LAC activity was initially reported to induce
apoptosis in endothelial cells (Nakamura
et al., 1994). The apoptotic activities of LAC antisera were then reported to be localized
in an annexin V-binding antibody fraction in 10/10 patients studied (Nakamura
et al., 1998). As annexin binds to PS, the apparent ability of anti-anuexin antibodies to
induce apoptosis would be the opposite of the ability of an anti-PS antibody to induce
apoptosis.
[0221] The ability of LAC antibody fractions to induce apoptosis was further reported to
be inhibited by preincubation with annexin V (Nakamura
et al., 1998). In contrast, removal of anti-phospholipid antibodies from the patients' IgG
fractions with phospholipid liposomes did not abolish the apoptosis-inducing activities
or annexin V binding (Nakamura
et al., 1998). These results reasonably implied that patients with LAC often have antibodies
that do not bind phospholipids and yet are responsible for the induction of apoptosis
in endothelial cells (Nakamura
et al., 1998).
[0222] Without needing to equate the Nakamura
et al. (1998) LAC data with the inventors' observations from
in vivo studies of tumors and tumor vasculature, due to the evidently disparate nature of
these clinical conditions, the inventors nonetheless have certain unifying theories.
Nakamura
et al. (1998) attempted to remove antiphospholipid antibodies from patients' antisera using
phospholipid liposomes, and observed that this did not abolish the apoptosis-inducing
activity. These results led Nakamura
et al. (1998) to conclude that the anti-phospholipids antibodies cannot be responsible for
apoptopic activity. However, the present inventors now have the insight to suggest
that the incubation with phospholipid liposomes may not have removed the anti-phospholipids
antibodies from the antisera, as phospholipids are antigenically neutral in bilayer
and liposomal form, and largely only bind antibodies in hexagonal form (Rauch
et al., 1986; Rauch and Janoff, 1990; Berard
et al., 1993) or in association with membrane proteins. Thus, anti-phospholipids antibodies
may remain in the LAC antisera and may cause, or contribute to, the observed apoptopic
activity.
[0223] The invention disclosed herein is directed to aminophospholipids as targets for use
in anti-tumor vasculature immunotoxin and/or coaguligand therapy. Although the identification
of any additional target to allow specific tumor vessel localization in vascular targeting
therapies is valuable, the present discovery of aminophospholipids as suitable targets
is particularly important as it brings another entire group of targets into the picture:
lipids rather than the proteins previously preferred. The aminophospholipid discovery
is also functionally significant as it allows therapeutic agents to be delivered into
even more intimate contact with the target cell membrane, rather than binding to a
protein complex more distant from the membrane.
[0224] One of the most surprising aspects of the present discovery is that PS expression
on intact tumor-associated endothelial cells is sufficently stable to allow targeting.
The present
in vivo and
in vitro data definitively show that PS is expressed on viable tumor-associated endothelial
cells with normal morphology and intact cytoskeletons. As PS expression is not limited
to cells undergoing cell death or about to enter an apoptopic pathway, targeting with
diagnostic and therapeutic agents is both practicable and surprising (given that PS
expression was thought to be associated only with cell destruction).
[0225] A precise molecular understanding of exactly how and why aminophospholipid-targeted
therapeutic agents are suitable for use in tumor treatment is not necessary in order
to practice the present invention. Given that the administration of aminophospholipid-directed
therapeutic agents is herein shown to advantageously result in specific anti-tumor
effects
in vivo, the invention can be utilized irrespective of the molecular mechanisms that underlie
the aminophospholipid expression in tumor vasculature.
[0226] However, it is interesting to note that a review of the scientific literature to
date reveals features that argue against the present surprisingly effective uses,
and even proposes directly opposite uses for distinct aminophospholipid binding agent-conjugates.
For example, annexin, a phosphatidylserine binding protein, has itself been proposed
for use as an anticoagulant (WO 91/07187; U.S. patent No. 5,296,467). This use of
annexin was said to be based upon the inhibition of the procoagulant activity of tumor
cells (WO 91/07187).
[0227] Even more telling is the disclosure of U.S. Patent No. 5,632,986 which, in complete
contrast to the present invention, proposes the use of annexin as a conjugate with
compounds that lyse thrombi, or precursors of such thrombolytic compounds. The referenced
combination of an aminophospholipid binding protein, annexin, with a lytic agent is,
evidently, the opposite of the present invention, which concerns the combination of
annexin and other aminophospholipid binding proteins with agents that induce thrombosis,
either directly or indirectly.
[0228] In the preparation of both immunotoxins and coaguligands based upon aminophospholipid
binding agents and antibodies, recombinant expression may be employed to create a
fusion protein, as is known to those of skill in the art and further disclosed herein.
Equally, immunotoxins and coaguligands may be generated using avidin:biotin bridges
or any of the chemical conjugation and cross-linker technologies, mostly developed
in reference to antibody conjugates. Therefore, any of the following aminophospholipid
binding proteins and ligands may be conjugated to a toxin or coagulant in the same
manner as used for antibody conjugates, described herein.
D1. Aminophospholipid Binding Proteins
[0229] In addition to antibodies (see below), aminophospholipid binding ligands or binding
proteins may be used in the therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs of the present
invention. Naturally occurring proteins are known that bind to both phosphatidylethanolamineand
phosphatidylserine with specificity.
[0230] A series of studies by Sugi and McIntyre revealed that kininogens can bind to membrane-exposed
PE, at least in platelets (Sugi and McIntyre 1995; 1996a; 1996b). Kininogens are naturally
occurring proteins that normally have anti-thrombotic effects. The present inventors
propose that low or high molecular weight kininogens may therefore be attached to
therapeutic agents and used in the delivery of therapeutics to phosphatidylethanolamine,
newly discovered to be a marker of tumor vasculature.
[0231] Various mammalian and human kininogen genes have now been cloned, and such genes
and proteins can be used in the various recombinant and/or chemical embodiments of
the present invention. For example, see the complete nucleotide and amino acid sequences
of the genes and proteins described in Nakanishi
et al., 1983.
[0232] Nawa
et al. (1983) reported cDNA and protein sequences for bovine low molecular weight kininogens.
Fig. 2 of Nawa
et al. (1983) provides these complete nucleotide and amino acid sequences. Kitamura
et al. (1983) then reported that a single gene encodes the bovine high molecular weight
and low molecular weight kininogens. Fig. 2 of Kitamura
et al. (1983) provides the referenced gene and protein sequences. Kitamura
et al. (1987) also provides further information concerning the bovine, rat and human kininogens,
including low molecular weight, high molecular weight and T-kininogens.
[0233] Preferred high and low molecular weight kininogens for use in these aspects of the
invention will be the human genes and proteins, as described by Takagaki
et al. (1985), Kitamura
et al. (1985) and Kellermarnn
et al. (1986). Each of Fig. 2 and Fig. 3 of Takagaki
et al. (1985) provides the complete nucleotide and amino acid sequences of human low and
high molecular weight prekininogens, respectively. Figs. 1 and 8 of the protein analysis
paper of Kellermann
et al. (1986) are similarly useful.
[0234] Kitamura
et al. (1985) also provides further information regarding the structural organization of
the human kininogen gene, as may be used,
e.g., to design particular expression constructs for use herewith. Kitamura
et al. (1988) provides detailed information regarding the cloning of cDNAs and genomic kininogens,
such that any desired kininogen may be cloned.
[0235] In addition to the T-kininogens described by Kitamura
et al. (1987), Anderson
et al. (1989) also provides the gene and protein sequences of T-kininogen. Fig. 3 of Anderson
et al. (1989) is specifically useful.
[0236] Other phosphatidylethanolamine binding proteins are known that can be used in such
embodiments. A number of studies, particularly by Jones and Hall, and Bernier and
Jolles, have concerned the purification, characterization and cloning of phosphatidylethanolamine
binding proteins. For example, Bernier and Jolles (1984; incorporated herein by reference)
first reported the purification and characterization of a basic ∼23 kDa cytosolic
protein from bovine brain that was later characterized as a phosphatidylethanolamine-binding
protein (Bemier
et al., 1986). Schoentgen
et al. (1987) reported the complete amino acid sequence of this bovine protein, then shown
to be 21 kDa. Fig. 2 of Schoentgen
et al. (1987) provides the complete amino acid sequence of this bovine phosphatidylethanolamine
binding protein.
[0237] Jones and Hall (1991) later purified and partially sequenced a ∼23 kDa protein from
rat sperm plasma membranes that showed sequence similarity and phospholipid binding
properties similar to the bovine brain cytosolic protein of Bernier and Jolles (Bemier
and Jolles, 1984; Bernier
et al., 1986; Schoentgen
et al., 1987). The rat 23 kDa protein of Jones and Hall (1991) also showed selective affinity
for phosphatidylethanolamine (Kd = 1.6 x 10
-5 M).
[0238] Perry
et al. (1994) then cloned and sequenced rat and monkey versions of the phosphatidylethanolamine
binding protein of Jones and Hall (1991). Figures, 4, 5 and 6 of Perry
et al. (1994) provide the complete DNA and amino acid sequences of the rat and monkey phosphatidylethanolamine
binding proteins, and comparison to the bovine protein sequence. Any of the foregoing
mammalian phosphatidylethanolamine binding proteins, or their human counterparts,
may be attached to therapeutic agents and used in the present invention. These mammalian
sequences have EMBL Nucleotide Sequence Database Accession Numbers X71873 (rat) and
X73137 (monkey).
[0239] To counterpart human phosphatidylethanolamine binding protein has also been cloned
(Hori
et al., 1994). Both Fig. 1 of Hori
et al. (1994) and GenBank, EMBL and DDBJ Accession Number D16111 provide the complete DNA
and amino acid sequences of the human phosphatidylethanolamine binding proteins. The
mammalian and human sequences, as incorporated herein, may be employed in well-known
expression techniques, either to express the proteins themselves or therapeutic agent-fusions
thereof. Phosphatidylethanolamine binding proteins and genes from other sources, such
as yeast, Drosophila, simian,
T. canis and
O. volvulus may also be employed in these embodiments (Gems
et al., 1995).
[0240] Variant, mutant or second generation phosphatidylethanolamine binding protein nucleic
acids may also be readily prepared by standard molecular biological techniques, and
may optionally be characterized as hybridizing to any of the phosphatidylethanolamine
binding protein nucleotide sequences set forth in any one or more of Nakanishi
et al. (1983); Nawa
et al. (1983); Kitamura
et al. (1983; 1985; 1987; 1988); Takagaki
et al. (1985); Kellermann
et al. (1986); Anderson
et al. (1989); Bernier and Jolles (1984); Bernier
et al. (1986); Schoentgen
et al. (1987); Jones and Hall (1991); Perry
et al. (1994); and Hori
et al. (1994). Exemplary suitable hybridization conditions include hybridization in about
7% sodium dodecyl sulfate (SDS), about 0.5 M NaPO
4, about 1 mM EDTA at about 50°C; and washing with about 1% SDS at about 42°C.
[0241] In addition to the foregoing phosphatidylethanolamine binding proteins or "ligands",
naturally occurring proteins exist that specifically bind phosphatidylserine. Preferred
amongst these are annexins (sometimes spelt "annexines"), a group of calcium-dependent
phospholipid binding proteins. At least nine members of the annexin family have been
identified in mammalian tissues (Annexin I through Annexin IX). Most preferred amongst
these is annexin V (also known as PAP-I).
[0242] U.S. Patent No. 5,658,877 describes Annexin I, effective amounts of Annexin I and
pharmaceutical compositions thereof. Also described are methods of treating an animal
to prevent or alleviate the adverse effects of endotoxin in the lung that comprise
administering into the airway of an animal a safe amount of 33 kDa Annexin I fragment.
[0243] Annexin V contains one free sulfhydryl group and does not have any attached carbohydrate
chains. The primary structure of annexin V deduced from the cDNA sequence shows that
annexin V comprises four internal repeating units (U.S. Patent No. 4,937,324).
[0244] U.S. Patent No. 5,296,467 and WO 91/07187 each provide pharmaceutical compositions
comprising 'annexine' (annexin). Although proposed for use as anticoagulants, the
annexins of U.S. Patent No. 5,296,467 and WO 91/07187 may now be used as part of the
conjugates of the present invention.
[0245] WO 91/07187 provides natural, synthetic or genetically prepared derivatives and analogucs
of 'annexine' (annexin), which may now be used in the conjugates of the present invention.
Particular annexins are provided of 320 amino acids, containing variant amino acids
and, optionally, a disulphide bridge between the 316-Cys and the 2-Ala.
[0246] U.S. Patent No.5,296,467 further describes annexins and pharmaceutical compositions
thereof. U.S. Patent No. 5,296,467 describes annexin cloning, recombinant expression
and preparation. Aggregates of two or more annexines,
e.g., linked by disulfide bonds between one or more cysteine groups on the respective
annexine, are also disclosed. Yet a further example of suitable annexin starting materials
is provided by WO 95/27903 which provides annexins for use in detecting apoptotic
cells.
[0247] WO 97/17084 also describes annexin starting materials for preparing constructs of
the present invention. WO 97/17084 particularly concerns the use of Annexin V to alter
phosphatidylserine-dependent phagocytosis. It is said that blocking PS-dependent phagocytosis
means that PS-carrying cells undergo phagocytosis by other pathways, leading to greater
immune responses, such that Annexin V may be used as an adjuvant to increase immunogenicity
of vaccines. The treatment of sickle cell anemia and malaria is also described. WO
97/17084 also provides certain expression vector systems that may be adapted for use
herein.
[0248] To the extent that they clearly describe appropriate annexin starting materials for
preparing therapeutic constructs of the present invention, each of the diagnostic
approaches of U.S. Patent No. 5,627,036; WO 95/19791; WO 95/27903; WO 95/34315; WO
96/17618; and WO 98/04294; are also useful. Various of these documents also concern
recombinant expression vectors useful for adaptation into the present invention.
[0249] Although totally counter-intuitive prior to the present invention, the annexin conjugation
technology of U.S. Patent No. 5,632,986 may now be adapted for use in the present
tumor treatment methods. U.S. Patent No. 5,632,986 provides annexin conjugates using
compounds that lyse thrombi, or precursors of such compounds. Annexin-plasminogen
activator conjugates and annexin-urokinase conjugates were particularly provided for
thrombolysis and for treating disorders resulting from thrombosis. By switching the
thrombolytic compounds of U.S. Patent No. 5,632,986 for the toxic and coagulative
compounds disclosed herein, the basic conjugate technology of U.S. Patent No. 5,632,986
can be easily adapted for use in the present invention.
[0250] U.S. Patent No. 5,632,986 further describes annexin isolation from tissue extracts
(U.S. Patent No. 4,937,324) and annexin production by recombinant methods. Each of
the cDNA clones and expression vectors of U.S. Patent No. 5,632,986 are thus useful.
[0251] U.S. Patent No.5,632,986 further describes mutants and variants of the annexin molecule
that are subdivided or altered at one or more amino acid residues so long as the phospholipid
binding capability is not reduced substantially. Appropriate annexins for use in the
present invention can thus be truncated, for example, to include one or more domains
or contain fewer amino acid residues than the native protein, or can contain substituted
amino acids. Any changes are acceptable within the scope of the invention so long
as the mutein or second generation annexin molecule does not contain substantially
lower affinity for aminophospholipid. Such guidance can also be applied to phosphatidylethanolamine
binding proteins.
[0252] Second generation, variant and mutant annexin-encoding nucleic acids may also be
readily prepared by standard molecular biological techniques, and may optionally be
characterized as hybridizing to any of the foregoing annexin-encoding nucleic acid
sequences under hybridization conditions such as those including hybridization in
about 7% sodium dodecyl sulfate (SDS), about 0.5 M NaPO
4, about 1 mM EDTA at about 50°C; and washing with about 1% SDS at about 42°C.
[0253] The chemical cross-linking of annexins and other agents is also described in U.S:
Patent No. 5,632,986. All such techniques can be adapted for use herewith simply by
substituting the thrombolytic agents for those described herein. Aliphatic diamines;
succinimide esters; hetero-bifunctional coupling reagents, such as SPDP; maleimide
compounds; linkers with spacers; and the like, may thus be used.
[0254] U.S. Patent No. 5,632,986 describes the recombinant production of annexin-containing
conjugates. Appropriate nucleic acid sequences are thus joined to produce chimeric
coding sequences that, in turn, produce chimeric proteins. Exemplary expression vectors
are said to be pKK233-2
(E. coli), DPOT (yeast) and pDSP1.1BGH (mammalian). Such teaching is supplemented by further
information provided herein.
D2. Biologically Functional Equivalents
[0255] Equivalents, or even improvements, of aminophospholipid binding proteins can now
be made, generally using the materials provided above as a starting point. Modifications
and changes may be made in the structure of an aminophospholipid binding protein and
still obtain a molecule having like or otherwise desirable characteristics. For example,
certain amino acids may substituted for other amino acids in a protein structure without
appreciable loss of interactive binding capacity, such as, binding to the aminophospholipids,
PS and PE. These considerations also apply to toxins and coagulants.
[0256] Since it is the interactive capacity and nature of a protein that defines that protein's
biological functional activity, certain amino acid sequence substitutions can be made
in a protein sequence (or of course, the underlying DNA sequence) and nevertheless
obtain a protein with like (agonistic) properties. It is thus contemplated that various
changes may be made in the sequence of known aminophospholipid binding proteins or
peptides (or underlying DNA sequences) without appreciable loss of their biological
utility or activity. Biological functional equivalents made from mutating an underlying
DNA sequence can be made using the codon information provided herein in Table A, and
the supporting technical details on site-specific mutagenesis.
[0257] It also is well understood by the skilled artisan that, inherent in the definition
of a "biologically functional equivalent" protein or peptide, is the concept that
there is a limit to the number of changes that may be made within a defined portion
of the molecule and still result in a molecule with an acceptable level of equivalent
biological activity. Biologically functional equivalent proteins and peptides are
thus defined herein as those proteins and peptides in which certain, not most or all,
of the amino acids may be substituted. Of course, a plurality of distinct proteins/peptides
with different substitutions may easily be made and used in accordance with the invention.
[0258] Amino acid substitutions are generally based on the relative similarity of the amino
acid side-chain substituents, for example, their hydrophobicity, hydrophilicity, charge,
size, and the like. An analysis of the size, shape and type of the amino acid side-chain
substituents reveals that arginine, lysine and histidine are all positively charged
residues; that alanine, glycine and serine are all a similar size; and that phenylalanine,
tryptophan and tyrosine all have a generally similar shape. Therefore, based upon
these considerations, arginine, lysine and histidine; alanine, glycine and serine;
and phenylalanine, tryptophan and tyrosine; are defined herein as biologically functional
equivalents.
[0259] In making more quantitative changes, the hydropathic index of amino acids may be
considered. Each amino acid has been assigned a hydropathic index on the basis of
their hydrophobicity and charge characteristics, these are: isoleucine (+4.5); valine
(+4.2); leucine (+3.8); phenylalanine (+2.8); cysteine/cystine (+2.5); methionine
(+1.9); alanine (+1.8); glycine (-0.4); threonine (-0.7); serine (-0.8); tryptophan
(-0.9); tyrosine (-1.3); proline (-1.6); histidine (-3.2); glutamate (-3.5); glutamine
(-3.5); aspartate (-3.5); asparagine (-3.5); lysine (-3.9); and arginine (-4.5).
[0260] The importance of the hydropathic amino acid index in conferring interactive biological
function on a protein is generally understood in the art (Kyte and Doolittle, 1982).
It is known that certain amino acids may be substituted for other amino acids having
a similar hydropathic index or score and still retain a similar biological activity.
In making changes based upon the hydropathic index, the substitution of amino acids
whose hydropathic indices are within ±2 is preferred, those which are within ±1 are
particularly preferred, and those within ±0.5 are even more particularly preferred.
[0261] It is thus understood that an amino acid can be substituted for another having a
similar hydrophilicity value and still obtain a biologically equivalent protein. As
detailed in U.S. Patent No. 4,554,101, the following hydrophilicity values have been
assigned to amino acid residues: arginine (+3.0); lysine (+3.0); aspartate (+3.0 ±
1); glutamate (+3.0 ± 1); serine (+0.3); asparagine (+0.2); glutamine (+0.2); glycine
(0); threonine (-0.4); proline (-0.5 ± 1); alanine (-0.5); histidine (-0.5); cysteine
(-1.0); methionine (-1.3); valine (-1.5); leucine (-1.8); isoleucine (-1.8); tyrosine
(-2.3); phenylalanine (-2.5); tryptophan (-3.4).
[0262] In making changes based upon hydrophilicity values, the substitution of amino acids
whose hydrophilicity values are within ±2 is preferred, those which are within ±1
are particularly preferred, and those within ±0.5 are even more particularly preferred.
D3. Toxic and Anti-Cellular Agents
[0263] For certain applications, the therapeutic agents will be cytotoxic or pharmacological
agents, particularly cytotoxic, cytostatic, anti-cellular or antiangiogenic agents
having the ability to kill or suppress the growth or cell division of endothelial
cells. In general, these aspects of the invention contemplate the use of any pharmacological
agent that can be conjugated to a targeting agent, and delivered in active form to
the targeted endothelium.
[0264] Exemplary anti-cellular agents include chemotherapeutic agents, as well as cytotoxins.
Chemotherapeutic agents that may be used include: hormones, such as steroids; anti-metabolites,
such as cytosine arabinoside, fluorouracil, methotrexate or aminopterin; anthracyclines;
mitomycin C; vinca alkaloids; demecolcine; etoposide; mithramycin; anti-tumor alkylating
agents, such as chlorambucil or melphalan. Other embodiments may include agents such
as cytokines. Basically, any anti-cellular agent may be used, so long as it can be
successfully conjugated to, or associated with, a targeting agent or antibody in a
manner that will allow its targeting, internalization, release and/or presentation
to blood components at the site of the targeted endothelial cells.
[0265] There may be circumstances, such as when the target antigen does not internalize
by a route consistent with efficient intoxication by the toxic compound, where one
will desire to target chemotherapeutic agents, such as anti-tumor drugs. cytokines,
antimetabolites, alkylating agents, hormones, and the like. A variety of chemotherapeutic
and other pharmacological agents have now been successfully conjugated to antibodies
and shown to function pharmacologically, including doxorubicin, daunomycin, methotrexate,
vinblastine, neocarzinostatin, macromycin, trenimon and α-amanitin.
[0266] In other circumstances, any potential side-effects from cytotoxin-based therapy may
be eliminated by the use of DNA synthesis inhibitors, such as daunorubicin, doxorubicin,
adriamycin, and the like. These agents are therefore preferred examples of anti-cellular
agents for use in the present invention. In terms of cytostatic agents, such compounds
generally disturb the natural cell cycle of a target cell, preferably so that the
cell is taken out of the cell cycle. Exemplary cytostatic agents include.
[0267] A wide variety of cytotoxic agents are known that may be conjugated to anti-aminophospholipid
antibodies or binding ligands. Examples include numerous useful plant-, fungus- or
bacteria-derived toxins, which, by way of example, include various A chain toxins,
particularly ricin A chain; ribosome inactivating proteins. such as saporin or gelonin:
α-sarcin; aspergillin; restrictocin: ribonucleases, such as placental ribonuclease;
diphtheria toxin: and
pseudomonas exotoxin, to name just a few.
[0268] Of the toxins, ricin A chains are preferred. The most preferred toxin moiety for
use herewith is toxin A chain that has been treated to modify or remove carbohydrate
residues, so-called deglycosylated A chain (dgA). Deglycosylated ricin A chain is
preferred because of its extreme potency, longer half-life, and because it is economically
feasible to manufacture it in a clinical grade and scale.
[0269] It may be desirable from a pharmacological standpoint to employ the smallest molecule
possible that nevertheless provides an appropriate biological response. One may thus
desire to employ smaller A chain peptides that will provide an adequate anti-cellular
response. To this end, it has been discovered that ricin A chain may be "truncated"
by the removal of 30 N-terminal amino acids by Nagarase (Sigma), and still retain
an adequate toxin activity. It is proposed that where desired, this truncated A chain
may be employed in conjugates in accordance with the invention.
[0270] Alternatively, one may find that the application of recombinant DNA technology to
the toxin A chain moiety will provide additional benefits in accordance the invention.
In that the cloning and expression of biologically active ricin A chain has been achieved,
it is now possible to identify and prepare smaller or otherwise variant peptides which
nevertheless exhibit an appropriate toxin activity. Moreover, the fact that ricin
A chain has now been cloned allows the application of site-directed mutagenesis, through
which one can readily prepare and screen for A chain-derived peptides and obtain additional
useful moieties for use in connection with the present invention.
[0271] Other agents for use in immunoconjugate targeting of PS expressed on tumor vasculature
are the angiopoietins. The angiopoietins, like the members of the VEGF family, are
growth factors largely specific for vascular endothelium (Davis and Yancopoulos, 1999;
Holash
el al., 1999). The angiopoietins first described were a naturally occurring agonist, angiopoietin-1
(Ang-1; SEQ ID NO:1 and SEQ ID NO:2), and a naturally occurring antagonist, angiopoietin-2
(Ang-2; SEQ ID NO:3 and SEQ ID NO:4), both of which act by means of the endothelial
cell tyrosine kinase receptor, Tie2.
[0272] Two new angiopoietins, angiopoietin-3 (mouse) and angiopoietin-4 (human) have also
been identified (Valenzuela
et al., 1999). Angiopoietin-3 appears to act as an antagonist, whereas angiopoietin-4 appears
to function as an agonist (Valenzuela
et al., 1999). A protein termed angiopoietin-3 was also cloned from human heart and reported
not to have mitogenic effects on endothelial cells (Kim
et al., 1999).
[0273] Whereas VEGF is necessary for the early stages of vascular development, angiopoietin-1
is generally required for the later stages of vascular remodeling. Angiopoietin-1
is thus a maturation or stabilization factor, which converts immature vessels to mature
vessels.
[0274] Angiopoietin-1 has been shown to augment revascularization in ischemic tissue (Shyu
et al., 1998) and to increase the survival of vascular networks exposed to either VEGF or
a form of aFGF (Papapetropoulos
et al., 1999). These authors also showed that angiopoietin-1 prevents apoptotic death in
HUVEC triggered by withdrawal of the same form of aFGF (Papapetropoulos
et al., 1999). Such data are consistent with the direct role of angiopoietin-1 on human
endothelial cells and its interaction with other angiogenic molecules to stabilize
vascular structures by promoting the survival of differentiated endothelial cells.
[0275] Of the angiopoietins, angiopoietin-2 is a preferred agent for use in PS-targeted
therapy, particularly in tumors with low VEGF levels and/or in combination with VEGF
inhibition. Angiopoietin-2 is also a ligand for Tie2, but generally counteracts blood
vessel maturation/stability mediated by angiopoietin-1. It is thus an antagonist of
angiopoietin-1, and acts to disturb capillary structure. However, as angiopoietin-2
renders endothelial cells responsive to angiogenic stimuli, it can initiate neovascularization
in combination with other appropriate signals, particularly VEGF (Asahara
et al., 1998; Holash
et al., 1999).
[0276] In the absence of another angiogenic signal, angiopoietin-2 causes vessels to destabilize
and become immature. In the presence of a stimulus, such as VEGF, angiopoietin-2 promotes
angiogenesis. Indeed, the angiogenic effects of a number of regulators are believed
to be achieved, at least in part, through the regulation of an autocrine loop of angiopoietin-2
activity in microvascular endothelial cells (Mandriota and Pepper, 1998).
[0277] Angiopoietin-2 expression in tumor tissue has been reported (Tanaka
et al., 1999), where it presumably acts in combination with VEGF to promote angiogenesis
(Stratmann
et al., 1998). However, as angiopoietin-2 provides a negative signal when VEGF is low or
absent, provision of angiopoietin-2 can be a useful therapeutic approach. In addition
to tumor-targeted forms, angiopoietin-2 can also be administered as a protein or gene
therapy therapeutic (see combination therapies described herein). Fusion proteins
of angiopoietins are also envisioned for use in this invention, such as the stable
Ang-1-Ang-2 fusion protein included herein as SEQ ID NO:5.
D4. Coagulation Factors
[0278] The antibody and ligand targeting agents of the invention may be linked to a component
that is capable of directly or indirectly stimulating coagulation, to form a coaguligand.
Here, the targeting agents may be directly linked to the coagulant or coagulation
factor, or may be linked to a second binding region that binds and then releases the
coagulant or coagulation factor. As used herein, the terms "coagulant" and "coagulation
factor" are each used to refer to a component that is capable of directly or indirectly
stimulating coagulation under appropriate conditions, preferably when provided to
a specific
in vivo environment, such as the tumor vasculature.
[0279] Preferred coagulation factors are Tissue Factor compositions, such as truncated TF
(tTF), dimeric, multimeric and mutant TF molecules. "Truncated TF" (tTF) refers to
TF constructs that are rendered membrane-binding deficient by removal of sufficient
amino acid sequences to effect this change in property. A "sufficient amount" in this
context is an amount of transmembrane amino acid sequence originally sufficient to
enter the TF molecule in the membrane, or otherwise mediate functional membrane binding
of the TF protein. The removal of such a "sufficient amount of transmembrane spanning
sequence" therefore creates a truncated Tissue Factor protein or polypeptide deficient
in phospholipid membrane binding capacity, such that the protein is substantially
a soluble protein that does not significantly bind to phospholipid membranes. Truncated
TF thus substantially fails to convert Factor VII to Factor VIIa in a standard TF
assay, and yet retains so-called catalytic activity including activating Factor X
in the presence of Factor VIIa.
[0280] U.S. Patent No. 5,504,067 further describes such truncated Tissue Factor proteins.
Preferably, the Tissue Factors for use in these aspects of the present invention will
generally lack the transmembrane and cytosolic regions (amino acids 220-263) of the
protein. However, there is no need for the truncated TF molecules to be limited to
molecules of the exact length of 219 amino acids.
[0281] Tissue Factor compositions may also be useful as dimers. Any of the truncated, mutated
or other Tissue Factor constructs may be prepared in a dimeric form for use in the
present invention. As will be known to those of ordinary skill in the art, such TF
dimers may be prepared by employing the standard techniques of molecular biology and
recombinant expression, in which two coding regions are prepared in-frame and expressed
from an expression vector. Equally, various chemical conjugation technologies may
be employed in connection with the preparation of TF dimers. The individual TF monomers
may be derivatized prior to conjugation. All such techniques would be readily known
to those of skill in the art.
[0282] lf desired, the Tissue Factor dimers or multimers may be joined via a biologically-releasable
bond, such as a selectively-cleavable linker or amino acid sequence. For example,
peptide linkers that include a cleavage site for an enzyme preferentially located
or active within a tumor environment are contemplated. Exemplary forms of such peptide
linkers are those that are cleaved by urokinase, plasmin, thrombin, Factor IXa, Factor
Xa, or a metalloproteinase, such as collagenase, gelatinase or stromelysin.
[0283] In certain embodiments, the Tissue Factor dimers may further comprise a hindered
hydrophobic membrane insertion moiety, to later encourage the functional association
of the Tissue Factor with the phospholipid membrane, but only under certain defined
conditions. As described in the context of the truncated Tissue Factors, hydrophobic
membrane-association sequences are generally stretches of amino acids that promote
association with the phospholipid environment due to their hydrophobic nature. Equally,
fatty acids may be used to provide the potential membrane insertion moiety.
[0284] Such membrane insertion sequences may be located either at the N-terminus or the
C-terminus of the TF molecule, or generally appended at any other point of the molecule
so long as their attachment thereto does not hinder the functional properties of the
TF construct. The intent of the hindered insertion moiety is that it remains non-functional
until the TF construct localizes within the tumor environment, and allows the hydrophobic
appendage to become accessible and even further promote physical association with
the membrane. Again, it is contemplated that biologically-releasable bonds and selectively-cleavable
sequences will be particularly useful in this regard, with the bond or sequence only
being cleaved or otherwise modified upon localization within the tumor environment
and exposure to particular enzymes or other bioactive molecules.
[0285] In other embodiments, the tTF constructs may be multimeric or polymeric. In this
context a "polymeric construct" contains 3 or more Tissue Factor constructs. A "multimeric
or polymeric TF construct" is a construct that comprises a first TF molecule or derivative
operatively attached to at least a second and a third TF molecule or derivative. The
multimers may comprise between about 3 and about 20 such TF molecules. The individual
TF units within the multimers or polymers may also be linked by selectively-cleavable
peptide linkers or other biological-releasable bonds as desired. Again. as with the
TF dimers discussed above, the constructs may be readily made using either recombinant
manipulation and expression or using standard synthetic chemistry.
[0286] Even further TF constructs useful in context of the present invention are those mutants
deficient in the ability to activate Factor VII. Such "Factor VII activation mutants"
are generally defined herein as TF mutants that bind functional Factor VII/VIIa, proteolytically
activate Factor X, but are substantially free from the ability to proteolytically
activate Factor VII. Accordingly, such constructs are TF mutants that lack Factor
VII activation activity.
[0287] The ability of such Factor VII activation mutants to function in promoting tumor-specific
coagulation is based upon their specific delivery to the tumor vasculature, and the
presence of Factor VIIa at low levels in plasma. Upon administration of such a Factor
VII activation mutant-targeting agent conjugate, the mutant will be localized within
the vasculature of a vascularized tumor. Prior to localization, the TF mutant would
be generally unable to promote coagulation in any other body sites, on the basis of
its inability to convert Factor VII to Factor VIIa. However, upon localization and
accumulation within the tumor region, the mutant will then encounter sufficient Factor
VIIa from the plasma in order to initiate the extrinsic coagulation pathway, leading
to tumor-specific thrombosis. Exogenous Factor VIIa could also be administered to
the patient.
[0288] Any one or more of a variety of Factor VII activation mutants may be prepared and
used in connection with the present invention. There is a significant amount of scientific
knowledge concerning the recognition sites on the TF molecule for Factor VII/VIIa.
It will thus be understood that the Factor VII activation region generally lies between
about amino acid 157 and about amino acid 167 of the TF molecule. However, it is contemplated
that residues outside this region may also prove to be relevant to the Factor VII
activating activity, and one may therefore consider introducing mutations into any
one or more of the residues generally located between about amino acid 106 and about
amino acid 209 of the TF sequence (WO 94/07515; WO 94/28017).
[0289] A variety of other coagulation factors may be used in connection with the present
invention, as exemplified by the agents set forth below. Thrombin, Factor V/Va and
derivatives, Factor VIII/VIIIa and derivatives, Factor IX/IXa and derivatives, Factor
X/Xa and derivatives, Factor XI/XIa and derivatives, Factor XII/XIIa and derivatives,
Factor XIII/XIIIa and derivatives, Factor X activator and Factor V activator may be
used in the present invention.
[0290] Russell's viper venom Factor X activator is contemplated for use in this invention.
Monoclonal antibodies specific for the Factor X activator present in Russell's viper
venom have also been produced, and could be used to specifically deliver the agent
as part of a bispecific binding ligand.
[0291] Thromboxane A
2 is formed from endoperoxides by the sequential actions of the enzymes cyclooxygenase
and thromboxane synthetase in platelet microsomes. Thromboxane A
2 is readily generated by platelets and is a potent vasoconstrictor, by virtue of its
capacity to produce platelet aggregation. Both thromboxane A
2 and active analogues thereof are contemplated for use in the present invention.
[0292] Thromboxane synthase, and other enzymes that synthesize platelet-activating prostaglandins,
may also be used as "coagulants" in the present context. Monoclonal antibodies to.
and immunoaffinity purification of, thromboxane synthase are known; as is the cDNA
for human thromboxane synthase.
[0293] α2-antiplasmin, or α2-plasmin inhibitor, is a proteinase inhibitor naturally present
in human plasma that functions to efficiently inhibit the lysis of fibrin clots induced
by plasminogen activator. α2-antiplasmin is a particularly potent inhibitor, and is
contemplated for use in the present invention.
[0294] As the cDNA sequence for α2-antiplasmin is available, recombinant expression and/or
fusion proteins are preferred. Monoclonal antibodies against α2-antiplasmin are also
available that may be used in the bispecific binding ligand embodiments of the invention.
These antibodies could both be used to deliver exogenous α2-antiplasmin to the target
site or to garner endogenous α2-antiplasmin and concentrate it within the targeted
region.
D5. Fusion Proteins and Recombinant Expression
[0295] The therapeutic agent-targeting agent compositions of the present invention may be
readily prepared as fusion proteins using molecular biological techniques. The use
of recombinant DNA techniques to achieve such ends is now standard practice to those
of skill in the art. These methods include, for example,
in vitro recombinant DNA techniques, synthetic techniques and
in vivo recombination/genetic recombination. DNA and RNA synthesis may, additionally, be
performed using an automated synthesizers (see, for example, the techniques described
in Sambrook
et al., 1989).
[0296] The preparation of such a fusion protein generally entails the preparation of a first
and second DNA coding region and the functional ligation or joining of such regions,
in frame, to prepare a single coding region that encodes the desired fusion protein.
In the present context, the targeting agent DNA sequence will be joined in frame with
a DNA sequence encoding a therapeutic agent. It is not generally believed to be particularly
relevant which portion of the therapeutic agent-targeting agent is prepared as the
N-terminal region or as the C-terminal region.
[0297] Once the desired coding region has been produced, an expression vector is created.
Expression vectors contain one or more promoters upstream of the inserted DNA regions
that act to promote transcription of the DNA and to thus promote expression of the
encoded recombinant protein. This is the meaning of "recombinant expression".
[0298] To obtain a so-called "recombinant" version of the therapeutic agent-targeting agent
protein, it is expressed in a recombinant cell. The engineering of DNA segment(s)
for expression in a prokaryotic or eukaryotic system may be performed by techniques
generally known to those of skill in recombinant expression. It is believed that virtually
any expression system may be employed in the expression of the therapeutic agent-targeting
agent constructs.
[0299] Such proteins may be successfully expressed in eukaryotic expression systems,
e.g., CHO cells, however, it is envisioned that bacterial expression systems, such as
E. coli pQE-60 will be particularly useful for the large-scale preparation and subsequent
purification of the therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs. cDNAs may also be
expressed in bacterial systems, with the encoded proteins being expressed as fusions
with β-galactosidase, ubiquitin,
Schistosoma japonicum glutathione S-transferase, and the like. It is believed that bacterial expression
will have advantages over eukaryotic expression in terms of ease of use and quantity
of materials obtained thereby.
[0300] In terms of microbial expression, U.S. Patent Nos. 5,583,013; 5,221,619; 4,785,420;
4,704,362; and 4,366,246 further supplement the present disclosure in connection with
the expression of genes in recombinant host cells.
[0301] Recombinantly produced therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs may be purified
and formulated for human administration. Alternatively, nucleic acids encoding the
therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs may be delivered via gene therapy. Although
naked recombinant DNA or plasmids may be employed, the use of liposomes or vectors
is preferred. The ability of certain viruses to enter cells via receptor-mediated
endocytosis and to integrate into the host cell genome and express viral genes stably
and efficiently have made them attractive candidates for the transfer of foreign genes
into mammalian cells. Preferred gene therapy vectors for use in the present invention
will generally be viral vectors.
[0302] Retroviruses have promise as gene delivery vectors due to their ability to integrate
their genes into the host genome, transferring a large amount of foreign genetic material,
infecting a broad spectrum of species and cell types and of being packaged in special
cell-lines. Other viruses, such as adenovirus, herpes simplex viruses (HSV), cytomegalovirus
(CMV), and adeno-associated virus (AAV), such as those described by U.S. Patent 5,139,941,
may also be engineered to serve as vectors for gene transfer.
[0303] Although some viruses that can accept foreign genetic material are limited in the
number of nucleotides they can accommodate and in the range of cells they infect,
these viruses have been demonstrated to successfully effect gene expression. However,
adenoviruses do not integrate their genetic material into the host genome and therefore
do not require host replication for gene expression, making them ideally suited for
rapid, efficient. heterologous gene expression. Techniques for preparing replication-defective
infective viruses are well known in the art.
[0304] In certain further embodiments, the gene therapy vector will be HSV. A factor that
makes HSV an attractive vector is the size and organization of the genome. Because
HSV is large, incorporation of multiple genes or expression cassettes is less problematic
than in other smaller viral systems. In addition, the availability of different viral
control sequences with varying performance (
e.g., temporal, strength) makes it possible to control expression to a greater extent
than in other systems. It also is an advantage that the virus has relatively few spliced
messages, further easing genetic manipulations. HSV also is relatively easy to manipulate
and can be grown to high titers.
[0305] Of course, in using viral delivery systems, one will desire to purify the virion
sufficiently to render it essentially free of undesirable contaminants, such as defective
interfering viral particles or endotoxins and other pyrogens such that it will not
cause any untoward reactions in the cell, animal or individual receiving the vector
construct. A preferred means of purifying the vector involves the use of buoyant density
gradients, such as cesium chloride gradient centrifugation.
E. Anti-Aminophospholipid Antibodies and Conjugates
El. Polyclonal Anti-Aminophospholipid Antibodies
[0306] Means for preparing and characterizing antibodies are well known in the art (see,
e.g., Antibodies: A Laboratory Manual, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory, 1988). To prepare
polyclonal antisera an animal is immunized with an immunogenic aminophospholipid composition,
and antisera collected from that immunized animal. A wide range of animal species
can be used for the production of antisera. Typically the animal used for production
of anti-antisera is a rabbit, mouse, rat, hamster, guinea pig or goat. Because of
the relatively large blood volume of rabbits, a rabbit is a preferred choice for production
of polyclonal antibodies.
[0307] The amount of immunogen composition used in the production of polyclonal antibodies
varies upon the nature of the immunogen as well as the animal used for immunization.
A variety of routes can be used to administer the present aminophospholipid immunogen;
subcutaneous, intramuscular, intradermal, intravenous, intraperitoneal and intrasplenic.
The production of polyclonal antibodies may be monitored by sampling blood of the
immunized animal at various points following immunization. A second, booster injection,
may also be given. The process of boosting and titering is repeated until a suitable
titer is achieved. When a desired titer level is obtained, the immunized animal can
be bled and the serum isolated and stored. The animal can also be used to generate
monoclonal antibodies.
[0308] As is well known in the art, the immunogenicity of a particular composition can be
enhanced by the use of non-specific stimulators of the immune response, known as adjuvants.
Exemplary adjuvants include complete Freund's adjuvant, a non-specific stimulator
of the immune response containing killed
Mycobacterium tuberculosis; incomplete Freund's adjuvant; and aluminum hydroxide adjuvant.
[0309] It may also be desired to boost the host immune system, as may be achieved by associating
aminophospholipids with, or coupling aminophospholipids to, a carrier. Exemplary carriers
are keyhole limpet hemocyanin (KLH) and bovine serum albumin (BSA). Other albumins
such as ovalbumin, mouse serum albumin or rabbit serum albumin can also be used as
carriers.
[0310] As is also known in the art, a given composition may vary in its immunogenicity.
However, the generation of antibodies against aminophospholipids is not particularly
difficult. For example, highly specific anti-phosphatidylserine antibodies were raised
in rabbits immunized by intramuscular injections of phosphatidylserine-containing
polyacrylamide gels and with phosphatidylserinecytochrome
c vesicles (Maneta-Peyret
et al., 1988; 1989). The use of acrylamide implants enhanced the production of antibodies
(Maneta-Peyret
et al., 1988; 1989). The anti-phosphatidylserine antibodies raised in this manner are able
to detect phosphatidylserine
in situ on human platelets (Maneta-Peyret
et al., 1988). The groups of Inoue, Rote and Rauch have also developed anti-PS and anti-PE
antibodies (see below).
E2. Monoclonal Anti-Aminophospholipid Antibodies
[0311] Various methods for generating monoclonal antibodies (MAbs) are also now very well
known in the art. The most standard monoclonal antibody generation techniques generally
begin along the same lines as those for preparing polyclonal antibodies (Antibodies:
A Laboratory Manual, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory, 1988). A polyclonal antibody response
is initiated by immunizing an animal with an immunogenic aminophospholipid composition
and, when a desired titer level is obtained, the immunized animal can be used to generate
MAbs.
[0312] MAbs may be readily prepared through use of well-known techniques, such as those
exemplified in US. Patent 4,196,265. Typically, this technique involves immunizing
-a suitable animal with the selected aminophospholipid immunogen composition. The
immunizing composition is administered in a manner effective to stimulate antibody
producing cells. Rodents such as mice and rats are preferred animals, however, the
use of rabbit, sheep and frog cells is also possible. The use of rats may provide
certain advantages (Goding, 1986, pp. 60-61), but mice are preferred, with the BALB/c
mouse being most preferred as this is most routinely used and generally gives a higher
percentage of stable fusions.
[0313] Following immunization, somatic cells with the potential for producing aminophospholipid
antibodies, specifically B lymphocytes (B cells), are selected for use in the MAb
generating protocol. These cells may be obtained from biopsied spleens, tonsils or
lymph nodes, or from a peripheral blood sample. Spleen cells and peripheral blood
cells are preferred, the former because they are a rich source of antibody-producing
cells that are in the dividing plasmablast stage, and the latter because peripheral
blood is easily accessible. Often, a panel of animals will have been immunized and
the spleen of animal with the highest antibody titer will be removed and the spleen
lymphocytes obtained by homogenizing the spleen with a syringe. Typically, a spleen
from an immunized mouse contains approximately 5 X 10
7 to 2 X 10
8 lymphocytes.
[0314] The anti-aminophospholipid antibody-producing B lymphocytes from the immunized animal
are then fused with cells of an immortal myeloma cell, generally one of the same species
as the animal that was immunized. Myeloma cell lines suited for use in hybridoma-producing
fusion procedures preferably are non-antibody-producing, have high fusion efficiency,
and enzyme deficiencies that render then incapable of growing in certain selective
media which support the growth of only the desired fused cells (hybridomas).
[0315] Any one of a number of myeloma cells may be used, as are known to those of skill
in the art (Goding, pp. 65-66, 1986; Campbell, pp. 75-83, 1984). For example, where
the immunized animal is a mouse, one may use P3-X63/Ag8, X63-Ag8.653, NS1/1.Ag 4 1,
Sp210-Ag14, FO, NSO/U, MPC-11, MPC11-X45-GTG 1.7 and S194/5XX0 Bul; for rats, one
may use R210.RCY3, Y3-Ag 1.2.3, IR983F, 4B210 or one of the above listed mouse cell
lines; and U-266, GM1500-GRG2, LICR-LON-HMy2 and UC729-6, are all useful in connection
with human cell fusions.
[0316] Methods for generating hybrids of antibody-producing spleen or lymph node cells and
myeloma cells usually comprise mixing somatic cells with myeloma cells in a 4:1 proportion,
though the proportion may vary from about 20:1 to about 1:1, respectively, in the
presence of an agent or agents (chemical or electrical) that promote the fusion of
cell membranes. Fusion methods using Sendai virus have been described by Kohler and
Milstein (1975; 1976), and those using polyethylene glycol (PEG), such as 37% (v/v)
PEG, by Gefter
et al. (1977). The use of electrically induced fusion methods is also appropriate (Goding
pp. 71-74, 1986).
[0317] Fusion procedures usually produce viable hybrids at low frequencies, about 1 × 10
-6 to 1 × 10
-8. However, this does not pose a problem, as the viable, fused hybrids are differentiated
from the parental, unfused cells (particularly the unfused myeloma cells that would
normally continue to divide indefinitely) by culturing in a selective medium. The
selective medium is generally one that contains an agent that blocks the
de novo synthesis of nucleotides in the tissue culture media. Exemplary and preferred agents
are aminopterin, methotrexate, and azaserine. Aminopterin and methotrexate block
de novo synthesis of both purines and pyrimidines, whereas azaserine blocks only purine synthesis.
Where aminopterin or methotrexate is used, the media is supplemented with hypoxanthine
and thymidine as a source of nucleotides (HAT medium). Where azaserine is used, the
media is supplemented with hypoxanthine.
[0318] The preferred selection medium is HAT. Only cells capable of operating nucleotide
salvage pathways are able to survive in HAT medium. The myeloma cells are defective
in key enzymes of the salvage pathway,
e.g., hypoxanthine phosphoribosyl transferase (HPRT), and they cannot survive. The B cells
can operate this pathway, but they have a limited life span in culture and generally
die within about two weeks. Therefore, the only cells that can survive in the selective
media are those hybrids formed from myeloma and B cells.
[0319] This culturing provides a population of hybridomas from which specific hybridomas
are selected. Typically, selection of hybridomas is performed by culturing the cells
by single-clone dilution in microtiter plates, followed by testing the individual
clonal supernatants (after about two to three weeks) for the desired anti-aminophospholipid
reactivity. The assay should be sensitive, simple and rapid, such as radioimmurioassays,
enzyme immunoassays, cytotoxicity assays, plaque assays, dot immunobinding assays,
and the like.
[0320] The selected hybridomas would then be serially diluted and cloned into individual
anti-aminophospholipid antibody-producing cell lines, which clones can then be propagated
indefinitely to provide MAbs. The cell lines may be exploited for MAb production in
two basic ways. A sample of the hybridoma can be injected (often into the peritoneal
cavity) into a histocompatible animal of the type that was used to provide the somatic
and myeloma cells for the original fusion. The injected animal develops tumors secreting
the specific monoclonal antibody produced by the fused cell hybrid., The body fluids
of the animal, such as serum or ascites fluid, can then be tapped to provide MAbs
in high concentration. The individual cell lines could also be cultured
in vitro, where the MAbs are naturally secreted into the culture medium from which they can
be readily obtained in high concentrations.
[0321] MAbs produced by either means will generally be further purified,
e.g., using filtration, centrifugation and various chromatographic methods; such as HPLC
or affinity chromatography, all of which purification techniques are well known to
those of skill in the art. These purification techniques each involve fractionation
to separate the desired antibody from other components of a mixture. Analytical methods
particularly suited to the preparation of antibodies include, for example, protein
A-Sepharose and/or protein G-Sepharose chromatography.
[0322] Umeda
et al. (1989) reported the effective production of monoclonal antibodies recognizing stereo-specific
epitopes of phosphatidylserine. The Umeda system is based on the direct immunization
of phosphatidylserine into mouse spleen using a
Salmonella-coated aminophospholipid sample (Umeda
et al., 1989). The Umeda protocol gives a high frequency of anti-PS MAbs, which exhibit three
distinct reactivity profiles ranging from highly specific to broadly cross-reactive.
Umeda is therefore also incorporated herein by reference for purposes of further describing
screening assays to identify MAbs that bind specifically to PS,
e.g., and do not bind to phosphatidylcholine.
[0323] Any of the 61 hybridomas generated by Umeda could potentially be employed in the
therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs of the present invention. Examples are
PSC8, PSF11, PSG3, PSD11, PSF10, PS1B, PS3D12, PS2C11; PS3A, PSF6, PSF7, PSB4, PS3H1;
PS4A7 and PS1G3. More preferred are PS3A, PSF6, PSF7, PSB4 and PS3HI as they bind
only to phosphatidylserine and phosphatidylethanolamine. Preferred anti-PS antibodies
are PS4A7 (IgM) and PS1G3 (IgG
3), as they are highly specific for PS and exhibit no cross-reaction with other phospholipids.
PS4A7 recognizes the stereo-specific configuration of the seine residue in PS (Figure
1 Umeda
et al., 1989).
[0324] Igarashi
et al. (1991) also reported the effective induction of anti-PS antibodies of the IgG isotype
by intrasplenic immunization. Only a slight increase of the titer was observed when
the antigen was again injected intravenously. A high frequency of anti-PS MAbs of
the IgG isotype was also observed even when MAbs were produced 10 days after the intrasplenic
injection of the antigen. These antibodies were also employed by Schuurmans Stekhoven
et al. (1994).
[0325] The other significant anti-PS antibody production has been by Rote and colleagues.
Rote
et al. (1993) particularly employed PS micelles in combination with Freund's complete adjuvant
to generate specific anti-PS antibodies. Rote
et al. (1993) also generated monoclonal antibodies that differentiate between cardiolipin
(CL) and PS. Rote
et al. (1993) is therefore also incorporated herein by reference for purposes of further
describing screening assays to identify MAbs that bind specifically to PS by testing
against resting and thrombin-activated platelets using flow cytometry.
[0326] The 3SB9b antibody produced by Rote
et al. (1993) reacted with only with PS, and is a preferred antibody for use in the therapeutic
agent-targeting agent constructs of the present invention. BA3B5C4 may also be used
as it reacts with both PS and CL. These antibodies are also described in Lin
et al. (1995), Obringer
et al. (1995) and Katsuragawa
et al. (1997).
E3. Anti-Aminophospholipid Antibodies from Phagemid Libraries
[0327] Recombinant technology now allows the preparation of antibodies having the desired
specificity from recombinant genes encoding a range of antibodies (Van Dijk
et al., 1989). Certain recombinant techniques involve the isolation of the antibody genes
by immunological screening of combinatorial immunoglobulin phage expression libraries
prepared from RNA isolated from the spleen of an immunized animal (Morrison
et al., 1986; Winter and Milstein, 1991).
[0328] For such methods, combinatorial immunoglobulin phagemid libraries are prepared from
RNA isolated from the spleen of the immunized animal, and phagemids expressing appropriate
antibodies are selected by panning using cells expressing the antigen and control
cells. The advantages of this approach over conventional hybridoma techniques are
that approximately 10
4 times as many antibodies can be produced and screened in a single round, and that
new specificities are generated by H and L chain combination, which further increases
the percentage of appropriate antibodies generated.
[0329] One method for the generation of a large repertoire of diverse antibody molecules
in bacteria utilizes the bacteriophage lambda as the vector (Huse
et al., 1989). Production of antibodies using the lambda vector involves the cloning of
heavy and light chain populations of DNA sequences into separate starting vectors.
The vectors are subsequently combined randomly to form a single vector that directs
the co-expression of heavy and light chains to form antibody fragments. The heavy
and light chain DNA sequences are obtained by amplification, preferably by PCR™ or
a related amplification technique, of mRNA isolated from spleen cells (or hybridomas
thereof) from an animal that has been immunized with a selected antigen. The heavy
and light chain sequences are typically . amplified using primers that incorporate
restriction sites into the ends of the amplified DNA segment to facilitate cloning
of the heavy and light chain segments into the starting vectors.
[0330] Another method for the generation and screening of large libraries of wholly or partially
synthetic antibody combining sites, or paratopes, utilizes display vectors derived
from filamentous phage such as M13, fl or fd. These filamentous phage display vectors,
referred to as "phagemids", yield large libraries of monoclonal antibodies having
diverse and novel immunospecificities. The technology uses a filamentous phage coat
protein membrane anchor domain as a means for linking gene-product and gene during
the assembly stage of filamentous phage replication, and has been used for the cloning
and expression of antibodies from combinatorial libraries (Kang
et al., 1991; Barbas
et al., 1991).
[0331] This general technique for filamentous phage display is described in U.S. Patent
5,658,727, incorporated herein by reference. In a most general sense, the method provides
a system for the simultaneous cloning and screening of pre-selected ligand-binding
specificities from antibody gene repertoires using a single vector system. Screening
of isolated members of the library for a pre-selected ligand-binding capacity allows
the correlation of the binding capacity of an expressed antibody molecule with a convenient
means to isolate the gene that encodes the member from the library.
[0332] Linkage of expression and screening is accomplished by the combination of targeting
of a fusion polypeptide into the periplasm of a bacterial cell to allow assembly of
a functional antibody, and the targeting of a fusion polypeptide onto the coat of
a filamentous phage particle during phage assembly to allow for convenient screening
of the library member of interest. Periplasmic targeting is provided by the presence
of a secretion signal domain in a fusion polypeptide. Targeting to a phage particle
is provided by the presence of a filamentous phage coat protein membrane anchor domain
(i.e., a cpIII- or cpVIII-derived membrane anchor domain) in a fusion polypeptide.
[0333] The diversity of a filamentous phage-based combinatorial antibody library can be
increased by shuffling of the heavy and light chain genes, by altering one or more
of the complementarity determining regions of the cloned heavy chain genes of the
library, or by introducing random mutations into the library by error-prone polymerase
chain reactions. Additional methods for screening phagemid libraries are described
in U.S. Patent No. 5,580,717; 5,427,908; 5,403,484; and 5,223,409.
[0334] Another method for the screening of large combinatorial antibody libraries has been
developed, utilizing expression of populations of diverse heavy and light chain sequences
on the surface of a filamentous bacteriophage, such as M13, fl or fd (U.S. Patent
No. 5,698,426). Two populations of diverse heavy (Hc) and light (Lc) chain sequences
are synthesized by polymerase chain reaction (PCR™). These populations are cloned
into separate M13-based vector containing elements necessary for expression. The heavy
chain vector contains a gene VIII (gVIII) coat protein sequence so that translation
of the heavy chain sequences produces gVIII-Hc fusion proteins. The populations of
two vectors are randomly combined such that only the vector portions containing the
Hc and Lc sequences are joined into a single circular vector.
[0335] The combined vector directs the co-expression of both He and Lc sequences for assembly
of the two polypeptides and surface expression on M13 (U.S. Patent No. 5,698,426).
The combining step randomly brings together different He and Lc encoding sequences
within two diverse populations into a single vector. The vector sequences donated
from each independent vector are necessary for production of viable phage. Also, since
the pseudo gVIII sequences are contained in only one of the two starting vectors,
co-expression of functional antibody fragments as Lc associated gVIII-Hc fusion proteins
cannot be accomplished on the phage surface until the vector sequences are linked
in the single vector.
[0336] Surface expression of the antibody library is performed in an amber suppressor strain.
An amber stop codon between the He sequence and the gVIII sequence unlinks the two
components in a non-suppressor strain. Isolating the phage produced from the non-suppressor
strain and infecting a suppressor strain will link the He sequences to the gVIII sequence
during expression. Culturing the suppressor strain after infection allows the coexpression
on the surface of M13 of all antibody species within the library as gVIII fusion proteins
(gVIII-Fab fusion proteins). Alternatively, the DNA can be isolated from the non-suppressor
strain and then introduced into a suppressor strain to accomplish the same effect.
[0337] The surface expression library is screened for specific Fab fragments that bind preselected
molecules by standard affinity isolation procedures. Such methods include, for example,
panning (Parmley and Smith, 1988), affinity chromatography and solid phase blotting
procedures. Panning is preferred, because high titers of phage can be screened easily,
quickly and in small volumes. Furthermore, this procedure can select minor Fab fragments
species within the population, which otherwise would have been undetectable, and amplified
to substantially homogenous populations. The selected Fab fragments can be characterized
by sequencing the nucleic acids encoding the polypeptides after amplification of the
phage population.
[0338] Another method for producing diverse libraries of antibodies and screening for desirable
binding specificities is described in U.S. Patent No. 5,667,988 and U.S. Patent No.
5,759,817. The method involves the preparation of libraries of heterodimeric immunoglobulin
molecules in the form of phagemid libraries using degenerate oligonucleotides and
primer extension reactions to incorporate the degeneracies into the CDR regions of
the immunoglobulin variable heavy and light chain variable domains, and display of
the mutagenized polypeptides on the surface of the phagemid. Thereafter, the display
protein is screened for the ability to bind to a preselected antigen.
[0339] The method for producing a heterodimeric immunoglobulin molecule generally involves
(1) introducing a heavy or light chain V region-coding gene of interest into the phagemid
display vector; (2) introducing a randomized binding site into the phagemid display
protein vector by primer extension with an oligonucleotide containing regions of homology
to a CDR of the antibody V region gene and containing regions of degeneracy for producing
randomized coding sequences to form a large population of display vectors each capable
of expressing different putative binding sites displayed on a phagemid surface display
protein; (3) expressing the display protein and binding site on the surface of a filamentous
phage particle; and (4) isolating (screening) the surface-expressed phage particle
using affinity techniques such as panning of phage particles against a preselected
antigen, thereby isolating one or more species of phagemid containing a display protein
containing a binding site that binds a preselected antigen.
[0340] A further variation of this method for producing diverse libraries of antibodies
and screening for desirable binding specificities is described in U.S. Patent No.
5,702,892. In this method, only heavy chain sequences are employed, the heavy chain
sequences are randomized at all nucleotide positions which encode either the CDRI
or CDRIII hypervariable region, and the genetic variability in the CDRs is generated
independent of any biological process.
[0341] In the method, two libraries are engineered to genetically shuffle oligonucleotide
motifs within the framework of the heavy chain gene structure. Through random mutation
of either CDRI or CDRIII, the hypervariable regions of the heavy chain gene were reconstructed
to result in a collection of highly diverse sequences. The heavy chain proteins encoded
by the collection of mutated gene sequences possessed the potential to have all of
the binding characteristics of an immunoglobulin while requiring only one of the two
immunoglobulin chains.
[0342] Specifically, the method is practiced in the absence of the immunoglobulin light
chain protein. A library of phage displaying modified heavy chain proteins is incubated
with an immobilized ligand to select clones encoding recombinant proteins that specifically
bind the immobilized ligand. The bound phage are then dissociated from the immobilized
ligand and amplified by growth in bacterial host cells. Individual viral plaques,
each expressing a different recombinant protein, are expanded, and individual clones
can then be assayed for binding activity.
E4. Anti-Aminophospholipid Antibodies from Human Patients
[0343] Antibodies against aminophospholipids, particularly phosphatidylserine and phosphatidylethanolamine,
occur in the human population, where they are correlated with certain disease states.
Anti-aminophospholipid antibodies are part of the heterogeneous anti-phospholipid
antibodies (aPL), observed to have families of different specificities and classes.
Primary anti-phospholipid syndrome (APS) has even been separated from other forms
of autoimmune disease associated with anti-phospholipid antibody production.
[0344] Anti-PS antibodies are particularly associated with recurrent pregnancy loss (Rote
et al., 1995; Rote, 1996; Vogt
et al., 1996; Vogt
et al., 1997) and with the autoimmune disease, systemic lupus erythematosus (SLE or "lupus")
(Branch
et al., 1987). Anti-PE antibodies have also been reported in human patients, particularly
those with autoimmune diseases (Staub
et al., 1989). Branch
et al. (1987) reported that 80% of patients with lupus anticoagulant (LA or LAC) had autoantibodies
that recognized PE; with Drouvalakis and Buchanan (1998) increasing this number to
95% PE-positives from autoimmune LAC sera.
[0345] Anti-phospholipid antibodies are not to be confused with anti-endothelial cell antibodies
(AECA). although they can be found in the same patient. The existence of AECA has
been documented in a variety of clinical settings associated with vasculitis, such
as systemic sclerosis (SS). To study AECA, antibodies are obtained from patients that
do not have anti-phospholipid antibodies (aPL-negative sera).
[0346] The pathogenic role of AECA remains unclear, although Bordron
et al. (1998) very recently suggested that AECA may initiate apoptosis in endothelial cells,
which would be followed by PS transfer to the outer face of the membrane. They proposed
that this would account for the subsequent generation of the anti-phospholipid antibodies
that are sometimes seen in conjunction with AECA in patients with skin lesions or
connective tissue disease (Bordron
et al., 1998). However, although AECA binding to an apoptosis-inducing antigen was postulated,
these studies did not lead to the further characterization of AECA, still said to
represent an extremely heterogeneous family of antibodies reacting with different
(non-lipid) structures on endothelial cells (Bordron
et al., 1998).
[0347] Anti-phosphatidylserine antibodies are closely associated with pregnancy loss, pregnancy-induced
hypertension and intrauterine growth retardation. A phosphatidylserine-dependent antigen
has been shown to be expressed on the surface of a choriocarcinoma model (BeWo) of
differentiating cytotrophoblastic cells. indicating that it should be accessible
in vivo to circulating anti-phosphatidylserine antibodies (Rote
et al., 1995). Indeed, Vogt
et al. (1996) showed that the monoclonal antibody 3SB9b, which reacts with phosphatidylserine
but not cardiolipin, induced a significant reduction in both fetal and placental weights
in a mouse model for the anti-phospholipid antibody syndrome
[0348] These authors developed a model for explaining miscarriages associated with anti-phospholipid
antibodies: anti-phosphatidylserine antibody reveals sites for prothrombin binding
on the surface of the trophoblast, most likely by removing Annexin V (Vogt
et al., 1997). Trophoblast differentiation is associated with externalization of phosphatidylserine
from the inner to the outer surface of the plasma membrane. Normally, externalization
of phosphatidylserine is concurrent with binding of Annexin V, which prevents the
phosphatidylserine-rich surface from acting as a site for activation of coagulation.
Thus, when anti-phospholipid antibodies are present, they prevent Annexin V binding
and lead to a procoagulant state (Vogt
et al., 1997).
[0349] Anti-PE antibodies are frequently associated with lupus anticoagulants (LAC sera).
The role of PE and anti-PE in LAC is extremely complex, see,
e.g., Smirnov
et al. (1995), where various hypotheses are set forth. Smirnov
et al. (1995) report that, in the presence of activated protein C and PE, LAC plasma clots
faster than normal plasma. Rauch
et al. (1986) characterize LAC anti-phospholipid antibodies as prolonging the clotting
time in
in vitro coagulation assays.
[0350] Vlachoyiannopoulos
et al. (1993) tested SLE and APS sera by ELISA for antibodies to phosphatidylethanolamine
and cardiolipin, as compared to healthy blood donors. Both SLE and APS patients were
reported to present a higher titer of IgM anti-PE antibodies than normal subjects,
while the IgG and IgA anti-PE reactivity reportedly did not differ. It was suggested
that IgA and IgG anti-PE antibodies may occur in low titers as natural autoantibodies
in normal subjects (Vlachoyiannopoulos
et al., 1993).
[0351] Rauch
et al. (1986) produced hybridomas by fusing lymphocytes from 13 systemic lupus erythematosus
patients with a lymphoblastoid line. They demonstrated that the autoantibodies that
prolonged clotting time bound to hexagonal phase phospholipids, including natural
and synthetic forms of phosphatidylethanolamine (Rauch
et al., 1986). In contrast, lamellar phospholipids, such as phosphatidylcholine and synthetic
lamellar forms of phosphatidylethanolamine, had no effect on the anticoagulant activity
(Rauch
et al., 1986).
[0352] Rauch and Janoff went on to show that immunization of mice with phosphatidylethanolamine
in the hexagonal II phase, but not in the bilayer phase, resulted in the induction
of anti-phospholipid antibodies. These antibodies were strongly reactive with phosphatidylethanolamine
and had functional lupus anticoagulant activity characteristic of autoantibodies from
patients with autoimmune disease (Rauch and Janoff, 1990).
[0353] The hexagonal II phase form of aminophospholipids should thus be advantageously used
to generate antibodies for use in the present invention. Indeed, Trudell reported
that antibodies raised against TFA- (trifluoroacetyl-) protein adducts bind to TFA-phosphatidylethanolamine
in hexagonal phase phospholipid micelles, but not in lamellar liposomes (Trudell
et al., 1991a; incorporated herein by reference). The authors suggested that TFA-phosphatidylethanolamine
adducts that reside in non-lamellar domains on the hepatocyte surface could be recognition
sites for anti-TFA-adduct antibodies and potentially participate in immune-mediated
halothane hepatotoxicity (Trudell
et al., 1991a). It was later shown that these same antibodies cross-react with TFA-dioleoylphosphatidylethanolamine
when this adduct is incorporated into the surface of hepatocytes (Trudell
et al., 1991b), thus supporting this hypothesis.
[0354] Berard further explained the hexagonal II phase form of aminophospholipids, such
as PE (Berard
et al., 1993). In bilayers, phospholipids generally adopt a gel structure, crystalline
lattice or lamellar phase (Berard
et al., 1993). However, depending on the cholesterol content, protein and ionic environments,
phospholipids can easily change phases, adopting a hexagonal II phase (Berard
et al., 1993). It is this hexagonal II phase of aminophospholipids that is believed to be
immunogenic, as initial proposed for autoantibody generation in disease situations
(Berard
et al., 1993).
[0355] Qamar
et al. (1990) have developed a variation on the hexagonal aminophospholipid recognition
theme. Using phosphatidylethanolamine as a model, these authors reported that anti-PE
antibodies from aPL-positive SLE sera do not bind to PE, but in fact are directed
to lysophosphatidylethanolamine (1PE), a natural PE degradation product and a likely
contaminant of most PE preparations (Qamar
et al., 1990).
[0356] Other recent data indicate that most anti-phospholipid antibodies recognize phospholipid
in the context of nearby proteins (Rote, 1996; Chamley
et al., 1991). In plasma membranes, the majority of the phospholipid appears to be naturally
in non-antigenic bilaminar form (Rote, 1996). Accessory molecules may help facilitate
the transition to hexagonal antigenic forms and stabilize their expression (Galli
et al., 1993). For example, naturally occurring anti-phospholipid antibodies were first reported
to recognize complexes of cardiolipin or phosphatidylserine with β
2-glycoprotein I (β
2-GPI or apolipoprotein H, apoH) (Galli
et al., 1990; 1993). β
2-GPI is believed to stabilize phospholipids in antigenic conformations that do not
exist in pure phospholipids (McNeil
et al., 1990; U.S. Patent No. 5,344,758; Chamley
et al., 1991; Matsuura
et al., 1994). Prothrombin has also been implicated in the phospholipid stabilization process
(Bevers
et al., 1991).
[0357] Phospholipid-binding plasma proteins are also generally necessary for antibody recognition
of the electrically neutral or zwitterionic phospholipid, phosphatidylethanolamine.
Sugi and Mclntyre (1995) identified two prominent PE-binding plasma proteins as high
molecular weight kininogen (HMWK or HK) and low molecular weight kininogen (LMWK or
LK). Anti-PE antibodies from patients with SLE and/or recurrent spontaneous abortions
were shown not to recognize PE, HMWK or LMWK when they were presented independently
as sole antigens on ELISA plates (Sugi and McIntyre, 1995). Other anti-PE-positive
sera that did not react with PE-HMWK or PE-LMWK were suggested to recognize factor
XI or prekallikrein, which normally bind to HMWK (Sugi and McIntyre, 1995).
[0358] The validity of these results was confirmed by showing that intact HMWK binds to
various phospholipids, such as cardiolipin, phosphatidylserine, phosphatidylcholine
and phosphatidylethanolamine; but that anti-PE antibodies recognize only a kininogen-PE
complex, and do not recognize kininogens presented with other phospholipid substrates
(Sugi and McIntyre, 1996a reference). This indicates that PE induces unique antigenic
conformational changes in the kininogens that are not induced when the kininogens
bind to other phospholipids (Sugi and McIntyre, 1996a).
[0359] It has further been suggested that kininogens can bind to platelets by virtue of
exposed PE in the platelet membrane (Sugi and McIntyre, 1996b). Exogenously added
kininogen-dependent anti-PE was shown to increase thrombin-induced platelet aggregation
in vitro, but not to alter ADP-induced aggregation (Sugi and McIntyre, 1996b). In contrast,
kininogen independent anti-PE, which recognized PE
per se, was reported not augment thrombin-induced platelet aggregation. It was thus proposed
that kininogen dependent anti-PE may disrupt the normal anti-thrombotic effects of
kininogen (Sugi and McIntyre, 1996b).
[0360] Anti-aminophospholipid antibodies from human patients are therefore a mixture of
antibodies that generally recognize aminophospholipids stabilized by protein interactions
(Rote, 1996). The antibodies may bind to stabilized phospholipid epitopes, or may
bind to an epitope formed from the interaction of the phospholipid and amino acids
on the stabilizing protein (Rote, 1996). Either way, such antibodies clearly recognize
aminophospholipids in natural membranes in the human body, probably associated with
plasma proteins (McNeil
et al., 1990; Bevers
et al., 1991). These antibodies would thus be appropriate as starting materials for generating
an antibody for use in the therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs of the present
invention.
[0361] To prepare an anti-aminophospholipid antibody from a human patient, one would simply
obtain human lymphocytes from an individual having anti-aminophospholipid antibodies,
for example from human peripheral blood, spleen, lymph nodes, tonsils or the like,
utilizing techniques that are well known to those of skill in the art. The use of
peripheral blood lymphocytes will often be preferred.
[0362] Human monoclonal antibodies may be obtained from the human lymphocytes producing
the desired anti-aminophospholipid antibodies by immortalizing the human lymphocytes,
generally in the same manner as described above for generating any monoclonal antibody.
The reactivities of the antibodies in the culture supernatants are generally first
checked, employing one or more selected aminophospholipid antigen(s), and the lymphocytes
that exhibit high reactivity are grown. The resulting lymphocytes are then fused with
a parent line of human or mouse origin, and further selection gives the optimal clones.
[0363] The recovery of monoclonal antibodies from the immortalized cells may be achieved
by any method generally employed in the production of monoclonal antibodies. For instance,
the desired monoclonal antibody may be obtained by cloning the immortalized lymphocyte
by the limiting dilution method or the like, selecting the cell producing the desired
antibody, growing the selected cells in a medium or the abdominal cavity of an animal,
and recovering the desired monoclonal antibody from the culture supernatant or ascites.
[0364] Such techniques have been used, for example, to isolate human monoclonal antibodies
to
Pseudomonas aeruginosa epitopes (U.S. Patent No. 5,196,337 and 5,252,480); polyribosylribitol phosphate
capsular polysaccharides (U.S. Patent No. 4,954,449); the Rh(D) antigen (U.S. Patent
No. 5,665,356); and viruses, such as human immunodeficiency virus, respiratory syncytial
virus, herpes simplex virus, varicella zoster virus and cytomegalovirus (U.S. Patent
No. 5,652,138; 5,762,905; and 4,950,595).
[0365] The applicability of the foregoing techniques to the generation of human anti-aminophospholipid
antibodies is clear. Rauch
et al. (1986) generally used such methods to produce hybridomas by fusing lymphocytes from
SLE patients with a lymphoblastoid line. This produced human antibodies that bound
to hexagonal phase phospholipids, including natural and synthetic forms of phosphatidylethanolamine
(Rauch
et al., 1986).
[0366] Additionally, the methods described in U.S. Patent 5,648,077 can be used to form
a trioma or a quadroma that produces a human antibody against a selected aminophospholipid.
In a general sense, a hybridoma cell line comprising a parent rodent immortalizing
cell, such as a murine myeloma cell,
e.g. SP-2, is fused to a human partner cell, resulting in an immortalizing xenogeneic
hybridoma cell. This xenogeneic hybridoma cell is fused to a cell capable of producing
an anti-aminophospholipid human antibody, resulting in a trioma cell line capable
of generating human antibody effective against such antigen in a human. Alternately,
when greater stability is desired, a trioma cell line which preferably no longer has
the capability of producing its own antibody is made, and this trioma is then fused
with a further cell capable of producing an antibody useful against the aminophospholipid
antigen to obtain a still more stable hybridoma (quadroma) that produces antibody
against the antigen.
E5. Anti-Aminophospholipid Antibodies from Human Lymphocytes
[0367] In vitro immunization, or antigen stimulation, may also be used to generate a human anti-aminophospholipid
antibody. Such techniques can be used to stimulate peripheral blood lymphocytes from
both anti-aminophospholipid antibody-producing human patients, and also from normal,
healthy subjects. Indeed, Vlachoyiannopoulos
et al. (1993) reported that low titer anti-aminophospholipid antibodies occur in normal
subjects. Even if this were not the case, anti-aminophospholipid antibodies can be
prepared from healthy human subjects, simply by stimulating antibody-producing cells
with aminophospholipids
in vitro.
[0368] Such
"in vitro immunization" involves antigen-specific activation of non-immunized B lymphocytes,
generally within a mixed population of lymphocytes (mixed lymphocyte cultures, MLC).
In vitro immunizations may also be supported by B cell growth and differentiation factors
and Iymphokines. The antibodies produced by these methods are often IgM antibodies
(Borrebaeck
et al., 1986).
[0369] Another method has been described (U.S. Patent No. 5,681,729) wherein human lymphocytes
that mainly produce IgG (or IgA) antibodies can be obtained. The method involves,
in a general sense, transplanting human lymphocytes to an immunodeficient animal so
that the human lymphocytes "take" in the animal body; immunizing the animal with a
desired antigen, so as to generate human lymphocytes producing an antibody specific
to the antigen; and recovering the human lymphocytes producing the antibody from the
animal. The human lymphocytes thus produced can be used to produce a monoclonal antibody
by immortalizing the human lymphocytes producing the antibody, cloning the obtained
immortalized human-originated lymphocytes producing the antibody, and recovering a
monoclonal antibody specific to the desired antigen from the cloned immortalized human-originated
lymphocytes.
[0370] The immunodeficient animals that may be employed in this technique are those that
do not exhibit rejection when human lymphocytes are transplanted to the animals, Such
animals may be artificially prepared by physical, chemical or biological treatments.
Any immunodeficient animal may be employed. The human lymphocytes may be obtained
from human peripheral blood, spleen, lymph nodes, tonsils or the like.
[0371] The "taking" of the transplanted human lymphocytes in the animals can be attained
by merely administering the human lymphocytes to the animals. The administration route
is not restricted and may be, for example, subcutaneous, intravenous or intraperitoneal.
The dose of the human lymphocytes is not restricted, and can usually be 10
6 to 10
8 lymphocytes per animal. The immunodeficient animal is then immunized with the desired
aminophospholipid antigen.
[0372] After the immunization, human lymphocytes are recovered from the blood, spleen, lymph
nodes or other lymphatic tissues by any conventional method. For example, mononuclear
cells can be separated by the Ficoll-Hypaque (specific gravity: 1.077) centrifugation
method, and the monocytes removed by the plastic dish adsorption method. The contaminating
cells originating from the immunodeficient animal may be removed by using an antiserum
specific to the animal cells. The antiserum may be obtained by, for example, immunizing
a second, distinct animal with the spleen cells of the immunodeficient animal, and
recovering serum from the distinct immunized animal. The treatment with the antiserum
may be carried out at any stage. The human lymphocytes may also be recovered by an
immunological method employing a human immunoglobulin expressed on the cell surface
as a marker.
[0373] By these methods, human lymphocytes mainly producing IgG and IgA antibodies specific
to one or more selected aminophospholipid(s) can be obtained. Monoclonal antibodies
are then obtained from the human lymphocytes by immortalization, selection, cell growth
and antibody production.
E6. Transgenic Mice Containing Human Antibody Libraries
[0374] Recombinant technology is now available for the preparation of antibodies. In addition
to the combinatorial immunoglobulin phage expression libraries disclosed above, another
molecular cloning approach is to prepare antibodies from transgenic mice containing
human antibody libraries. Such techniques are described in U.S. Patent No. 5.545,807,
incorporated herein by reference.
[0375] In a most general sense, these methods involve the production of a transgenic animal
that has inserted into its germline genetic material that encodes for at least part
of an immunoglobulin of human origin or that can rearrange to encode a repertoire
of immunoglobulins. The inserted genetic material may be produced from a human source,
or may be produced synthetically. The material may code for at least part of a known
immunoglobulin or may be modified to code for at least part of an altered immunoglobulin.
[0376] The inserted genetic material is expressed in the transgenic animal, resulting in
production of an immunoglobulin derived at least in part from the inserted human immunoglobulin
genetic material. It is found the genetic material is rearranged in the transgenic
animal, so that a repertoire of immunoglobulins with part or parts derived from inserted
genetic material may be produced, even if the inserted genetic material is incorporated
in the germline in the wrong position or with the wrong geometry.
[0377] The inserted genetic material may be in the form of DNA cloned into prokaryotic vectors
such as plasmids and/or cosmids. Larger DNA fragments are inserted using yeast artificial
chromosome vectors (Burke
et al., 1987; incorporated herein by reference), or by introduction of chromosome fragments
(Richer and Lo, 1989; incorporated herein by reference). The inserted genetic material
may be introduced to the host in conventional manner, for example by injection or
other procedures into fertilized eggs or embryonic stem cells.
[0378] In preferred aspects, a host animal that initially does not carry genetic material
encoding immunoglobulin constant regions is utilized, so that the resulting transgenic
animal will use only the inserted human genetic material when producing immunoglobulins.
This can be achieved either by using a naturally occurring mutant host lacking the
relevant genetic material, or by artificially making mutants
e.g., in cell lines ultimately to create a host from which the relevant genetic material
has been removed.
[0379] Where the host animal carries genetic material encoding immunoglobulin constant regions,
the transgenic animal will carry the naturally occurring genetic material and the
inserted genetic material and will produce immunoglobulins derived from the naturally
occurring genetic material, the inserted genetic material, and mixtures of both types
of genetic material. In this case the desired immunoglobulin can be obtained by screening
hybridomas derived from the transgenic animal,
e.g., by exploiting the phenomenon of allelic exclusion of antibody gene expression or
differential chromosome loss.
[0380] Once a suitable transgenic animal has been prepared, the animal is simply immunized
with the desired immunogen. Depending on the nature of the inserted material, the
animal may produce a chimeric immunoglobulin,
e.g. of mixed mouse/human origin, where the genetic material of foreign origin encodes
only part of the immunoglobulin; or the animal may produce an entirely foreign immunoglobulin.
e.g. of wholly human origin, where the genetic material of foreign origin encodes an entire
immunoglobulin.
[0381] Polyclonal antisera may be produced from the transgenic animal following immunization.
Immunoglobulin-producing cells may be removed from the animal to produce the immunoglobulin
of interest. Preferably, monoclonal antibodies are produced from the transgenic animal,
e.g., by fusing spleen cells from the animal with myeloma cells and screening the resulting
hybridomas to select those producing the desired antibody. Suitable techniques for
such processes are described herein.
[0382] In an alternative approach, the genetic material may be incorporated in the animal
in such a way that the desired antibody is produced in body fluids such as serum or
external secretions of the animal, such as milk, colostrum or saliva. For example,
by inserting
in vitro genetic material encoding for at least part of a human immunoglobulin into a gene
of a mammal coding for a milk protein and then introducing the gene to a fertilized
egg of the mammal,
e.g., by injection, the egg may develop into an adult female mammal producing milk containing
immunoglobulin derived at least in part from the inserted human immunoglobulin genetic
material. The desired antibody can then be harvested from the milk. Suitable techniques
for carrying out such processes are known to those skilled in the art.
[0383] The foregoing transgenic animals are usually employed to produce human antibodies
of a single isotype, more specifically an isotype that is essential for B cell maturation,
such as IgM and possibly IgD. Another preferred method for producing human anti-aminophospholipid
antibodies is to use the technology described in U.S. Patent No. 5,545,806; 5,569,825;
5,625,126; 5,633,425; 5,661,016; and 5,770,429; wherein transgenic animals are described
that are capable of switching from an isotype needed for B cell development to other
isotypes.
[0384] In the development of a B lymphocyte, the cell initially produces IgM with a binding
specificity determined by the productively rearranged V
H and V
L regions. Subsequently, each B cell and its progeny cells synthesize antibodies with
the same L and H chain V regions, but they may switch the isotype of the H chain.
The use of mu or delta constant regions is largely determined by alternate splicing,
permitting IgM and IgD to be coexpressed in a single cell. The other heavy chain isotypes
(gamma, alpha, and epsilon) are only expressed natively after a gene rearrangement
event deletes the C mu and C delta exons. This gene rearrangement process, termed
isotype switching, typically occurs by recombination between so called switch segments
located immediately upstream of each heavy chain gene (except delta). The individual
switch segments are between 2 and 10 kb in length, and consist primarily of short
repeated sequences.
[0385] For these reasons, it is preferable that transgenes incorporate transcriptional regulatory
sequences within about 1-2 kb upstream of each switch region that is to be utilized
for isotype switching. These transcriptional regulatory sequences preferably include
a promoter and an enhancer element, and more preferably include the 5' flanking (
i.e., upstream) region that is naturally associated (
i.
e., occurs in germline configuration) with a switch region. Although a 5' flanking
sequence from one switch region can be operably linked to a different switch region
for transgene construction, in some embodiments it is preferred that each switch region
incorporated in the transgene construct have the 5' flanking region that occurs immediately
upstream in the naturally occurring germline configuration. Sequence information relating
to immunoglobulin switch region sequences is known (Mills
et al., 1990; Sideras
et al., 1989).
[0386] In the method described in U.S. Patent No. 5,545,806; 5,569,825; 5,625,126; 5,633,425;
5,661,016; and 5,770,429, the human immunoglobulin transgenes contained within the
transgenic animal function correctly throughout the pathway of B-cell development,
leading to isotype switching. Accordingly, in this method, these transgenes are constructed
so as to produce isotype switching and one or more of the following: (1) high level
and cell-type specific expression, (2) functional gene rearrangement, (3) activation
of and response to allelic exclusion, (4) expression of a sufficient primary repertoire,
(5) signal transduction, (6) somatic hypermutation, and (7) domination of the transgene
antibody locus during the immune response.
[0387] An important requirement for transgene function is the generation of a primary antibody
repertoire that is diverse enough to trigger a secondary immune response for a wide
range of antigens. The rearranged heavy chain gene consists of a signal peptide exon,
a variable region exon and a tandem array of multi-domain constant region regions,
each of which is encoded by several exons. Each of the constant region genes encode
the constant portion of a different class of immunoglobulins. During B-cell development,
V region proximal constant regions are deleted leading to the expression of new heavy
chain classes. For each heavy chain class, alternative patterns of RNA splicing give
rise to both transmembrane and secreted immunoglobulins.
[0388] The human heavy chain locus consists of approximately 200 V gene segments spanning
2 Mb, approximately 30 D gene segments spanning about 40 kb, six J segments clustered
within a 3 kb span, and nine constant region gene segments spread out over approximately
300 kb. The entire locus spans approximately 2.5 Mb of the distal portion of the long
arm of chromosome 14. Heavy chain transgene fragments containing members of all six
of the known V
H families, the D and J gene segments, as well as the mu, delta, gamma 3, gamma 1 and
alpha 1 constant regions are known (Berman
et al., 1988). Genomic fragments containing all of the necessary gene segments and regulatory
sequences from a human light chain locus is similarly constructed.
[0389] The expression of successfully rearranged immunoglobulin heavy and light transgenes
usually has a dominant effect by suppressing the rearrangement of the endogenous immunoglobulin
genes in the transgenic nonhuman animal. However, in certain embodiments, it is desirable
to effect complete inactivation of the endogenous Ig loci so that hybrid immunoglobulin
chains comprising a human variable region and a non-human (
e.g., murine) constant region cannot be formed, for example by trans-switching between
the transgene and endogenous Ig sequences. Using embryonic stem cell technology and
homologous recombination, the endogenous immunoglobulin repertoire can be readily
eliminated. In addition, suppression of endogenous Ig genes may be accomplished using
a variety of techniques, such as antisense technology.
[0390] In other aspects of the invention, it may be desirable to produce a trans-switched
immunoglobulin. Antibodies comprising such chimeric trans-switched immunoglobulins
can be used for a variety of applications where it is desirable to have a non-human
(
e.g., murine) constant region,
e.g., for retention of effector functions in the host. The presence of a murine constant
region can afford advantages over a human constant region, for example, to provide
murine effector functions (
e.g., ADCC, murine complement fixation) so that such a chimeric antibody may be tested
in a mouse disease model. Subsequent to the animal testing, the human variable region
encoding sequence may be isolated,
e.g., by PCR amplification or cDNA cloning from the source (hybridoma clone), and spliced
to a sequence encoding a desired human constant region to encode a human sequence
antibody more suitable for human therapeutic use.
E7. Humanized Anti-Aminophospholipid Antibodies
[0391] Human antibodies generally have at least three potential advantages for use in human
therapy. First, because the effector portion is human, it may interact better with
the other parts of the human immune system,
e.g., to destroy target cells more efficiently by complement-dependent cytotoxicity (CDC)
or antibody-dependent cellular cytotoxicity (ADCC). Second, the human immune system
should not recognize the antibody as foreign. Third, the half-life in the human circulation
will be similar to naturally occurring human antibodies, allowing smaller and less
frequent doses to be given.
[0392] Various methods for preparing human anti-aminophospholipids are provided herein.
In addition to human antibodies, "humanized" antibodies have many advantages. "Humanized"
antibodies are generally chimeric or mutant monoclonal antibodies from mouse, rat,
hamster, rabbit or other species, bearing human constant and/or variable region domains
or specific changes. Techniques for generating a so-called "humanized" anti-aminophospholipid
antibody are well known to those of skill in the art.
[0393] Humanized antibodies also share the foregoing advantages. First, the effector portion
is still human. Second, the human immune system should not recognize the framework
or constant region as foreign, and therefore the antibody response against such an
injected antibody should be less than against a totally foreign mouse antibody. Third,
injected humanized antibodies, as opposed to injected mouse antibodies, will presumably
have a half-life more similar to naturally occurring human antibodies, also allowing
smaller and less frequent doses.
[0394] A number of methods have been described to produce humanized antibodies. Controlled
rearrangement of antibody domains joined through protein disulfide bonds to form new,
artificial protein molecules or "chimeric" antibodies can be utilized (Konieczny
et al., 1981). Recombinant DNA technology can also be used to construct gene fusions between
DNA sequences encoding mouse antibody variable light and heavy chain domains and human
antibody light and heavy chain constant domains (Morrison
et al., 1984).
[0395] DNA sequences encoding the antigen binding portions or complementarity determining
regions (CDR's) of murine monoclonal antibodies can be grafted by molecular means
into the DNA sequences encoding the frameworks of human antibody heavy and light chains
(Jones
et al., 1986; Riechmann et
al., 1988). The expressed recombinant products are called "reshaped" or humanized antibodies,
and comprise the framework of a human antibody light or heavy chain and the antigen
recognition portions, CDR's, of a murine monoclonal antibody.
[0396] Another method for producing humanized antibodies is described in U.S. Patent No.
5,639,641. The method provides, via resurfacing, humanized rodent antibodies that
have improved therapeutic efficacy due to the presentation of a human surface in the
variable region. In the method: (1) position alignments of a pool of antibody heavy
and light chain variable regions is generated to give a set of heavy and light chain
variable region framework surface exposed positions, wherein the alignment positions
for all variable regions are at least about 98% identical; (2) a set of heavy and
light chain variable region framework surface exposed amino acid residues is defined
for a rodent antibody (or fragment thereof); (3) a set of heavy and light chain variable
region framework surface exposed amino acid residues that is most closely identical
to the set of rodent surface exposed amino acid residues is identified; (4) the set
of heavy and light chain variable region framework surface exposed amino acid residues
defined in step (2) is substituted with the set of heavy and light chain variable
region framework surface exposed amino acid residues identified in step (3), except
for those amino acid residues that are within 5Å of any atom of any residue of the
complementarity determining regions of the rodent antibody; and (5) the humanized
rodent antibody having binding specificity is produced.
[0397] A similar method for the production of humanized antibodies is described in U.S.
Patent No. 5,693,762; 5,693,761; 5,585,089; and 5,530,101. These methods involve producing
humanized immunoglobulins having one or more complementarity determining regions (CDR's)
and possible additional amino acids from a donor immunoglobulin and a framework region
from an accepting human immunoglobulin. Each humanized immunoglobulin chain usually
comprises, in addition to the CDR's, amino acids from the donor immunoglobulin framework
that are capable of interacting with the CDR's to effect binding affinity, such as
one or more amino acids that are immediately adjacent to a CDR in the donor immunoglobulin
or those within about 3Å as predicted by molecular modeling. The heavy and light chains
may each be designed by using any one, any combination, or all of the various position
criteria described in U.S. Patent No. 5,693,762; 5,693,761; 5,585,089; and 5,530,101.
When combined into an intact antibody, the humanized immunoglobulins are substantially
non-immunogenic in humans and retain substantially the same affinity as the donor
immunoglobulin to the original antigen.
[0398] An additional method for producing humanized antibodies is described in U.S. Patent
5,565,332 and 5,733,743. This method combines the concept of humanizing antibodies
with the phagemid libraries also described in detail herein. In a general sense, the
method utilizes sequences from the antigen binding site of an antibody or population
of antibodies directed against an antigen of interest. Thus for a single rodent antibody,
sequences comprising part of the antigen binding site of the antibody may be combined
with diverse repertoires of sequences of human antibodies that can, in combination,
create a complete antigen binding site.
[0399] The antigen binding sites created by this process differ from those created by CDR
grafting, in that only the portion of sequence of the original rodent antibody is
likely to make contacts with antigen in a similar manner. The selected human sequences
are likely to differ in sequence and make alternative contacts with the antigen from
those of the original binding site. However, the constraints imposed by binding of
the portion of original sequence to antigen and the shapes of the antigen and its
antigen binding sites, are likely to drive the new contacts of the human sequences
to the same region or epitope of the antigen. This process has therefore been termed
"epitope imprinted selection" (EIS).
[0400] Starting with an animal antibody, one process results in the selection of antibodies
that are partly human antibodies. Such antibodies may be sufficiently similar in sequence
to human antibodies to be used directly in therapy or after alteration of a few key
residues. Sequence differences between the rodent component of the selected antibody
with human sequences could be minimized by replacing those residues that differ with
the residues of human sequences, for example, by site directed mutagenesis of individual
residues, or by CDR grafting of entire loops. However, antibodies with entirely human
sequences can also be created. EIS therefore offers a method for making partly human
or entirely human antibodies that bind to the same epitope as animal or partly human
antibodies respectively. In EIS, repertoires of antibody fragments can be displayed
on the surface of filamentous phase and the genes encoding fragments with antigen
binding activities selected by binding of the phage to antigen.
[0401] Additional methods for humanizing antibodies contemplated for use in the present
invention are described in U.S. Patent No. 5,750,078; 5,502,167; 5,705,154; 5,770,403;
5,698,417; 5,693,493; 5,558,864; 4,935,496; and 4,816,567.
E8. Mutagenesis by PCR
[0402] Site-specific mutagenesis is a technique useful in the preparation of individual
antibodies through specific mutagenesis of the underlying DNA. The technique further
provides a ready ability to prepare and test sequence variants, incorporating one
or more of the foregoing considerations, whether humanizing or not, by introducing
one or more nucleotide sequence changes into the DNA.
[0403] Although many methods are suitable for use in mutagenesis, the use of the polymerase
chain reaction (PCR™) is generally now preferred. This technology offers a quick and
efficient method for introducing desired mutations into a given DNA sequence. The
following text particularly describes the use of PCR™ to introduce point mutations
into a sequence, as may be used to change the amino acid encoded by the given sequence.
Adaptations of this method are also suitable for introducing restriction enzyme sites
into a DNA molecule.
[0404] In this method, synthetic oligonucleotides are designed to incorporate a point mutation
at one end of an amplified segment. Following PCR™, the amplified fragments are blunt-ended
by treating with Klenow fragments, and the blunt-ended fragments are then ligated
and subcloned into a vector to facilitate sequence analysis.
[0405] To prepare the template DNA that one desires to mutagenize, the DNA is subcloned
into a high copy number vector, such as pUC19, using restriction sites flanking the
area to be mutated. Template DNA is then prepared using a plasmid miniprep. Appropriate
oligonucleotide primers that are based upon the parent sequence, but which contain
the desired point mutation and which are flanked at the 5' end by a restriction enzyme
site, are synthesized using an automated synthesizer. It is generally required that
the primer be homologous to the template DNA for about 15 bases or so. Primers may
be purified by denaturing polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis, although this is not
absolutely necessary for use in PCR™. The 5' end of the oligonucleotides should then
be phosphorylated.
[0406] The template DNA should be amplified by PCR™, using the oligonucleotide primers that
contain the desired point mutations. The concentration of MgCl
2 in the amplification buffer will generally be about 15 mM. Generally about 20-25
cycles of PCR™ should be carried out as follows: denaturation, 35 sec. at 95°C; hybridization,
2 min. at 50°C; and extension, 2 min. at 72°C. The PCR™ will generally include a last
cycle extension of about 10 min. at 72°C. After the final extension step, about 5
units of Klenow fragments should be added to the reaction mixture and incubated for
a further 15 min. at about 30°C. The exonuclease activity of the Klenow fragments
is required to make the ends flush and suitable for blunt-end cloning.
[0407] The resultant reaction mixture should generally be analyzed by nondenaturing agarose
or acrylamide gel electrophoresis to verify that the amplification has yielded the
predicted product. One would then process the reaction mixture by removing most of
the mineral oils, extracting with chloroform to remove the remaining oil, extracting
with buffered phenol and then concentrating by precipitation with 100% ethanol. Next,
one should digest about half of the amplified fragments with a restriction enzyme
that cuts at the flanking sequences used in the oligonucleotides. The digested fragments
are purified on a low gelling/melting agarose gel.
[0408] To subclone the fragments and to check the point mutation, one would subclone the
two amplified fragments into an appropriately digested vector by blunt-end ligation.
This would be used to transform E.
coli, from which plasmid DNA could subsequently be prepared using a miniprep. The amplified
portion of the plasmid DNA would then be analyzed by DNA sequencing to confirm that
the correct point mutation was generated. This is important as Taq DNA polymerase
can introduce additional mutations into DNA fragments.
[0409] The introduction of a point mutation can also be effected using sequential PCR™ steps.
In this procedure, the two fragments encompassing the mutation are annealed with each
other and extended by mutually primed synthesis. This fragment is then amplified by
a second PCR™ step, thereby avoiding the blunt-end ligation required in the above
protocol. In this method, the preparation of the template DNA, the generation of the
oligonucleotide primers and the first PCR™ amplification are performed as described
above. In this process, however, the chosen oligonucleotides should be homologous
to the template DNA for a stretch of between about 15 and about 20 bases and must
also overlap with each other by about 10 bases or more.
[0410] In the second PCR™ amplification, one would use each amplified fragment and each
flanking sequence primer and carry PCR™ for between about 20 and about 25 cycles,
using the conditions as described above. One would again subclone the fragments and
check that the point mutation was correct by using the steps outlined above.
[0411] In using either of the foregoing methods, it is generally preferred to introduce
the mutation by amplifying as small a fragment as possible. Of course, parameters
such as the melting temperature of the oligonucleotide, as will generally be influenced
by the GC content and the length of the oligo, should also be carefully considered.
The execution of these methods, and their optimization if necessary, will be known
to those of skill in the art, and are further described in various publications, such
as
Current Protocols in Molecular Biology, 1995.
[0412] When performing site-specific mutagenesis,
Table A can be employed as a reference.

E9. Antibody Fragments
[0413] Irrespective of the source of the original anti-aminophospholipid antibody, either
the intact antibody, antibody multimers, or any one of a variety of functional, antigen-binding
regions of the antibody may be used in the present invention. Exemplary functional
regions include scFv, Fv, Fab', Fab and F(ab')
2 fragments of the anti-aminophospholipid antibodies. Techniques for preparing such
constructs are well known to those in the art and are further exemplified herein.
[0414] The choice of antibody construct may be influenced by various factors. For example,
prolonged half-life can result from the active readsorption of intact antibodies within
the kidney, a property of the Fc piece of immunoglobulin. IgG based antibodies, therefore,
are expected to exhibit slower blood clearance than their Fab' counterparts. However,
Fab' fragment-based compositions will generally exhibit better tissue penetrating
capability.
[0415] Fab fragments can be obtained by proteolysis of the whole immunoglobulin by the non-specific
thiol protease, papain. Papain must first be activated by reducing the sulphydryl
group in the active site with cysteine, 2-mercaptoethanol or dithiothreitol. Heavy
metals in the stock enzyme should be removed by chelation with EDTA (2 mM) to ensure
maximum enzyme activity. Enzyme and substrate are normally mixed together in the ratio
of 1:100 by weight. After incubation, the reaction can be stopped by irreversible
alkylation of the thiol group with iodoacetamide or simply by dialysis. The completeness
of the digestion should be monitored by SDS-PAGE and the various fractions separated
by protein A-Sepharose or ion exchange chromatography.
[0416] The usual procedure for preparation of F(ab')
2 fragments from IgG of rabbit and human origin is limited proteolysis by the enzyme
pepsin. The conditions, 100x antibody excess w/w in acetate buffer at pH 4.5, 37°C,
suggest that antibody is cleaved at the C-terminal side of the inter-heavy-chain disulfide
bond. Rates of digestion of mouse IgG may vary with subclass and it may be difficult
to obtain high yields of active F(ab')
2 fragments without some undigested or completely degraded IgG. In particular, IgG
2b is highly susceptible to complete degradation. The other subclasses require different
incubation conditions to produce optimal results, all of which is known in the art.
[0417] Digestion of rat IgG by pepsin requires conditions including dialysis in 0.1 M acetate
buffer, pH 4.5, and then incubation for four hours with 1% w/w pepsin; IgG
1 and IgG
2a digestion is improved if first dialyzed against 0.1 M formate buffer, pH 2.8, at
4°C, for 16 hours followed by acetate buffer. IgG
2b gives more consistent results with incubation in staphylococcal V8 protease (3% w/w)
in 0.1 M sodium phosphate buffer, pH 7.8, for four hours at 37°C.
[0418] The following patents and patent applications further supplement the present teachings
regarding the preparation and use of functional, antigen-binding regions of antibodies,
including scFv, Fv, Fab', Fab and F(ab')
2 fragments of the anti-aminophospholipid antibodies: U.S. Patent Nos. 5,855,866 5,965,132,
6,004,555, 6,093,399 and 5,877,289.
E10. Antibody Conjugates
[0419] Anti-aminophospholipid antibodies may be conjugated to anti-cellular or cytotoxic
agents, to prepare "immunotoxins"; or operatively associated with components that
are capable of directly or indirectly stimulating coagulation, thus forming a "coaguligand".
In coaguligands, the targeting agents may be directly linked to a direct or indirect
coagulation factor, or may be linked to a second binding region that binds and then
releases a direct or indirect coagulation factor. The 'second binding region' approach
generally uses a coagulant-binding antibody as a second binding region, thus resulting
in a bispecific antibody construct. The preparation and use of bispecific antibodies
in general is well known in the art, and is further disclosed
[0420] In the preparation of immunotoxins, coaguligands and bispecific antibodies, recombinant
expression may be employed. The nucleic acid sequences encoding the chosen antibody-based
targeting agent are attached, in-frame, to nucleic acid sequences encoding the chosen
toxin, coagulant, or second binding region to create an expression unit or vector.
Recombinant expression results in translation of the new nucleic acid, to yield the
desired protein product. Although antibody-encoding nucleic acids are employed. rather
than protein binding ligands, the recombinant approach is essentially the same as
those described hereinabove.
[0421] Returning to conjugate technology, the preparation of immunotoxins is generally well
known in the art. However, certain advantages may be achieved through the application
of certain preferred technology, both in the preparation of the immunotoxins and in
their purification for subsequent clinical administration. For example, while IgG
based immunotoxins will typically exhibit better binding capability and slower blood
clearance than their Fab' counterparts, Fab' fragment-based immunotoxins will generally
exhibit better tissue penetrating capability as compared to IgG based immunotoxins.
[0422] Additionally, while numerous types of disulfide-bond containing linkers are known
that can be successfully employed to conjugate the toxin moiety to the targeting agent,
certain linkers will generally be preferred over other linkers, based on differing
pharmacological characteristics and capabilities. For example, linkers that contain
a disulfide bond that is sterically "hindered" are to be preferred, due to their greater
stability
in vivo, thus preventing release of the toxin moiety prior to binding at the site of action.
[0423] A wide variety of cytotoxic agents are known that may be conjugated to anti-aminophospholipid
antibodies, including plant-, fungus- and bacteria-derived toxins, such as ricin A
chain or deglycosylated A chain. The cross-linking of a toxin A chain to a targeting
agent, in certain cases, requires a cross-linker that presents disulfide functions.
The reason for this is unclear, but is likely due to a need for certain toxin moieties
to be readily releasable from the targeting agent once the agent has "delivered" the
toxin to the targeted cells.
[0424] Each type of cross-linker, as well as how the cross-linking is performed, will tend
to vary the pharmacodynamics of the resultant conjugate. Ultimately, in cases where
a releasable toxin is contemplated. one desires to have a conjugate that will remain
intact under conditions found everywhere in the body except the intended site of action,
at which point it is desirable that the conjugate have good "release" characteristics.
Therefore, the particular cross-linking scheme, including in particular the particular
cross-linking reagent used and the structures that are cross-linked. will be of some
significance.
[0425] Depending on the specific toxin compound used as part of the fusion protein, it may
be necessary to provide a peplide spacer operatively attaching the targeting agent
and the toxin compound which is capable of folding into a disulfide-bonded loop structure.
Proteolytic cleavage within the loop would then yield a heterodimeric polypeptide
wherein the targeting agent and the toxin compound are linked by only a single disulfide
bond. An example of such a toxin is a Ricin A-chain toxin.
[0426] When certain other toxin compounds are utilized, a non-cleavable peptide spacer may
be provided to operatively attach the targeting agent and the toxin compound of the
fusion protein. Toxins which may be used in conjunction with non-cleavable peptide
spacers are those which may, themselves, be converted by proteolytic cleavage, into
a cytotoxic disulfide-bonded form. An example of such a toxin compound is a
Pseudonomas exotoxin compound.
[0427] There may be circumstances, such as when the target antigen does not internalize
by a route consistent with efficient intoxication by targeting agent/toxin compounds,
such as immunotoxins, where one will desire to target chemotherapeutic agents such
as anti-tumor drugs. other cytokines, antimetabolites, alkylating agents. hormones,
and the like. A variety of chemotherapeutic and other pharmacological agents have
now been successfully conjugated to antibodies and shown to function pharmacologically.
Exemplary antineoplastic agents that have been investigated include doxorubicin, daunomycin,
methotrexate, vinblastine, and various others. Moreover, the attachment of other agents
such as neocarzinostatin, macromycin, trenimon and α-amanitin has been described.
[0428] Where coagulation factors are used in connection with the present invention. any
covalent linkage to the antibody or targeting agent should be made at a site distinct
from its functional coagulating site. The compositions are thus "linked" in any operative
manner that allows each region to perform its intended function without significant
impairment. Thus, the targeting agents bind to aminophospholipids, and the coagulation
factor promotes blood clotting.
E11. Biochemical Cross-linkers
[0429] In additional to the general information provided above, anti-aminophospholipid antibodies
may be conjugated to anti-cellular or cytotoxic agents using certain preferred biochemical
cross-linkers. Cross-linking reagents are used to form molecular bridges that tie
together functional groups of two different molecules. To link two different proteins
in a step-wise manner, hetero-bifunctional cross-linkers can be used that eliminate
unwanted homopolymer formation. Exemplary hetero-bifunctional cross-linkers are referenced
in
Table B.
TABLE B
| HETERO-BIFUNCTIONAL CROSS-LINKERS |
| linker |
Reactive Toward |
Advantages and Applications |
Spacer Arm Length after cross-linking |
| SMPT |
Primary amines Sulfhydryls |
· Greater stability |
11.2 A |
| SPDP |
Primary amines Sulfhydryls |
· Thiolation |
6.8 A |
| ·Cleavable cross-linking |
|
| LC-SPDP |
Primary amines Sulfhydryls |
· Extended spacer arm |
15.6 A |
| Sulfo-LC-SPDP |
Primary amines Sulfhydryls |
· Extended spacer arm |
15.6 A |
| · Water-soluble |
|
| SMCC |
Primary amines Sulfhydryls |
· Stable maleimide reactive group |
11.6 A |
| · Enzyme-antibody conjugation |
|
| · Hapten-carrier protein conjugation |
|
| Sulfo-SMCC |
Primary amines Sulfhydryls |
· Stable maleimide reactive group |
11.6 A |
| · Water-soluble |
|
| · Enzyme-antibody conjugation |
|
| MBS |
Primary amines Sulfhydryls |
· Enzyme-antibody conjugation |
9.9 A |
| · Hapten-carrier protein conjugation |
|
| Sulfo-MBS |
Primary amines Sulfhydryls |
· Water-soluble |
9.9A |
| SIAB |
Primary amines Sulfhydryls |
· Enzyme-antibody conjugation |
10.6 A |
| Sulfo-SIAB |
Primary amines Sulfhydryls |
· Water-soluble |
10.6 A |
| SMPB |
Primary amines Sulfhydryls |
· Extended spacer arm |
14.5 A |
| · Enzyme-antibody conjugation |
|
| Sulfo-SMPB |
Primary amines Sulfhydryls |
· Extended spacer arm |
14.5 A |
| · Water-soluble |
|
| EDC/Sulfo-NHS |
Primary amines Carboxyl groups |
· Hapten-Carrier conjugation |
0 |
| ABH |
Carbohydrates Nonselective |
· Reacts with sugar groups |
11.9 A |
[0430] Hetero-bifunctional cross-linkers contain two reactive groups: one generally reacting
with primary amine group (
e.g., N-hydroxy succinimide) and the other generally reacting with a thiol group (
e.g., pyridyl disulfide, maleimides, halogens,
etc.). Through the primary amine reactive group, the cross-linker may react with the
lysine residue(s) of one protein (
e.g., the selected antibody or fragment) and through the thiol reactive group, the cross-linker,
already tied up to the first protein, reacts with the cysteine residue (free sulfhydryl
group) of the other protein (
e.g., the coagulant).
[0431] Compositions therefore generally have, or are derivatized to have. a functional group
available for cross-linking purposes. This requirement is not considered to be limiting
in that a wide variety of groups can be used in this manner. For example. primary
or secondary amine groups, hydrazide or hydrazine groups, carboxyl alcohol, phosphate,
or alkylating groups may be used for binding or cross-linking.
[0432] The spacer arm between the two reactive groups of a cross-linkers may have various
length and chemical compositions. A longer spacer arm allows a better flexibility
of the conjugate components while some particular components in the bridge (
e.g., benzene group) may lend extra stability to the reactive group or an increased resistance
of the chemical link to the action of various aspects (
e.g., disulfide bond resistant to reducing agents). The use of peptide spacers, such as
L-Leu-L-Ala-L-Leu-L-Ala, is also contemplated.
[0433] It is preferred that a cross-linker having reasonable stability in blood will be
employed. Numerous types of disulfide-bond containing linkers are known that can be
successfully employed to conjugate targeting and toxic or coagulating agents. Linkers
that contain a disulfide bond that is sterically hindered may prove to give greater
stability
in vivo, preventing release of the agent prior to binding at the site of action. These linkers
are thus one preferred group of linking agents.
[0434] One of the most preferred cross-linking reagents for use in immunotoxins is SMPT,
which is a bifunctional cross-linker containing a disulfide bond that is "sterically
hindered" by an adjacent benzene ring and methyl groups. It is believed that steric
hindrance of the disulfide bond serves a function of protecting the bond from attack
by thiolate anions such as glutathione which can be present in tissues and blood,
and thereby help in preventing decoupling of the conjugate prior to the delivery of
the attached agent to the tumor site. It is contemplated that the SMPT agent may also
be used in connection with the bispecific ligands of this invention.
[0435] The SMPT cross-linking reagent, as with many other known cross-linking reagents,
lends the ability to cross-link functional groups such as the SH of cysteine or primary
amines (
e.g., the epsilon amino group of lysine). Another possible type of cross-linker includes
the hetero-bifunctional photoreactive phenylazides containing a cleavable disulfide
bond such as sulfosuccinimidyl-2-(p-azido salicylamido) ethyl-1,3'-dithiopropionate.
The N-hydroxy-succinimidyl group reacts with primary amino groups and the phenylazide
(upon photolysis) reacts non-selectively with any amino acid residue.
[0436] In addition to hindered cross-linkers, non-hindered linkers can also be employed
in accordance herewith. Other useful cross-linkers, not considered to contain or generate
a protected disulfide, include SATA, SPDP and 2-iminothiolane. The use of such cross-linkers
is well understood in the art.
[0437] Once conjugated, the conjugate is separated from unconjugated targeting and therapeutic
agents and from other contaminants. A large a number of purification techniques are
available for use in providing conjugates of a sufficient degree of purity to render
them clinically useful. Purification methods based upon size separation, such as gel
filtration, gel permeation or high performance liquid chromatography, will generally
be of most use. Other chromatographic techniques, such as Blue-Sepharose separation,
may also be used.
E12. Bispecific Antibodies
[0438] Bispecific antibodies are particularly useful in the coaguligand aspects of the present
invention. However, bispecific antibodies in general may be employed, so long as one
arm binds to an aminophospholipid and the bispecific antibody is attached to a therapeutic
agent, generally at a site distinct from the antigen binding sites. Bispecific antibodies
that bind to both PS and PE may also be used.
[0439] In general, the preparation of bispecific antibodies is also well known in the art.
One method involves the separate preparation of antibodies having specificity for
the targeted antigen, on the one hand. and (as herein) a coagulating agent on the
other. Peptic F(ab'γ)
2 fragments are prepared from the two chosen antibodies, followed by reduction of each
to provide separate Fab'γ
SH fragments. The SH groups on one of the two partners to be coupled are then alkylated
with a cross-linking reagent such as o-phenyleriedimaleimide to provide free maleimide
groups on one partner. This partner may then be conjugated to the other by means of
a thioether linkage, to give the desired F(ab'γ)
2 heteroconjugate. Other techniques are known wherein cross-linking with SPDP or protein
A is carried out. or a trispecific construct is prepared.
[0440] Another method for producing bispecific antibodies is by the fusion of two hybridomas
to form a quadroma. As used herein, the term "quadroma" is used to describe the productive
fusion of two B cell hybridomas. Using now standard techniques, two antibody producing
hybridomas are fused to give daughter cells, and those cells that have maintained
the expression of both sets of clonotype immunoglobulin genes are then selected.
[0441] A preferred method of generating a quadroma involves the selection of an enzyme deficient
mutant of at least one of the parental hybridomas. This first mutant hybridoma cell
line is then fused to cells of a second hybridoma that had been lethally exposed,
e.g., to iodoacetamide, precluding its continued survival. Cell fusion allows for the
rescue of the first hybridoma by acquiring the gene for its enzyme deficiency from
the lethally treated hybridoma, and the rescue of the second hybridoma through fusion
to the first hybridoma. Preferred, but not required, is the fusion of immunoglobulins
of the same isotype, but of a different subclass. A mixed subclass antibody permits
the use if an alternative assay for the isolation of a preferred quadroma.
[0442] In more detail, one method of quadroma development and screening involves obtaining
a hybridoma line that secretes the first chosen MAb and making this deficient for
the essential metabolic enzyme, hypoxanthine-guanine phosphoribosyltransferase (HGPRT).
To obtain deficient mutants of the hybridoma, cells are grown in the presence of increasing
concentrations of 8-azaguanine (1 x 10
-7M to 1 x 10
-5M). The mutants are subcloned by limiting dilution and tested for their hypoxanlhine/
aminopterin/ thymidine (HAT) sensitivity. The culture medium may consist of, for example,
DMEM supplemented with 10% FCS, 2mM L-Glutamine and 1 mM penicillin-streptomycin.
[0443] A complementary hybridoma cell line that produces the second desired MAb is used
to generate the quadromas by standard cell fusion techniques. Briefly, 4.5 x 10
7 HAT-sensitive first cells are mixed with 2.8 x 10
7 HAT-resistant second cells that have been pre-treated with a lethal dose of the irreversible
biochemical inhibitor iodoacetamide (5 mM in phosphate buffered saline) for 30 minutes
on ice before fusion. Cell fusion is induced using polyethylene glycol (PEG) and the
cells are plated out in 96 well microculture plates. Quadromas are selected using
HAT-containing medium. Bispecific antibody-containing cultures are identified using,
for example, a solid phase isotype-specific ELISA and isotype-specific immunofluorescence
staining.
[0444] In one identification embodiment to identify the bispecific antibody, the wells of
microtiter plates (Falcon, Becton Dickinson Labware) are coated with a reagent that
specifically interacts with one of the parent hybridoma antibodies and that lacks
cross-reactivity with both antibodies. The plates are washed, blocked, and the supernatants
(SNs) to be tested are added to each well. Plates are incubated at room temperature
for 2 hours, the supernatants discarded, the plates washed, and diluted alkaline phosphatase-anti-antibody
conjugate added for 2 hours at room temperature. The plates are washed and a phosphatase
substrate,
e.g., P-Nitrophenyl phosphate (Sigma, St. Louis) is added to each well. Plates are incubated,
3N NaOH is added to each well to stop the reaction, and the OD
410 values determined using an ELISA reader.
[0445] In another identification embodiment, microtiter plates pre-treated with poly-L-lysine
are used to bind one of the target cells to each well, the cells are then fixed,
e.g. using 1% glutaraldehyde, and the bispecific antibodies are tested for their ability
to bind to the intact cell. In addition, FACS, immunofluorescence staining, idiotype
specific antibodies, antigen binding competition assays, and other methods common
in the art of antibody characterization may be used in conjunction with the present
invention to identify preferred quadromas.
[0446] Following the isolation of the quadroma, the bispecific antibodies are purified away
from other cell products. This may be accomplished by a variety of protein isolation
procedures, known to those skilled in the art of immunoglobulin purification. Means
for preparing and characterizing antibodies are well known in the art (See,
e.g., Antibodies: A Laboratory Manual, 1988).
[0447] For example, supernatants from selected quadromas are passed over protein A or protein
G sepharose columns to bind IgG (depending on the isotype). The bound antibodies are
then eluted with,
e.g. a pH 5.0 citrate buffer. The elute fractions containing the BsAbs, are dialyzed against
an isotonic buffer. Alternatively, the eluate is also passed over an anti-immunoglobulin-sepharose
column. The BsAb is then eluted with 3.5 M magnesium chloride. BsAbs purified in this
way are then tested for binding activity by,
e.g., an isotype-specific ELISA and immunofluorescence staining assay of the target cells,
as described above.
[0448] Purified BsAbs and parental antibodies may also be characterized and isolated by
SDS-PAGE electrophoresis, followed by staining with silver or Coomassie. This is possible
when one of the parental antibodies has a higher molecular weight than the other,
wherein the band of the BsAbs migrates midway between that of the two parental antibodies.
Reduction of the samples verifies the presence of heavy chains with two different
apparent molecular weights.
F. Pharmaceutical Compositions
[0449] The most basic pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention will generally
comprise an effective amount of at least a first therapeutic agent-targeting agent
construct, dissolved or dispersed in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier or aqueous
medium. Combined therapeutics are also contemplated, and the same type of underlying
pharmaceutical compositions may be employed for both single and combined medicaments.
[0450] The phrases "pharmaceutically or pharmacologically acceptable" refer to molecular
entities and compositions that do not produce an adverse, allergic or other untoward
reaction when administered to an animal, or a human, as appropriate. As used herein,
"pharmaceutically acccptable carrier" includes any and all solvents, dispersion media,
coatings, antibacterial and antifungal agents, isotonic and absorption delaying agents
and the like. The use of such media and agents for pharmaceutical active substances
is well known in the art. Except insofar as any conventional media or agent is incompatible
with the active ingredient, its use in the therapeutic compositions is contemplated.
For human administration, preparations should meet sterility, pyrogenicity, general
safety and purity standards as required by FDA Office of Biologics standards. Supplementary
active ingredients can also be incorporated into the compositions.
F1. Parenteral Formulations
[0451] The therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs of the present invention will most
often be formulated for parenteral administration,
e.g., formulated for injection
via the intravenous, intramuscular, sub-cutaneous, transdermal, or other such routes.
including peristaltic administration and direct instillation into a tumor or disease
site (intracavity administration). The preparation of an aqueous composition that
contains a therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct as an active ingredient will
be known to those of skill in the art in light of the present disclosure. Typically,
such compositions can be prepared as injectables, either as liquid solutions or suspensions;
solid forms suitable for using to prepare solutions or suspensions upon the addition
of a liquid prior to injection can also be prepared; and the preparations can also
be emulsified.
[0452] The pharmaceutical forms suitable for injectable use include sterile aqueous solutions
or dispersions; formulations including sesame oil, peanut oil or aqueous propylene
glycol: and sterile powders for the extemporaneous preparation of sterile injectable
solutions or dispersions. In all cases, the form should be sterile and fluid to the
extent that syringability exists. It should be stable under the conditions of manufacture
and storage and should be preserved against the contaminating action of microorganisms,
such as bacteria and fungi.
[0453] The therapeutic agent-targeting agent compositions can be formulated into a sterile
aqueous composition in a neutral or salt form. Solutions of the therapeutic agent-targeting
agents as free base or pharmacologically acceptable salts can be prepared in water
suitably mixed with a surfactant, such as hydroxypropylcellulose. Pharmaceutically
acceptable salts, include the acid addition salts (formed with the free amino groups
of the protein), and those that are formed with inorganic acids such as, for example,
hydrochloric or phosphoric acids, or such organic acids as acetic, trifluoroacetic,
oxalic, tartaric, mandelic, and the like. Salts formed with the free carboxyl groups
can also be derived from inorganic bases such as, for example, sodium, potassium,
ammonium, calcium, or ferric hydroxides, and such organic bases as isopropylamine,
trimethylamine, histidine, procaine and the like.
[0454] Suitable carriers include solvents and dispersion media containing, for example,
water, ethanol, polyol (for example, glycerol, propylene glycol, and liquid polyethylene
glycol, and the like), suitable mixtures thereof, and vegetable oils. In many cases,
it will be preferable to include isotonic agents, for example, sugars or sodium chloride.
The proper fluidity can be maintained, for example, by the use of a coating, such
as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersion
and/or by the use of surfactants.
[0455] Under ordinary conditions of storage and use, all such preparations should contain
a preservative to prevent the growth of microorganisms. The prevention of the action
of microorganisms can be brought about by various antibacterial and antifungal agents,
for example, parabens, chlorobutanol, phenol, sorbic acid, thimerosal, and the like.
Prolonged absorption of the injectable compositions can be brought about by the use
in the compositions of agents delaying absorption, for example, aluminum monostearate
and gelatin.
[0456] Prior to or upon formulation, the therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs should
be extensively dialyzed to remove undesired small molecular weight molecules, and/or
lyophilized for more ready formulation into a desired vehicle, where appropriate.
Sterile injectable solutions are prepared by incorporating the active therapeutic
agent-targeting agents in the required amount in the appropriate solvent with various
of the other ingredients enumerated above, as desired, followed by filtered sterilization.
Generally, dispersions are prepared by incorporating the various sterilized active
ingredients into a sterile vehicle that contains the basic dispersion medium and the
required other ingredients from those enumerated above.
[0457] In the case of sterile powders for the preparation of sterile injectable solutions,
the preferred methods of preparation are vacuum-drying and freeze-drying techniques
that yield a powder of the active therapeutic agent-targeting agent ingredient, plus
any additional desired ingredient from a previously sterile-filtered solution thereof.
[0458] Suitable pharmaceutical compositions in accordance with the invention will generally
include an amount of the therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct admixed with
an acceptable pharmaceutical diluent or excipient, such as a sterile aqueous solution,
to give a range of final concentrations, depending on the intended use. The techniques
of preparation are generally well known in the art as exemplified by Remington's Pharmaceutical
Scicnces, 16th Ed. Mack Publishing Company, 1980. It should be appreciated that endotoxin
contamination should be kept minimally at a safe level, for example, less that 0.5
ng/mg protein. Moreover, for human administration, preparations should meet sterility,
pyrogenicity, general safety and purity standards as required by FDA Office of Biological
Standards.
[0459] Upon formulation, therapeutic agent-targeting agent solutions will be administered
in a manner compatible with the dosage formulation and in such amount as is therapeutically
effective. Formulations are easily administered in a variety of dosage forms, such
as the type of injectable solutions described above, but other pharmaceutically acceptable
forms are also contemplated,
e.g., tablets, pills, capsules or other solids for oral administration, suppositories,
pessaries, nasal solutions or sprays, aerosols, inhalants, liposomal forms and the
like. Pharmaceutical "slow release" capsules or compositions may also be used. Slow
release formulations are generally designed to give a constant drug level over an
extended period and may be used to deliver therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs
in accordance with the present invention.
F2. Liposomes and Nanocapsules
[0460] In certain embodiments, liposomes and/or nanoparticles may also be employed with
the therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs. The formation and use of liposomes
is generally known to those of skill in the art, as summarized below.
[0461] Liposomes are formed from phospholipids that are dispersed in an aqueous medium and
spontaneously form multilamellar concentric bilayer vesicles (also termed multilamellar
vesicles (MLVs). MLVs generally have diameters of from 25 nm to 4 µm. Sonication of
MLVs results in the formation of small unilamellar vesicles (SUVs) with diameters
in the range of 200 to 500 Å, containing an aqueous solution in the core.
[0462] Phospholipids can form a variety of structures other than liposomes when dispersed
in water, depending on the molar ratio of lipid to water. At low ratios the liposome
is the preferred structure. The physical characteristics of liposomes depend on pH,
ionic strength and the presence of divalent cations. Liposomes can show low permeability
to ionic and polar substances, but at elevated temperatures undergo a phase transition
which markedly alters their permeability. The phase transition involves a change from
a closely packed, ordered structure. known as the gel state, to a loosely packed,
less-ordered structure, known as the fluid state. This occurs at a characteristic
phase-transition temperature and results in an increase in permeability to ions, sugars
and drugs.
[0463] Liposomes interact with cells via four different mechanisms: Endocytosis by phagocytic
cells of the reticuloendothelial system such as macrophages and neutrophils; adsorption
to the cell surface, either by nonspecific weak hydrophobic or electrostatic forces,
or by specific interactions with cell-surface components; fusion with the plasma cell
membrane by insertion of the lipid bilayer of the liposome into the plasma membrane,
with simultaneous release of liposomal contents into the cytoplasm; and by transfer
of liposomal lipids to cellular or subcellular membranes, or
vice versa. without any association of the liposome contents. Varying the liposome formulation
can alter which mechanism is operative, although more than one may operate at the
same time.
[0464] Nanocapsules can generally entrap compounds in a stable and reproducible way. To
avoid side effects due to intracellular polymeric overloading, such ultrafine particles
(sized around 0.1 µm) should be designed using polymers able to be degraded
in vivo. Biodegradable polyalkyl-cyanoacrylate nanoparticles that meet these requirements
are contemplated for use in the present invention, and such particles may be are easily
made.
G. Therapeutic Kits
[0465] This invention also provides therapeutic kits comprising therapeutic agent-targeting
agent constructs for use in the present treatment methods. Such kits will generally
contain, in suitable container means, a pharmaceutically acceptable formulation of
at least one therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct. The kits may also contain
other pharmaceutically acceptable formulations, either for diagnosis/imaging or combined
therapy. For example, such kits may contain any one or more of a range of chemotherapeutic
or radiotherapeutic drugs; anti-angiogenic agents; anti-tumor cell antibodies; and/or
anti-tumor vasculature or anti-tumor stroma immunotoxins or coaguligands.
[0466] The kits may have a single container (container means) that contains the therapeutic
agent-targeting agent construct, with or without any additional components, or they
may have distinct containers for each desired agent. Where combined therapeutics are
provided, a single solution may be pre-mixed, either in a molar equivalent combination,
or with one component in excess of the other. Alternatively, each of the therapeutic
agent-targeting agent construct and other anti-cancer agent components of the kit
may be maintained separately within distinct containers prior to administration to
a patient.
[0467] When the components of the kit are provided in one or more liquid solutions, the
liquid solution is preferably an aqueous solution, with a sterile aqueous solution
being particularly preferred. However, the components of the kit may be provided as
dried powder(s). When reagents or components are provided as a dry powder, the powder
can be reconstituted by the addition of a suitable solvent. It is envisioned that
the solvent may also be provided in another container.
[0468] The containers of the kit will generally include at least one vial, test tube, flask,
bottle, syringe or other container means, into which the therapeutic agent-targeting
agent construct, and any other desired agent, may be placed and, preferably, suitably
aliquoted. Where separate components are included, the kit will also generally contain
a second vial or other container into which these are placed, enabling the administration
of separated designed doses. The kits may also comprise a second/third container means
for containing a sterile, pharmaceutically acceptable buffer or other diluent.
[0469] The kits may also contain a means by which to administer the therapeutic agent-targeting
agent construct to an animal or patient,
e.g., one or more needles or syringes, or even an eye dropper, pipette, or other such
like apparatus, from which the formulation may be injected into the animal or applied
to a diseased area of the body. The kits of the present invention will also typically
include a means for containing the vials, or such like, and other component, in close
confinement for commercíal sale, such as,
e.g., injection or blow-molded plastic containers into which the desired vials and other
apparatus are placed and retained.
H. Tumor Treatment
[0470] The most important use of the present invention is in the treatment of vascularized,
malignant tumors; with the treatment of benign tumors, such as BPH, also being contemplated.
The invention may also be used in the therapy of other diseases and disorders having,
as a component of the disease, prothrombotic blood vessels. Such vasculature-associated
diseases include diabetic retinopathy, macular degeneration, vascular restenosis,
including restenosis following angioplasty, arteriovenous malformations (AVM), meningioma,
hemangioma, neovascular glaucoma and psoriasis; and also angiofibroma, arthritis,
rheumatoid arthritis, atherosclerotic plaques, corneal graft ncovascularization, hemophilic
joints, hypertrophic scars, osler-weber syndrome, pyogenic granuloma retrolental fibroplasia,
scleroderma, trachoma, vascular adhesions, synovitis, dermatitis, various other inflammatory
diseases and disorders, and even endometriosis.
[0471] The therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct treatment is most preferably exploited
for the treatment of solid tumors. Such uses may employ therapeutic agent-targeting
agent constructs alone or in combination with chemotherapeutic, radiotherapeutic,
apoptopic, anti-angiogenic agents and/or immunotoxins or coaguligands. The therapeutic
agent-targeting agent construct methods are broadly applicable to the treatment of
any malignant tumor having a vascular component. Typical vascularized tumors are the
solid tumors, particularly carcinomas, which require a vascular component for the
provision of oxygen and nutrients. Exemplary solid tumors that may be treated using
the invention include, but are not limited to, carcinomas of the lung, breast, ovary,
stomach, pancreas, larynx, esophagus, testes, liver, parotid, biliary tract, colon,
rectum, cervix, uterus, endometrium, kidney, bladder, prostate, thyroid, squamous
cell carcinomas, adenocarcinomas, small cell carcinomas, melanomas, gliomas, neuroblastomas,
and the like.
[0472] The present invention is contemplated for use in the treatment of any patient that
presents with a solid tumor. However, in that this invention is particularly successful
in the treatment of solid tumors of moderate or large sizes, patients in these categories
are likely to receive more significant benefits from treatment in accordance with
the methods and compositions provided herein.
[0473] Therefore, in general, the invention can be used to treat tumors of about 0.3-0.5
cm and upwards, although it is a better use of the invention to treat tumors of greater
than 0.5 cm in size. From the studies already conducted in acceptable animal models,
it is believed that patients presenting with tumors of between about 1.0 and about
2.0 cm in size will be in the preferred treatment group of patients for therapeutic
agent-targeting agent therapy, although tumors up to and including the largest tumors
found in humans may also be treated.
[0474] Although the present invention is not generally intended for use in a preventative
or prophylactic treatment, use of the invention is certainly not confined to the treatment
of patients having tumors of only moderate or large sizes. There are many reasons
underlying this aspect of the breadth of the invention. For example, a patient presenting
with a primary tumor of moderate size or above may also have various other metastatic
tumors that are considered to be small-sized or even in the earlier stages of metastatic
tumor seeding. Given that the therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs, or combinations,
of the invention are generally administered into the systemic circulation of a patient,
they will naturally have effects on the secondary, smaller and metastatic tumors,
although this may not be the primary intent of the treatment. Furthermore, even in
situations where the tumor mass as a whole is a single small tumor, certain beneficial
anti-tumor effects will result from the use of the present therapeutic agent-targeting
agent treatment.
[0475] The guidance provided herein regarding the most suitable patients for use in connection
with the present invention is intended as teaching that certain patient's profiles
may assist with the selection of patients for treatment by the present invention.
The pre-selection of certain patients, or categories of patients, does not in any
way negate the basic usefulness of the present invention in connection with the treatment
of all patients having a vascularized tumor. A further consideration is the fact that
the assault on the tumor provided by the therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct
of the invention may predispose the tumor to further therapeutic treatment, such that
the subsequent treatment results in an overall synergistic effect or even leads to
total remission or cure.
[0476] It is not believed that any particular type of tumor should be excluded from treatment
using the present invention. However. the type of tumor cells may be relevant to the
use of the invention in combination with secondary therapeutic agents. particularly
chemotherapeutics and anti-tumor cell immunotoxins. As the effect of the present therapy
is to destroy the tumor vasculature, and as the vasculature is substantially or entirely
the same in all solid tumors, it will be understood that the present therapeutic agent-targeting
agent methodology is widely or entirely applicable to the treatment of all solid tumors,
irrespective of the particular phenotype or genotype of the tumor cells themselves.
[0477] Therapeutically effective doses of therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs are
readily determinable using data from an animal model, as shown in the studies detailed
herein. Experimental animals bearing solid tumors are frequently used to optimize
appropriate therapeutic doses prior to translating to a clinical environment. Such
models are known to be very reliable in predicting effective anti-cancer strategies.
For example, mice bearing solid tumors, such as used in the Examples, are widely used
in pre-clinical testing. The inventors have used such art-accepted mouse models to
determine working ranges of therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs that give
beneficial anti-tumor effects with minimal toxicity.
[0478] As is known in the art, there are realistic objectives that may be used as a guideline
in connection with pre-clinical testing before proceeding to clinical treatment. However,
due to the safety already demonstrated in accepted models, pre-clinical testing of
the present invention will be more a matter of optimization, rather than to confirm
effectiveness. Thus, pre-clinical testing may be employed to select the most advantageous
therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs, doses or combinations.
[0479] Any therapeutic agent-targeting agent dose, or combined medicament, that results
in any consistent detectable tumor vasculature destruction, thrombosis and anti-tumor
effects will still define a useful invention. Destructive, thrombotic and necrotic
effects should be observed in between about 10% and about 40-50% of the tumor blood
vessels and tumor tissues, upwards to between about 50% and about 99% of such effects
being observed. The present invention may also be effective against vessels downstream
of the tumor,
i.e., target at least a sub-set of the draining vessels, particularly as cytokines released
from the tumor will be acting on these vessels, changing their antigenic profile.
[0480] It will also be understood that even in such circumstances where the anti-tumor effects
of the therapeutic agent-targeting agent dose, or combined therapy, are towards the
low end of this range, it may be that this therapy is still equally or even more effective
than all other known therapies in the context of the particular tumor targets. It
is unfortunately evident to a clinician that certain tumors cannot be effectively
treated in the intermediate or long term, but that does not negate the usefulness
of the present therapy, particularly where it is at least about as effective as the
other strategies generally proposed.
[0481] In designing appropriate doses of therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs, or
combined therapeutics, for the treatment of vascularized tumors, one may readily extrapolate
from the animal studies described herein in order to arrive at appropriate doses for
clinical administration. To achieve this conversion, one would account for the mass
of the agents administered per unit mass of the experimental animal and. preferably,
account for the differences in the body surface area between the experimental animal
and the human patient. All such calculations are well known and routine to those of
ordinary skill in the art.
[0482] For example, in taking the successful doses of annexin-TF constructs in the mouse
studies, and applying standard calculations based upon mass and surface area, effective
doses for use in human patients would be between about 1 mg and about 500 mgs antibody
per patient, and preferably, between about 10 mgs and about 100 mgs antibody per patient.
[0483] Accordingly, using this information, the inventors contemplate that useful low doses
of therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs for human administration will be about
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 15, 20, 25 or about 30 mgs or so per patient; and useful
high doses of therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs for human administration
will be about 250, 275, 300, 325, 350, 375, 400, 425, 450, 475 or about 500 mgs or
so per patient. Useful intermediate doses of therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs
for human administration are contemplated to be about 35, 40, 50, 60. 70, 80, 90,
100, 125, 150, 175, 200 or about 225 mgs or so per patient.
[0484] Any particular range using any of the foregoing recited exemplary doses or any value
intermediate between the particular stated ranges is contemplated. It will also be
understood that therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs with coagulants can generally
be used at higher doses than those with toxins.
[0485] In general, dosage ranges of between about 5-100 mgs, about 10-80 mgs, about 20-70
mgs, about 25-60 mgs, or about 30-50 mgs or so of therapeutic agent-targeting agent
construct per patient will be preferred. Notwithstanding these stated ranges, it will
be understood that, given the parameters and detailed guidance presented herein, further
variations in the active or optimal ranges will be encompassed within the present
invention. Although doses in and around about 5 or 10 to about 70, 80, 90 or 100 mgs
per patient are currently preferred, it will be understood that lower doses may be
more appropriate in combination with other agents, and that high doses can still be
tolerated, particularly given the enhanced safety of the coagulant constructs. The
use of human or humanized antibodies or binding proteins renders the present invention
even safer for clinical use, further reducing the chances of significant toxicity
or side effects in healthy tissues.
[0486] The intention of the therapeutic regimens using the present invention is generally
to produce significant anti-tumor effects whilst still keeping the dose below the
levels associated with unacceptable toxicity. In addition to varying the dose itself,
the administration regimen can also be adapted to optimize the treatment strategy.
A currently preferred treatment strategy is to administer between about 1-500 mgs,
and preferably, between about 10-100 mgs of the therapeutic agent-targeting agent
construct, or therapeutic cocktail containing such, about 3 times within about a 7
day period. For example, doses would be given on about day 1, day 3 or 4 and day 6
or 7.
[0487] In administering the particular doses themselves, one would preferably provide a
pharmaceutically acceptable composition (according to FDA standards of sterility,
pyrogenicity, purity and general safety) to the patient systemically. Intravenous
injection is generally preferred, and the most preferred method is to employ a continuous
infusion over a time period of about 1 or 2 hours or so. Although it is not required
to determine such parameters prior to treatment using the present invention, it should
be noted that the studies detailed herein result in at least some thrombosis being
observed specifically in the blood vessels of a solid tumor within about 12-24 hours
of injection, and that widespread tumor necrosis is also observed in this period.
[0488] Naturally, before wide-spread use, clinical trials will be conducted. The various
elements of conducting a clinical trial, including patient treatment and monitoring,
will be known to those of skill in the art in light of the present disclosure. The
following information is being presented as a general guideline for use in establishing
such trials.
[0489] Patients chosen for the first therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct treatment
studies will have failed to respond to at least one course of conventional therapy,
and will have objectively measurable disease as determined by physical examination,
laboratory techniques, and/or radiographic procedures. Any chemotherapy should be
stopped at least 2 weeks before entry into the study. Where murine monoclonal antibodies
or antibody portions are employed, the patients should have no history of allergy
to mouse immunoglobulin.
[0490] Certain advantages will be found in the use of an indwelling central venous catheter
with a triple lumen port. The therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs should
be filtered, for example, using a 0.22 µ filter, and diluted appropriately, such as
with saline, to a final volume of 100 ml. Before use, the test sample should also
be filtered in a similar manner, and its concentration assessed before and after filtration
by determining the A
280. The expected recovery should be within the range of 87% to 99%, and adjustments
for protein loss can then be accounted for.
[0491] The therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs may be administered over a period
of approximately 4-24 hours, with each patient receiving 2-4 infusions at 2-7 day
intervals. Administration can also be performed by a steady rate of infusion over
a 7 day period. The infusion given at any dose level should be dependent upon any
toxicity observed. Hence, if Grade II toxicity was reached after any single infusion,
or at a particular period of time for a steady rate infusion, further doses should
be withheld or the steady rate infusion stopped unless toxicity improved. Increasing
doses of therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs should be administered to groups
of patients until approximately 60% of patients showed unacceptable Grade III or IV
toxicity in any category. Doses that are 2/3 of this value are defined as the safe
dose.
[0492] Physical examination, tumor measurements, and laboratory tests should, of course,
be performed before treatment and at intervals up to 1 month later. Laboratory tests
should include complete blood counts, serum creatinine, creatine kinase, electrolytes,
urea, nitrogen, SGOT. bilirubin, albumin, and total serum protein. Serum samples taken
up to 60 days after treatment should be. evaluated by radioimmunoassay for the presence
of the administered therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs, and antibodies against
any portions thereof. Immunological analyses of sera. using any standard assay such
as, for example, an ELISA or RIA, will allow the pharmacokinetics and clearance of
the anti-aminophospholipid therapeutic agent to be evaluated.
[0493] To evaluate the anti-tumor responses, the patients should be examined at 48 hours
to 1 week and again at 30 days after the last infusion. When palpable disease was
present, two perpendicular diameters of all masses should be measured daily during
treatment, within 1 week after completion of therapy, and at 30 days. To measure nonpalpable
disease, serial CT scans could be performed at 1-cm intervals throughout the chest,
abdomen, and pelvis at 48 hours to 1 week and again at 30 days. Tissue samples should
also be evaluated histologically, and/or by flow cytometry, using biopsies from the
disease sites or even blood or fluid samples if appropriate.
[0494] Clinical responses may be defined by acceptable measure. For example, a complete
response may be defined by the disappearance of all measurable tumor 1 month after
treatment. Whereas a partial response may be defined by a 50% or greater reduction
of the sum of the products of perpendicular diameters of all evaluable tumor nodules
1 month after treatment, with no tumor sites showing enlargement. Similarly, a mixed
response may be defined by a reduction of the product of perpendicular diameters of
all measurable lesions by 50% or greater 1 month after treatment, with progression
in one or more sites.
[0495] In light of results from clinical trials, such as those described above, an even
more precise treatment regimen may be formulated. Even so, some variation in dosage
may later be necessary depending on the condition of the subject being treated. The
physician responsible for administration will, in light of the present disclosure,
be able to determine the appropriate dose for the individual subject. Such optimization
and adjustment is routinely carried out in the art and by no means reflects an undue
amount of experimentation.
I. Tumor Imaging
[0496] There is further disclosed further provides combined tumor treatment and imaging
methods, based upon anti-aminophospholipid binding ligands. Anti-aminophospholipid
binding proteins or antibodies that are linked to one or more detectable agents are
envisioned for use in pre-imaging the tumor, forming a reliable image prior to the
treatment, which itself targets the aminophospholipid markers.
[0497] The anti-aminophospholipid imaging ligands or antibodies, or conjugates thereof,
will generally comprise an anti-aminophospholipid antibody or binding ligand operatively
attached, or conjugated to, a detectable label. "Detectable labels" are compounds
or elements that can be detected due to their specific functional properties, or chemical
characteristics, the use of which allows the component to which they are attached
to be detected, and further quantified if desired. Preferably, the detectable labels
are those detectable
in vivo using non-invasive methods.
[0498] Antibody and binding protein conjugates for use as diagnostic agents generally fall
into two classes, those for use in
in vitro diagnostics, such as in a variety of immunoassays, and those for use
in vivo diagnostic protocols. It is the
in vivo imaging methods that are particularly intended for use with the agents of this invention.
[0499] Many appropriate imaging agents are known in the art, as are methods for their attachment
to antibodies and binding ligands (see,
e.g., U.S. patents 5,021,236 and 4,472,509). Certain attachment methods involve the use
of a metal chelate complex employing, for example, an organic chelating agent such
a DTPA attached to the antibody (U.S. Patent 4,472,509). Monoclonal antibodies may
also be reacted with an enzyme in the presence of a coupling agent such as glutaraldehyde
or periodate. Conjugates with fluorescein markers are prepared in the presence of
these coupling agents or by reaction with an isothiocyanate.
[0500] An example of detectable labels are the paramagnetic ions. In this case, suitable
ions include chromium (III), manganese (II), iron (III), iron (II), cobalt (II), nickel
(II), copper (II), neodymium (III), samarium (III), ytterbium (III), gadolinium (III),
vanadium (II), terbium (III), dysprosium (III), holmium (III) and erbium (III), with
gadolinium being particularly preferred.
[0501] Ions useful in other contexts, such as X-ray imaging, include but are not limited
to lanthanum (III), gold (III), lead (II), and especially bismuth (III). Fluorescent
labels include rhodamine, fluorescein and renographin. Rhodamine and fluorescein are
often linked via an isothiocyanate intermediate.
[0502] In the case of radioactive isotopes for diagnostic applications, suitable examples
include
14carbon,
51chromium,
36chlorine,
57cobalt,
58cobalt, copper
67,
152Eu, gallium
67,
3hydrogen, iodine
123, iodine
125, iodine
131, indium
111,
59iron,
32phosphorus, rhenium
186, rhenium
188,
75selenium,
35sulphur, technetium
99m and yttrium
90.
125I is often being preferred for use in certain embodiments, and technicium
99m and indium
111 are also often preferred due to their low energy and suitability for long range detection.
[0503] Radioactively labeled anti-aminophospholipid antibodies and binding ligands for use
in the present invention may be produced according to well-known methods in the art.
For instance, intermediary functional groups that are often used to bind radioisotopic
metallic ions to antibodies are diethylenetriaminepentaacetic acid (DTPA) and ethylene
diaminetetracetic acid (EDTA).
[0504] Monoclonal antibodies can also be iodinated by contact with sodium or potassium iodide
and a chemical oxidizing agent such as sodium hypochlorite, or an enzymatic oxidizing
agent, such as lactoperoxidase. Anti-aminophospholipid antibodies according to the
invention may be labeled with technetium-
99m by ligand exchange process, for example, by reducing pertechnate with stannous solution,
chelating the reduced technetium onto a Sephadex column and applying the antibody
to this column; or by direct labeling techniques,
e.g., by incubating pertechnate, a reducing agent such as SNCl
2, a buffer solution such as sodium-potassium phthalate solution, and the antibody.
[0505] Any of the foregoing type of detectably labeled anti-aminophospholipid antibodies
and aminophospholipid binding ligands may be used in the imaging aspects of the present
invention. Although not previously proposed for use in combined tumor imaging and
treatment, the detectably-labeled annexins of U.S. Patent No. 5,627,036; WO 95/19791;
WO 95/27903; WO 95/34315; WO 96/17618; and WO 98/04294; may also be employed.
[0506] WO 95/27903 provides annexins for use in detecting apoptotic cells. Any of the annexin-detectable
agent markers of WO 95/27903 may be used herein, although it will be known that certain
of these are more suitable for
in vitro uses. WO 95/27903 provides detectable kits that may be adapted for combined use with
the therapeutics of the present invention.
[0507] Each of WO 95/19791; WO 95/34315; WO 96/17618; and WO 98/04294; are also incorporated
herein by reference for purposes of further describing radiolabelled annexin conjugates
for diagnostic imaging. The intent of each of the foregoing documents is to provide
radiolabelled annexins for use in imaging vascular thromboses, particularly in or
near the heart, such as in deep vein thrombosis, pulmonary embolism, myocardial infarction,
atrial fibrillation, problems with prosthetic cardiovascular materials, stroke, and
the like. These radiolabelled annexins were also proposed for use in imaging activated
platelets,
e.g., in conditions such as abscesses, restenosis, inflammation of joints, clots in cerebral
arteries,
etc.
[0508] U.S. Patent No. 5,627,036 also generally concerns 'annexine' (annexin) binding ligands
for use in analyzing platelet phosphatidylserine. It is explained in U.S. Patent No.
5,627,036 that hemostatic disorders, such as arterial, coronary and venous thrombosis,
are usually idiopathic, which makes prediction and prevention difficult. To recognize
such hemostatic disorders earlier, the detection of activated platelets is proposed.
The detectably labeled annexins compositions are thus disclosed in order to detect
activated platelets in hemostatic disorders (U.S. Patent No. 5,627,036).
[0509] Although proposing a wide range of diagnostic uses, none of WO 95/19791; WO 95/34315;
WO 96/17618; or WO 98/04294 make reference to imaging the vasculature of solid tumors.
Neither does U.S. Patent No. 5,627,036 make any such suggestions. Nonetheless, the
disclosed detectable and radiolabelled annexin compositions
per se may now be used to advantage in this regard, in light of the surprising discoveries
disclosed herein.
[0510] In particular, U.S. Patent No. 5,627,036 discloses annexins detectably labeled with
fluorescein isothiocyanate; radioisotopes of halogens, technetium, lead, mercury,
thallium or indium; and paramagnetic contrast agents.
[0511] WO 95/19791 provides conjugates of annexin bonded to an N
2S
2 chelate that can be radiolabelled by complexing a radionuclide to the chelate. WO
95/34315 provides annexin conjugates comprising one or more galactose residues with
the N
2S
2 chelate. The galactose moiety is said to facilitate the rapid elimination of the
radiolabelled conjugate from the circulation, reducing radiation damage to non-target
tissues and background 'noise.'
[0512] WO 96/17618 in turn provides annexin conjugates suitable for radiolabeling with diagnostic
imaging agents that comprise an annexin with a cluster of galactose residues and an
N
2S
2 chelate. These are reported to have a shorter circulating half-life and a higher
binding affinity for target sites than the foregoing radiolabeled annexin-galactose
conjugates.
[0513] Still further radiolabeled annexin conjugates are provided by WO 98/04294. These
conjugates comprise an annexin that is modified to provide an accessible sulphydryl
group conjugated to a hexose moiety that is recognized by a mammalian liver receptor.
Annexin multimer conjugates and chelating compounds conjugated via esterase-sensitive
bonds are also provided.
[0514] Each of WO 95/19791; WO 95/34315; WO 96/17618; and WO 98/04294 provide annexin conjugate
components for radiolabelling that are amenable to packaging in "cold kits",
i.e., wherein the components are provided in separate vials. U.S. Patent No. 5,627,036
similarly provides kits comprising a carrier being compartmentalized to receive detectably
labeled annexins that may be adapted for use herewith.
[0515] Although suitable for use in
in vitro diagnostics, the present aminophospholipid detection methods are more intended for
forming an image of the tumor vasculature of a patient prior to treatment with therapeutic
agent-targeting agent constructs. The
in vivo diagnostic or imaging methods generally comprise administering to a patient a diagnostically
effective amount of an anti-aminophospholipid antibody or binding ligand that is conjugated
to a marker that is detectable by non-invasive methods. The antibody- or binding ligand-marker
conjugate is allowed sufficient time to localize and bind to the aminophospholipid
expressed on the luminal surface of the tumor vasculature. The patient is then exposed
to a detection device to identify the detectable marker, thus forming an image of
the tumor vasculature.
[0516] The nuclear magnetic spin-resonance isotopes, such as gadolinium, are detected using
a nuclear magnetic imaging device; and radioactive substances, such as technicium
99m or indium
111, are detected using a gamma scintillation camera or detector. U.S. Patent No. 5,627,036
provides even further guidance regarding the safe and effective introduction of such
detectably labeled constructs into the blood of an individual, and means for determining
the distribution of the detectably labeled annexin extracorporally,
e.g., using a gamma scintillation camera or by magnetic resonance measurement.
[0517] Dosages for imaging embodiments are generally less than for therapy, but are also
dependent upon the age and weight of a patient. A one time dose of between about 0.1,
0.5 or about 1 mg and about 9 or 10 mgs, and more preferably, of between about 1 mg
and about 5-10 mgs of anti-aminophospholipid antibody- or aminophospholipid binding
ligand-conjugate per patient is contemplated to be useful. U.S. Patent No. 5,627,036;
and WO 95/19791, each incorporated herein by reference, are also instructive regarding
doses of detectably-labeled annexins.
J. Combination Therapies
[0518] The therapeutic agent-targeting agent treatment methods using agents of the present
invention may be combined with any other methods generally employed in the treatment
of the particular tumor, disease or disorder that the patient exhibits. So long as
a particular therapeutic approach is not known to be detrimental to the patient's
condition in itself, and does not significantly counteract the therapeutic agent-targeting
agent treatment, its combination with the present invention is contemplated.
[0519] In connection solid tumor treatment, methods using agents of the present invention
may be used in combination with classical approaches, such as surgery, radiotherapy,
chemotherapy, and the like. The present disclosure therefore provides combined therapies
in which therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs are used simultaneously with,
before, or after surgery or radiation treatment; or are administered to patients with,
before, or after conventional chemotherapeutic, radiotherapeutic or anti-angiogenic
agents, or targeted immunotoxins or coaguligands.
[0520] Combination therapy for other vascular diseases is also contemplated. A particular
example of such is benign prostatic hyperplasia (BPH), which may be treated with therapeutic
agent-targeting agent constructs in combination other treatments currently practiced
in the art. For example, targeting of immunotoxins to markers localized within BPH,
such as PSA.
[0521] When one or more agents are used in combination with the therapeutic agent-targeting
agent therapy, there is no requirement for the combined results to be additive of
the effects observed when each treatment is conducted separately. Although at least
additive effects are generally desirable, any increased anti-tumor effect above one
of the single therapies would be of benefit. Also, there is no particular requirement
for the combined treatment to exhibit synergistic effects, although this is certainly
possible and advantageous.
[0522] To practice combined anti-tumor therapy, one would simply administer to an animal
a therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct in combination with another anti-cancer
agent in a manner effective to result in their combined anti-tumor actions within
the animal. The agents would therefore be provided in amounts effective and for periods
of time effective to result in their combined presence within the tumor vasculature
and their combined actions in the tumor environment. To achieve this goal, the therapeutic
agent-targeting agent constructs and anti-cancer agents may be administered to the
animal simultaneously, either in a single composition, or as two distinct compositions
using different administration routes.
[0523] Alternatively, the therapeutic agent-targeting agent treatment may precede, or follow,
the anti-cancer agent treatment by,
e.g., intervals ranging from minutes to weeks. In certain embodiments where the anti-cancer
agent and therapeutic agent-targeting agent construct are applied separately to the
animal, one would ensure that a significant period of time did not expire between
the time of each delivery, such that the anti-cancer agent and therapeutic agent-targeting
agent composition would still be able to exert an advantageously combined effect on
the tumor. In such instances, it is contemplated that one would contact the tumor
with both agents within about 5 minutes to about one week of each other and, more
preferably, within about 12-72 hours of each other, with a delay time of only about
12-48 hours being most preferred.
[0524] Exemplary anti-cancer agents that would be given prior to the therapeutic agent-targeting
agent construct are agents that induce the expression of aminophospholipids within
the tumor vasculature. For example, agents that stimulate localized calcium production
and/or that induce apoptosis will generally result in increased PS expression, which
can then be targeted using a subsequent anti-PS therapeutic agent-targeting agent
construct. Therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs would be first administered
in other situations to cause tumor destruction, followed by,
e.g., anti-angiogenic therapies or therapies directed to targeting necrotic tumor cells.
[0525] The general use of combinations of substances in cancer treatment is well know. For
example, U.S. Patent No. 5,710,134 discloses components that induce necrosis in tumors
in combination with non-toxic substances or "prodrugs". The enzymes set free by necrotic
processes cleave the non-toxic "prodrug" into the toxic "drug", which leads to tumor
cell death. Also, U.S. Patent No. 5,747,469 discloses the combined use of viral vectors
encoding p53 and DNA damaging agents. Any such similar approaches can be used with
the present invention.
[0526] In some situations, it may even be desirable to extend the time period for treatment
significantly, where several days (2, 3, 4, 5, 6 or 7), several weeks (1, 2, 3, 4,
5, 6, 7 or 8) or even several months (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7 or 8) lapse between the
respective administrations. This would be advantageous in circumstances where one
treatment was intended to substantially destroy the tumor, such as the therapeutic
agent-targeting agent treatment, and another treatment was intended to prevent micrometastasis
or tumor re-growth, such as the administration of an anti-angiogenic agent. The EN
7/44 antibody of Hagemeier
et al. (1986) is not believed to be an effective anti-angiogenic agent, lacking binding
to a surface accessible antigen, amongst other deficiencies.
[0527] It also is envisioned that more than one administration of either the therapeutic
agent-targeting agent construct or the anti-cancer agent will be utilized. The therapeutic
agent-targeting agent constructs and anti-cancer agents may be administered interchangeably,
on alternate days or weeks; or a sequence of therapeutic agent-targeting agent treatment
may be given, followed by a sequence of anti-cancer agent therapy. In any event, to
achieve tumor regression using a combined therapy, all that is required is to deliver
both agents in a combined amount effective to exert an anti-tumor effect, irrespective
of the times for administration.
[0528] In terms of surgery, any surgical intervention may be practiced in combination with
the present invention. In connection with radiotherapy, any mechanism for inducing
DNA damage locally within tumor cells is contemplated, such as γ-irradiation, X-rays,
UV-irradiation, microwaves and even electronic emissions and the like. The directed
delivery of radioisotopes to tumor cells is also contemplated, and this may be used
in connection with a targeting antibody or other targeting means.
[0529] Cytokine therapy also has proven to be an effective partner for combined therapeutic
regimens. Various cytokines may be employed in such combined approaches. Examples
of cytokines include IL-1α IL-1β, IL-2, IL-3, IL-4, IL-5, IL-6. IL-7, IL-8, IL-9,
IL-10, IL-11, IL-12, IL-13, TGF-β, GM-CSF, M-CSF, G-CSF, TNFα, TNFβ, LAF, TCGF, BCGF,
TRF, BAF, BDG, MP, LIF, OSM, TMF, PDGF, IFN-α, IFN-β, IFN-γ. Cytokines are administered
according to standard regimens, consistent with clinical indications such as the condition
of the patient and relative toxicity of the cytokine. Uteroglobins may also be used
to prevent or inhibit metastases (U.S. Patent No. 5,696,092).
J1. Chemotherapeutics
[0530] In certain embodiments, the therapeutic agent-targeting agent constructs of the present
invention may be administered in combination with a chemotherapeutic agent. Chemotherapeutic
drugs can kill proliferating tumor cells, enhancing the necrotic areas created by
the overall treatment. The drugs can thus enhance the thrombotic action of the therapeutic
agent-targeting agent constructs.
[0531] By inducing the formation of thrombi in tumor vessels, the therapeutic agent-targeting
agent constructs can enhance the action of the chemotherapeutics by retaining or trapping
the drugs within the tumor. The chemotherapeutics are thus retained within the tumor,
while the rest of the drug is cleared from the body. Tumor cells are thus exposed
to a higher concentration of drug for a longer period of time. This entrapment of
drug within the tumor makes it possible to reduce the dose of drug, making the treatment
safer as well as more effective.
[0532] Irrespective of the underlying mechanism(s), a variety of chemotherapeutic agents
may be used in the combined treatment methods disclosed herein. Chemotherapeutic agents
contemplated as exemplary include,
e.g., tamoxifen, taxol, vincristine, vinblastine, etoposide (VP-16), adriamycin, 5-fluorouracil
(5FU), camptothecin, actinomycin-D, mitomycin C, cisplatin (CDDP), combretastatin(s)
and derivatives and prodrugs thereof.
[0533] As will be understood by those of ordinary skill in the art, the appropriate doses
of chemotherapeutic agents will be generally around those already employed in clinical
therapies wherein the chemotherapeutics are administered alone or in combination with
other chemotherapeutics. By way of example only, agents such as cisplatin, and other
DNA alkylating may be used. Cisplatin has been widely used to treat cancer, with efficacious
doses used in clinical applications of 20 mg/m
2 for 5 days every three weeks for a total of three courses. Cisplatin is not absorbed
orally and must therefore be delivered
via injection intravenously, subcutaneously, intratumorally or intraperitoneally.
[0534] Further useful agents include compounds that interfere with DNA replication, mitosis
and chromosomal segregation. Such chemotherapeutic compounds include adriamycin, also
known as doxorubicin, etoposide, verapamil, podophyllotoxin, and the like. Widely
used in a clinical setting for the treatment of neoplasms, these compounds are administered
through bolus injections intravenously at doses ranging from 25-75 mg/m
2 at 21 day intervals for adriamycin, to 35-50 mg/m
2 for etoposide intravenously or double the intravenous dose orally.
[0535] Agents that disrupt the synthesis and fidelity of polynucleotide precursors may also
be used. Particularly useful are agents that have undergone extensive testing and
are readily available. As such, agents such as 5-fluorouracil (5-FU) are preferentially
used by neoplastic tissue, making this agent particularly useful for targeting to
neoplastic cells. Although quite toxic, 5-FU, is applicable in a wide range of carriers.
including topical, however intravenous administration with doses ranging from 3 to
15 mg/kg/day being commonly used.
[0536] Exemplary chemotherapeutic agents that are useful in connection with combined therapy
are listed in
Table C. Each of the agents listed therein are exemplary and by no means limiting. The skilled
artisan is directed to "Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences" 15th Edition, chapter
33, in particular pages 624-652. Some variation in dosage will necessarily occur depending
on the condition of the subject being treated. The physician responsible for administration
will be able to determine the appropriate dose for the individual subject.
TABLE C
| Chemotherapeutic Agents Useful in Neoplastic Disease |
| CLASS |
TYPE OF AGENT |
NONPROPRIETARY NAMES (OTHER NAMES) |
DISEASE |
| Alkylating Agents |
Nitrogen Mustards |
Mechlorethamine (HN2) |
Hodgkin's disease, non-Hodgkin's lymphomas |
| Cyclophosphamide Ifosfamide |
Acute and chronic lymphocytic leukemias, Hodgkin's disease, non-Hodgkin's lymphomas,
multiple myeloma, neuroblastoma, breast, ovary, lung, Wilms' tumor, cervix, testis,
soft-tissue sarcomas |
| Melphalan (L-sarcolysin) |
Multiple myeloma, breast, ovary |
| Chlorambucil |
Chronic lymphocytic leukemia, primary macroglobulinemia, Hodgkin's disease, non-Hodgkin's
lymphomas |
| Ethylenimenes and Methylmelamines |
Hexamethylmelamine |
Ovary |
| Thiotepa |
Bladder, breast, ovary |
| Alkyl Sulfonates |
Busulfan |
Chronic granulocytic leukemia |
| Nitrosoureas |
Carmustine (BCNU) |
Hodgkin's disease, non-Hodgkin's lymphomas, primary brain tumors, multiple myeloma,
malignant melanoma |
| Lomustine (CCNU) |
Hodgkin's disease, non-Hodgkin's lymphomas, primary brain tumors, small-cell lung |
| Semustine (methyl-CCNU) |
Primary brain tumors, stomach, colon |
| Streptozocin (streptozotocin) |
Malignant pancreatic insulinoma, malignant carcinoid |
| Triazines |
Dacarbazine (DTIC; dimethyltriazenoimidaz olecarboxamide) |
Malignant melanoma, Hodgkin's disease, soft-tissue sarcomas |
| Antimetabolites |
Folic Acid Analogs |
Methotrexate (amethopterin) |
Acute lymphocytic leukemia, choriocarcinoma, mycosis fungoides, breast, head and neck,
lung, osteogenic sarcoma |
| Pyrimidine Analogs |
Fluouracil (5-fluorouracil; 5-FU) |
Breast, colon, stomach, |
| Floxuridine (fluorodeoxyuridine; FUdR) |
pancreas, ovary, head and neck, urinary bladder, premalignant skin lesions (topical) |
| Cytarabine (cytosine arabinoside) |
Acute granulocytic and acute lymphocytic leukemias |
| Purine Analogs and Related Inhibitors |
Mercaptopurine (6-mercaptopurine; 6-MP) |
Acute lymphocytic, acute granulocytic and chronic granulocytic leukemias |
| Thioguanine (6-thioguanine; TG) |
Acute granulocytic, acute lymphocytic and chronic granulocytic leukemias |
| Pentostatin (2-deoxycoformycin) |
Hairy cell leukemia, mycosis fungoides, chronic lymphocytic leukemia |
| Natural Products |
Vinca Alkaloids |
Vinblastine (VLB) |
Hodgkin's disease, non-Hodgkin's lymphomas, breast, testis |
| Vincristine |
Acute lymphocytic leukemia, neuroblastoma, Wilms' tumor, rhabdomyosarcoma, Hodgkin's
disease, non-Hodgkin's lymphomas, small-cell lung |
| Epipodophyllotoxins |
Etoposide Tertiposide |
Testis, small-cell lung and other lung, breast, Hodgkin's disease, non-Hodgkin's lymphomas,
acute granulocytic leukemia, Kaposi's sarcoma |
| Antibiotics |
Dactinomycin (actinomycin D) |
Choriocarcinoma, Wilms' tumor, rhabdomyosarcoma, testis, Kaposi's sarcoma |
| Daunorubicin (daunomycin; rubidomycin) |
Acute granulocytic and acute lymphocytic leukemias |
| Doxorubicin |
Soft-tissue, osteogenic and other sarcomas; Hodgkin's disease, non-Hodgkin's lymphomas,
acute leukemias, breast, genitourinary, thyroid, lung, stomach, neuroblastoma |
| Bleomycin |
Testis, head and neck, skin, esophagus, lung and genitourinary tract; Hodgkin's disease,
non-Hodgkin's lymphomas |
| Plicamycin (mithramycin) |
Testis, malignant hypercalcemia |
| Mitomycin (mitomycin C) |
Stomach, cervix, colon, breast, pancreas, bladder, head and neck |
| Enzymes |
L-Asparaginase |
Acute lymphocytic leukemia |
| Biological Response Modifiers |
Interferon alfa Interferon alfa |
Hairy cell leukemia., Kaposi's sarcoma, melanoma, carcinoid, renal cell, ovary, bladder,
non-Hodgkin's lymphomas, mycosis fungoides, multiple myeloma, chronic granulocytic
leukemia |
| Miscellaneous Agents |
Platinum Coordination Complexes |
Cisplatin (cis-DDP) Carboplatin |
Testis, ovary, bladder, head and neck, lung, thyroid, cervix, endometrium, neuroblastoma,
osteogenic sarcoma |
| Anthracenedione |
Mitoxantrone |
Acute granulocytic leukemia, breast |
| Substituted Urea |
Hydroxyurea |
Chronic granulocytic leukemia, polycythemia vera, essental thrombocytosis, malignant
melanoma |
| Methyl Hydrazine Derivative |
Procarbazine (N-methylhydrazine, MIH) |
Hodgkin's disease |
| Adrenocortical Suppressant |
Mitotane (o,p'DDD) |
Adrenal cortex |
| Aminoglutethimide |
Breast |
| Hormones and Antagonists |
Adrenocorticosteroids |
Prednisone (several other equivalent preparations available) |
Acute and chronic lymphocytic leukemias, non-Hodgkin's lymphomas, Hodgkin's disease,
breast |
| |
Hydroxyprogesterone caproate |
Endometrium, breast |
| Progestins |
Medroxyprogesterone acetate |
| |
Megestrol acetate |
| Estrogens |
Diethylstilbestrol |
Breast, prostate |
| Ethinyl estradiol (other preparations available) |
| Antiestrogen |
Tamoxifen |
Breast |
| Androgens |
Testosterone propionate |
Breast |
| Fluoxymesterone (other preparations available) |
| Antiandrogen |
Flutamide |
Prostate |
| Gonadotropin-releasing hormone analog |
Leuprolide |
Prostate |
J2. Anti-Angiogenics
[0537] The term "angiogenesis" refers to the generation of new blood vessels, generally
into a tissue or organ. Under normal physiological conditions, humans or animals undergo
angiogenesis only in very specific restricted situations. For example, angiogenesis
is normally observed in wound healing, fetal and embryonic development and formation
of the corpus luteum, endometrium and placenta. Uncontrolled (persistent and/or unregulated)
angiogenesis is related to various disease states, and occurs during tumor growth
and metastasis.
[0538] Both controlled and uncontrolled angiogenesis are thought to proceed in a similar
manner. Endothelial cells and pericytes, surrounded by a basement membrane, form capillary
blood vessels. Angiogenesis begins with the erosion of the basement membrane by enzymes
released by endothelial cells and leukocytes. The endothelial cells, which line the
lumen of blood vessels, then protrude through the basement membrane. Angiogenic stimulants
induce the endothelial cells to migrate through the eroded basement membrane. The
migrating cells form a "sprout" off the parent blood vessel, where the endothelial
cells undergo mitosis and proliferate. The endothelial sprouts merge with each other
to form capillary loops, creating the new blood vessel.
[0539] As persistent, unregulated angiogenesis occurs during tumor development and metastasis,
the treatment methods of this invention may be used in combination with any one or
more "anti-angiogenic" therapies. Exemplary anti-angiogenic agents that are useful
in connection with combined therapy are listed in
Table D. Each of the agents listed therein is exemplary and by no means limiting.
TABLE D
| Inhibitors and Negative Regulators of Angiogenesis |
| SUBSTANCES |
REFERENCES |
| Angiostatin |
O'Reilly et al., 1994 |
| Endostatin |
O'Reilly et al., 1997 |
| 16kDa prolactin fragment |
Ferrara et al., 1991; Clapp et al., 1993; D'Angelo et al., 1995; Lee et al., 1998 |
| Laminin peptides |
Kleinman et al., 1993; Yamamura et al., 1993; Iwamoto et al., 1996; Tryggvason, 1993 |
| Fibronectin peptides |
Grant et al., 1998; Sheu et al., 1997 |
| Tissue metalloproteinase inhibitors (TIMP 1, 2, 3, 4) |
Sang, 1998 |
| Plasminogen activator inhibitors (PAI-1, -2) |
Soff et al., 1995 |
| Tumor necrosis factor α (high dose, in vitro) |
Frater-Schroder et al., 1987 |
| TGF-β1 |
RayChadhury and D'Amore, 1991; Tada et al., 1994 |
| Interferons (IFN-α, -β, γ) |
Moore et al., 1998; Lingen et al., 1998 |
| ELR- CXC Chemokines: IL-12; SDF-1; MIG; Platelet factor 4 (PF-4); IP-10 |
Moore et al., 1998; Hiscox and Jiang, 1997; Coughlin et al., 1998; Tanaka et al., 1997 |
| Thrombospondin (TSP) |
Good et al., 1990; Frazier, 1991; Bornstein. 1992; Tolsma et al., 1993; Sheibani and Frazier, 1995; Volpert et al., 1998 |
| SPARC |
Hasselaar and Sage, 1992; Lane et al., 1992; Jendraschak and Sage, 1996 |
| 2-Methoxyoestradiol |
Fotsis et al., 1994 |
| Proliferin-related protein |
Jackson et al., 1994 |
| Suramin |
Gagliardi et al., 1992; Takano et al., 1994; Waltenberger et al., 1996; Gagliardi et al., 1998; Manetti et al., 1998 |
| Thalidomide |
D'Amato et al., 1994; Kenyon et al., 1997 Wells. 1998 |
| Cortisone |
Thorpe et al., 1993 Folkman et al., 1983 Sakamoto et al., 1986 |
| Linomide |
Vukanovic et al., 1993; Ziche et al., 1998; Nagler et al., 1998 |
| Fumagillin (AGM-1470; TNP-470) |
Sipos et al., 1994; Yoshida et al., 1998 |
| Tamoxifen |
Gagliardi and Collins, 1993; Linder and Borden, 1997; Haran et al., 1994 |
| Korean mistletoe extract (Viscum album coloratum) |
Yoon et al., 1995 |
| Retinoids |
Oikawa et al., 1989; Lingen et al., 1996; Majewski et al. 1996 |
| CM101 |
Hellerqvist et al., 1993; Quinn et al., 1995; Wamil et al., 1997; DeVore et al., 1997 |
| Dexamethasone |
Hori et al., 1996; Wolff et al., 1997 |
| Leukemia inhibitory factor (LIF) |
Pepper et al., 1995 |
[0540] A certain preferred component for use in inhibiting angiogenesis is a protein named
"angiostatin". This component is disclosed in U.S. Patents 5,776,704; 5,639,725 and
5,733,876. Angiostatin is a protein having a molecular weight of between about 38
kD and about 45 kD, as determined by reducing polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis,
which contains approximately Kringle regions 1 through 4 of a plasminogen molecule.
Angiostatin generally has an amino acid sequence substantially similar to that of
a fragment of murine plasminogen beginning at amino acid number 98 of an intact murine
plasminogen molecule.
[0541] The amino acid sequence of angiostatin varies slightly between species. For example,
in human angiostatin, the amino acid sequence is substantially similar to the sequence
of the above described murine plasminogen fragment, although an active human angiostatin
sequence may start at either amino acid number 97 or 99 of an intact human plasminogen
amino acid sequence. Further, human plasminogen may be used, as it has similar anti-angiogenic
activity, as shown in a mouse tumor model.
[0542] Certain anti-angiogenic therapies have already been shown to cause tumor regressions,
and angiostatin is one such agent. Endostatin, a 20 kDa COOH-terminal fragment of
collagen XVIII, the bacterial polysaccharide CM101, and the antibody LM609 also have
angiostatic activity. However, in light of their other properties, they are referred
to as anti-vascular therapies or tumor vessel toxins, as they not only inhibit angiogenesis
but also initiate the destruction of tumor vessels through mostly undefined mechanisms.
Their combination with the present invention is clearly envisioned.
[0543] Angiostatin and endostatin have become the focus of intense study, as they are the
first angiogenesis inhibitors that have demonstrated the ability to not only inhibit
tumor growth but also cause tumor regressions in mice. There are multiple proteases
that have been shown to produce angiostatin from plasminogen including elastase. macrophage
metalloelastase (MME), matrilysin (MMP-7), and 92 kDa gelatinase B/type IV collagenase
(MMP-9).
[0544] MME can produce angiostatin from plasminogen in tumors and granulocyte-macrophage
colony-stimulating factor (GMCSF) upregulates the expression of MME by macrophages
inducing the production of angiostatin. The role of MME in angiostatin generation
is supported by the finding that MME is in fact expressed in clinical samples of hepatocellular
carcinomas from patients. Another protease thought to be capable of producing angiostatin
is stromelysin-1 (MMP-3). MMP-3 has been shown to produce angiostatin-like fragments
from plasminogen
in vitro.
[0545] The mechanism of action for angiostatin is currently unclear, it is hypothesized
that it binds to an unidentified cell surface receptor on endothelial cells inducing
endothelial cell to undergo programmed cell death or mitotic arrest. Endostatin appears
to be an even more powerful anti-angiogenesis and anti-tumor agent although its biology
is much less clear. Endostatin is effective at causing regressions in a number of
tumor models in mice. Tumors do not develop resistance to endostatin and, after multiple
cycles of treatment, tumors enter a dormant state during which they do not increase
in volume. In this dormant state, the percentage of tumor cells undergoing apoptosis
was increased, yielding a population that essentially stays the same size. Endostatin
is also thought to bind an unidentified endothelial cell surface receptor that mediates
its effect.
[0546] CM101 is a bacterial polysaccharide that has been well characterized in its ability
to induce neovascular inflammation in tumors. CM101 binds to and crosslinks receptors
expressed on dedifferentiated endothelium that stimulates the activation of the complement
system. It also initiates a cytokine-driven inflammatory response that selectively
targets the tumor. It is a uniquely antipathoangiogenic agent that downregulates the
expression VEGF and its receptors. CM101 is currently in clinical trials as an anti-cancer
drug, and can be used in combination herewith.
[0547] Thrombospondin (TSP-1) and platelet factor 4 (PF4) may also be used in combination
with the present invention. These are both angiogenesis inhibitors that associate
with heparin and are found in platelet α-granules. TSP-1 is a large 450kDa multi-domain
glycoprotein that is constituent of the extracellular matrix. TSP-1 binds to many
of the proteoglycan molecules found in the extracellular matrix including, HSPGs,
fibronectin, laminin, and different types of collagen. TSP-1 inhibits endothelial
cell migration and proliferation
in vitro and angiogenesis
in vivo. TSP-1 can also suppress the malignant phenotype and tumorigenesis of transformed
endothelial cells. The tumor suppressor gene p53 has been shown to directly regulate
the expression of TSP-1 such that, loss of p53 activity causes a dramatic reduction
in TSP-1 production and a concomitant increase in tumor initiated angiogenesis.
[0548] PF4 is a 70aa protein that is member of the CXC ELR- family of chemokines that is
able to potently inhibit endothelial cell proliferation
in vitro and angiogenesis
in vivo. PF4 administered intratumorally or delivered by an adenoviral vector is able to
cause an inhibition of tumor growth.
[0549] Interferons and metalloproteinase inhibitors are two other classes of naturally occurring
angiogenic inhibitors that can be combined with the present invention. The anti-endothelial
activity of the interferons has been known since the early 1980s, however, the mechanism
of inhibition is still unclear. It is known that they can inhibit endothelial cell
migration and that they do have some anti-angiogenic activity
in vivo that is possibly mediated by an ability to inhibit the production of angiogenic promoters
by tumor cells. Vascular tumors in particular are sensitive to interferon, for example,
proliferating hemangiomas can be successfully treated with IFNα.
[0550] Tissue inhibitors of metalloproteinases (TIMPs) are a family of naturally occurring
inhibitors of matrix metalloproteases (MMPs) that can also inhibit angiogenesis and
can be used in combined treatment protocols with the present invention. MMPs play
a key role in the angiogenic process as they degrade the matrix through which endothelial
cells and fibroblasts migrate when extending or remodeling the vascular network. In
fact, one member of the MMPs, MMP-2, has been shown to associate with activated endothelium
through the integrin αvβ3 presumably for this purpose. If this interaction is disrupted
by a fragment of MMP-2, then angiogenesis is downregulated and in tumors growth is
inhibited.
[0551] There are a number of pharmacological agents that inhibit angiogenesis, any one or
more of which may be used in combination with the present invention. These include
AGM-1470/TNP-470, thalidomide, and carboxyamidotriazole (CAI). Fumagillin was found
to be a potent inhibitor of angiogenesis in 1990, and since then the synthetic analogues
of fumagillin, AGM-1470 and TNP-470 have been developed. Both of these drugs inhibit
endothelial cell proliferation
in vitro and angiogenesis
in vivo. TNP-470 has been studied extensively in human clinical trials with data suggesting
that long-term administration is optimal.
[0552] Thalidomide was originally used as a sedative but was found to be a potent teratogen
and was discontinued. In 1994 it was found that thalidomide is an angiogenesis inhibitor.
Thalidomide is currently in clinical trials as an anti-cancer agent as well as a treatment
of vascular eye diseases.
[0553] CAI is a small molecular weight synthetic inhibitor of angiogenesis that acts as
a calcium channel blocker that prevents actin reorganization, endothelial cell migration
and spreading on collagen IV. CAI inhibits neovascularization at physiological attainable
concentrations and is well tolerated orally by cancer patients. Clinical trials with
CAI have yielded disease stabilization in 49 % of cancer patients having progressive
disease before treatment.
[0554] Cortisone in the presence of heparin or heparin fragments was shown to inhibit tumor
growth in mice by blocking endothelial cell proliferation. The mechanism involved
in the additive inhibitory effect of the steroid and heparin is unclear although it
is thought that the heparin may increase the uptake of the steroid by endothelial
cells. The mixture has been shown to increase the dissolution of the basement membrane
underneath newly formed capillaries and this is also a possible explanation for the
additive angiostatic effect. Heparin-cortisol conjugates also have potent angiostatic
and anti-tumor effects activity
in vivo.
[0555] Further specific angiogenesis inhibitors, including, but not limited to, Anti-Invasive
Factor, retinoic acids and paclitaxel (U.S. Patent No. 5,716,981); AGM-1470 (Ingber
et al., 1990); shark cartilage extract (U.S. Patent No. 5,618,925); anionic polyamide or
polyurea oligomers (U.S. Patent No. 5,593,664); oxindole derivatives (U.S. Patent
No. 5,576,330); estradiol derivatives (U.S. Patent No. 5,504,074); and thiazolopyrimidine
derivatives (U.S. Patent No. 5,599,813) are also contemplated for use as anti-angiogenic
compositions for the combined therapeutics of the present invention.
[0556] Compositions comprising an antagonist of an α
vβ
3 integrin may also be used to inhibit angiogenesis in combination with the present
invention. As disclosed in U.S. Patent No. 5,766,591, RGD-containing polypeptides
and salts thereof, including cyclic polypeptides, are suitable examples of α
vβ
3 integrin antagonists.
[0557] The antibody LM609 against the α
vβ
3 integrin also induces tumor regressions. Integrin α
vβ
3 antagonists, such as LM609, induce apoptosis of angiogenic endothelial cells leaving
the quiescent blood vessels unaffected. LM609 or other α
vβ
3 antagonists may also.work by inhibiting the interaction of α
vβ
3 and MMP-2, a proteolytic enzyme thought to play an important role in migration of
endothelial cells and fibroblasts.
[0558] Apoptosis of the angiogenic endothelium in this case may have a cascade effect on
the rest of the vascular network. Inhibiting the tumor vascular network from completely
responding to the tumor's signal to expand may, in fact, initiate the partial or full
collapse of the network resulting in tumor cell death and loss of tumor volume. It
is possible that endostatin and angiostatin function in a similar fashion. The fact
that LM609 does not affect quiescent vessels but is able to cause tumor regressions
suggests strongly that not all blood vessels in a tumor need to be targeted for treatment
in order to obtain an anti-tumor effect.
[0559] Non-targeted angiopoietins, such as angiopoietin-2, may also be used in combination
with the present invention. As described above in the context of targeted delivery,
the angiogenic effects of various regulators involve an autocrine loop connected with
angiopoietin-2. The use of angiopoietin-2, angiopoietin-1, angiopoietin-3 and angiopoietin-4,
is thus contemplated in conjunction with the present invention. Other methods of therapeutic
intervention based upon altering signaling through the Tie2 receptor can also be used
in combination herewith, such as using a soluble Tie2 receptor capable of blocking
Tie2 activation (Lin
et al., 1998). Delivery of such a construct using recombinant adenoviral gene therapy has
been shown to be effective in treating cancer and reducing metastases (Lin
et al., 1998).
J3. Apoptosis-Inducing Agents
[0560] Therapeutic agent-targeting agent treatment may also be combined with treatment methods
that induce apoptosis in any cells within the tumor, including tumor cells and tumor
vascular endothelial cells. Although many anti-cancer agents may have, as part of
their mechanism of action, an apoptosis-inducing effect, certain agents have been
discovered, designed or selected with this as a primary mechanism, as described below.
[0561] A number of oncogenes have been described that inhibit apoptosis, or programmed cell
death. Exemplary oncogenes in this category include, but are not limited to, bcr-abl,
bcl-2 (distinct from bcl-1, cyclin D1; GenBank accession numbers M14745, X06487; U.S.
Patent No. 5,650,491; and 5,539,094) and family members including Bcl-xl, Mcl-1, Bak,
A1, A20. Overexpression of bcl-2 was first discovered in T cell lymphomas. bcl-2 functions
as an oncogene by binding and inactivating Bax, a protein in the apoptotic pathway.
Inhibition of bcl-2 function prevents inactivation of Bax, and allows the apoptotic
pathway to proceed. Thus, inhibition of this class of oncogenes,
e.g., using antisense nucleotide sequences, is contemplated for use in the present invention
in aspects wherein enhancement of apoptosis is desired (U.S. Patent No. 5,650,491;
5,539,094; and 5,583,034).
[0562] Many forms of cancer have reports of mutations in tumor suppressor genes, such as
p53. Inactivation of p53 results in a failure to promote apoptosis. With this failure,
cancer cells progress in tumorigenesis, rather than become destined for cell death.
Thus, provision of tumor suppressors is also contemplated for use in the present invention
to stimulate cell death. Exemplary tumor suppressors include, but are not limited
to, p53, Retinoblastoma gene (Rb). Wilm's tumor (WT1), bax alpha, interleukin-1b-converting
enzyme and family, MEN-1 gene, neurofibromatosis, type 1 (NF1), cdk inhibitor p16,
colorectal cancer gene (DCC), familial adenomatosis polyposis gene (FAP), multiple
tumor suppressor gene (MTS-1), BRCA1 and BRCA2.
[0563] Preferred for use are the p53 (U.S. Patent No. 5,747,469; 5,677,178; and 5,756,455),
Retinoblastoma, BRCA1 (U.S. Patent No. 5,750,400; 5,654,155; 5,710,001; 5,756,294;
5,709,999; 5,693,473; 5,753,441; 5,622,829; and 5,747,282), MEN-1 (GenBank accession
number U93236) and adenovirus EIA (U.S. Patent No. 5,776,743) genes.
[0564] Other compositions that may be used include genes encoding the tumor necrosis factor
related apoptosis inducing ligand termed TRAIL, and the TRAIL polypeptide (U.S. Patent
No. 5,763,223); the 24 kD apoptosis-associated protease of U.S. Patent No. 5,605,826,
Fas-associated factor 1, FAF1 (U.S. Patent No. 5,750,653). Also contemplated for use
in these aspects of the present invention is the provision of interleukin-1β-converting
enzyme and family members, which are also reported to stimulate apoptosis.
[0565] Compounds such as carbostyril derivatives (U.S. Patent No. 5,672,603; and 5,464,833);
branched apogenic peptides (U.S. Patent No. 5,591,717); phosphotyrosine inhibitors
and non-hydrolyzable phosphotyrosine analogs (U.S. Patent No. 5,565,491; and 5,693,627);
agonists of RXR retinoid receptors (U.S. Patent No. 5,399,586); and even antioxidants
(U.S. Patent No. 5,571,523) may also be used. Tyrosine kinase inhibitors, such as
genistein, may also be linked to ligands that target a cell surface receptor (U.S.
Patent No. 5,587,459).
J4. Immunotoxins and Coaguligands
[0566] The anti-aminophospholipid-conjugate based treatment methods may be used in combination
with other immunotoxins and/or coaguligands in which the targeting portion thereof,
e.g., antibody or ligand, is directed to a relatively specific marker of the tumor cells,
tumor vasculature or tumor stroma. In common with the chemotherapeutic and anti-angiogenic
agents discussed above, the combined use of other targeted toxins or coagulants will
generally result in additive, markedly greater than additive or even synergistic anti-tumor
results.
[0567] Generally speaking, antibodies or ligands for use in these additional aspects will
preferably recognize accessible tumor antigens that are preferentially, or specifically,
expressed in the tumor site. The antibodies or ligands will also preferably exhibit
properties of high affinity; and the antibodies, ligands or conjugates thereof, will
not exert significant
in vivo side effects against life-sustaining normal tissues, such as one or more tissues
selected, from heart, kidney, brain, liver, bone marrow, colon, breast, prostate,
thyroid, gall bladder, lung, adrenals, muscle, nerve fibers, pancreas, skin, or other
life-sustaining organ or tissue in the human body. The term "significant side effects",
as used herein, refers to an antibody, ligand or antibody conjugate, that, when administered
in vivo, will produce only negligible or clinically manageable side effects, such as those
normally encountered during chemotherapy.
[0568] At least one binding region of these second anti-cancer agents employed in combination
with the invention will be a component that is capable of delivering a toxin or coagulation
factor to the tumor region,
i.e., capable of localizing within a tumor site. Such targeting agents may be directed
against a component of a tumor cell. tumor vasculature or tumor stroma. The targeting
agents will generally bind to a surface-expressed, surface-accessible or surface-localized
component of a tumor cell, tumor vasculature or tumor stroma. However, once tumor
vasculature and tumor cell destruction begins, internal components will be released,
allowing additional targeting of virtually any tumor component.
[0569] Many tumor cell antigens have been described, any one which could be employed as
a target in connection with the combined aspects of the present invention. Appropriate
tumor cell antigens for additional immunotoxin and coaguligand targeting include those
recognized by the antibodies B3 (U.S. Patent 5,242,813; ATCC HB 10573); KSI/4 (U.S.
Patent 4,975,369; obtained from a cell comprising the vectors NRRL B-18356 and/or
NRRL B-18357); 260F9 (ATCC HB 8488); and D612 (U.S. Patent 5,183,756; ATCC HB 9796).
One may also consult the ATCC Catalogue of any subsequent year to identify other appropriate
cell lines producing anti-tumor cell antibodies.
[0570] For tumor vasculature targeting, the targeting antibody or ligand will often bind
to a marker expressed by, adsorbed to, induced on or otherwise localized to the intratumoral
blood vessels of a vascularized tumor. Appropriate expressed target molecules include,
for example, endoglin, E-selectin, P-selectin, VCAM-1, ICAM-1, PSMA (Liu
et al., 1997), a TIE, a ligand reactive with LAM-1, a VEGF/VPF receptor, an FGF receptor,
α
vβ
3 integrin, pleiotropin and endosialin. Suitable adsorbed targets are those such as
VEGF, FGF, TGFβ, HGF, PF4, PDGF, TIMP, a ligand that binds to a TIE and tumor-associated
fibronectin isoforms. Antigens naturally and artificially inducible by cytokines and
coagulants may also be targeted, such as ELAM-1, VCAM-1, ICAM-1, a ligand reactive
with LAM-1, endoglin, and even MHC Class II (cytokine-inducible,
e.g., by IL-1, TNF-α, IFN-γ, IL-4 and/or TNF-β); and E-selectin, P-selectin, PDGF and
ICAM-1 (coagulant-inducible
e.g., by thrombin, Factor IX/IXa, Factor X/Xa and/or plasmin).
[0571] The following patents and patent applications further supplement the present teachings
regarding the preparation and use of immunotoxins directed against expressed, adsorbed,
induced or localized markers of tumor vasculature: U.S. Patents Nos. 5,855,866; 5,776,427;
5.863,538; 5,660,827; 6,004,554, 5,965,132, 6,051,230, 6,093,399 and 5,877,289; and
U.S.
[0572] Suitable tumor stromal targets include components of the tumor extracellular matrix
or stroma, or components those bound therein; including basement membrane markers,
type IV collagen, laminin, heparan sulfate, proteoglycan, fibronectins, activated
platelets, LIBS and tenascin. A preferred target for such uses is RIBS.
[0573] The following patents and patent applications further supplement the present teachings
regarding the preparation and use of tumor stromal targeting agents: U.S. Patents
No. 5,877,289, 6004555, 6036955 and 6093399.
[0574] The second anti-cancer therapeutics may be operatively attached to any of the cytotoxic
or otherwise anti-cellular agents described herein for use in the anti-aminophospholipidimmunotoxins.
However, suitable anti-cellular agents also include radioisotopes. Toxin moieties
will be preferred, such as ricin A chain and deglycosylated A chain (dgA) or even
gelonin. Any one or more of the angiopoietins, or fusions thereof, may also be used
as part of a second immunoconjugate for combined therapy.
[0575] The second, targeted agent for optional use with the invention may comprise a targeted
component that is capable of promoting coagulation,
i.e., a coaguligand. Here, the targeting antibody or ligand may be directly or indirectly,
e.g., via another antibody, linked to any factor that directly or indirectly stimulates
coagulation, including any of those described herein for use in the anti-aminophospholipid
coaguligands. Preferred coagulation factors for such uses are Tissue Factor (TF) and
TF derivatives, such as truncated TF (tTF), dimeric and multimeric TF, and mutant
TF deficient in the ability to activate Factor VII.
[0576] Effective doses of immunotoxins and coaguligands for combined use in the treatment
of cancer will be between about 0.1 mg/kg and about 2 mg/kg, and preferably, of between
about 0.8 mg/kg and about 1.2 mg/kg, when administered via the IV route at a frequency
of about 1 time per week. Some variation in dosage will necessarily occur depending
on the condition of the subject being treated. The physician responsible for administration
will determine the appropriate dose for the individual subject.
[0577] The following examples are included to demonstrate preferred embodiments of the invention.
It should be appreciated by those of skill in the art that the techniques disclosed
in the examples which follow represent techniques discovered by the inventor to function
well in the practice of the invention, and thus can be considered to constitute preferred
modes for its practice. However, those of skill in the art should, in light of the
present disclosure, appreciate that many changes can be made in the specific embodiments
which are disclosed.
EXAMPLE I
VCAM-1 Expression on Tumor and Normal Blood Vessels
A. Materials and Methods
1. Materials
[0578] Na
125I was obtained from Amersham (Arlington Heights, IL). Dulbecco's modified Eagle's
tissue culture medium (DMEM) and Dulbecco PBS containing Ca
2+ and Mg
2+ were obtained from Gibco (Grand Island, NY). Fetal calf serum was obtained from Hyclone
(Logan, Utah). O-phenylenediamine, hydrogen peroxide, 3-aminopropyltriethoxy-silane
and sterile, endotoxin-free saline (0.9% NaCI in 100 ml of water) were from Sigma
(St. Louis, MO). SMPT was from Pierce (Rockford, IL). Proplex T containing factor
VII (74 IU/ml), factor X and factor IX (17 IU/ml) was purchased from Baxter Diagnostics
Inc. (McGraw Park, IL). Chromogenic substrate, S-2765, for measuring factor Xa proteolytic
activity was obtained from Chromogenix (Franklin, OH). Purified factor Xa was purchased
from American Diagnostica (Greenwich, CT). 96 and 48 flat bottom microtiter plates
were obtained from Falcon (Becton Dickinson and Co., Lincoln Park, NJ). Sepharose-Protein
G beads and S200 Superdex were purchased from Pharmacia (Piscataway, NJ). Recombinant
murine IL-1α was purchased from R&D Systems (Minneapolis, MN).
2. Antibodies
[0579] The MK2.7 hybridoma, secreting a rat IgG1 antibody against murine VCAM-1, was obtained
from the American Type Culture Collection (ATCC, Rockville, MD; ATCC CRL 1909). The
characterization of this anti-VCAM-1 antibody has been reported by Mlyake
et al. (1991). The R187 hybridoma, secreting a rat IgG1 antibody against murine viral protein
p30 gag, was also obtained from the ATCC, and was used as an isotype matched control
for the anti-VCAM-1 antibody.
[0580] Mouse monoclonal antibody, 10H10, against human tissue factor was prepared as described
in Morrissey
et al. (1988), and in US-A-6093399.
[0581] MECA 32, a pan anti-mouse vascular endothelial cell antibody, was prepared as described
by Leppink
et al. (1989). MJ 7/18 rat IgG, reactive with murine endoglin, was prepared as described
by Ge and Butcher (1994). The MECA 32 and MJ 7/18 antibodies served as positive controls
for immunohistochemical studies.
[0582] Rabbit auti-rat and rat anti-mouse secondary antibodies conjugated with horseradish
peroxidase (HRP) were purchased from Dako (Carpimeria, CA).
3. Antibody Purification
[0583] Anti-VCAM-1 hybridoma, MK 2.7, and the irrelevant control hybridoma, R187, were grown
in bioreactors (Heraeus, Inc., Germany) for 12 days. Supernatants were centrifuged,
filtered through 0.22 µm filters and loaded onto Sepharose-Protein G columns. IgG
was eluted with citric acid buffer, pH 3.5, dialyzed into PBS and stored thereafter
at 4°C in the same buffer. Purity was estimated by SDS-PAGE and was routinely > 90%.
Binding capacity of the purified anti-VCAM-1 antibody was assessed immunohistochemically
on frozen sections of L540 tumor and by cell-based ELISA using IL-1α stimulated bEnd.3
cells, as described herein below.
4. Tumor-Bearing Micc and Immunohistochemistry
[0584] Male CB17 SCID mice (Charles River, Wilmington, MA) weighing approximately 25 g were
injected with 1 × 10
7-L540 Hodgkin's lymphoma cells subcutaneously into the right flank. Tumors were allowed,
to grow to a size of 0.4-0.7 cm
3. Animals were anesthetized with metafane and their blood circulation was perfused
with heparinized saline as described by Burrows
et al. (1992). The tumor and major organs were removed and snap-frozen in liquid nitrogen.
[0585] Cryostat sections of the tissues were cut, incubated with the anti-VCAM-1 antibody
and stained immunohistochemically to detect VCAM-1. Rat IgG was detected using rabbit
anti-rat IgG conjugated to HRP followed by development with carbazole (Fries
et al., 1993).
B. Results
[0586] The blood vessels of the major organs and a tumor from mice bearing subcutaneous
L540 human Hodgkin's tumors were examined immunohistochemically for VCAM-1 expression
using an anti-VCAM-1 antibody. VCAM-1 expression on tumor blood vessels was more peripheral
than central. However, as demonstrated in Example VI and Example VII, the anti-VCAM-1
antibody and coaguligand were evidently binding to blood transporting vessels, as
clearly shown by the ability of the coaguligand to arrest blood flow in all tumor
regions and to cause destruction of the intratumoral region.
[0587] Overall, VCAM-1 expression was observed on 20-30% of total tumor blood vessels stained
by the anti-endoglin antibody, MJ 7/18. VCAM-1 staining of the tumor vessels was largely
observed on venules. VCAM-1 expression was similar in tumors up to 1500 mm
3, but larger tumors appeared to have reduced staining, with 5-10% of MJ 7/18 positive
vessels being positive for VCAM-1.
[0588] Constitutive vascular expression of VCAM-1 was found in heart and lungs in both tumor-bearing
and normal animals (Table 1). In the heart, strong staining was observed on venules
and veins. Approximately 10% of MECA 32 positive vessels were positive for VCAM-1.
Staining in lung endothelium was weak in comparison to heart and tumor, and was confined
to a few large blood vessels. Strong stromal staining was observed in testis where
VCAM-1 expression was strictly extravascular. Similar findings regarding constitutive
VCAM-1 expression in rodent lung and testis were previously reported (Fries
et al., 1993).
TABLE 1
| Expression of VCAM-1 on Endothelium in Tissues of L540 Tumor Bearing Mice and Localization
of Anti-VCAM-1 Antibody |
| Tissue |
VCAM-1
expressiona |
anti-VCAM-1 antibody
Localizationb |
| Adrenal |
- c |
- |
| Brain Cerebellum |
- |
- |
| Brain Cortex |
- |
- |
| Heart |
++ |
++ |
| Kidney |
- |
- |
| Large Intestine |
- |
- |
| Liver |
- |
- |
| Lung |
+ |
+ |
| Pancreas |
- |
- |
| Small Intestine |
- |
- |
| Spleen |
- |
- |
| Testis |
-d |
- |
| L540 Hodgkin's tumor |
+++ |
+++ |
| a VCAM-1 was detected by anti-VCAM-1 antibody followed by anti-rat IgG-HRP. |
| b Localization of anti-VCAM-1 antibody in vivo was determined by injecting the antibody, exsanguinating the mice and staining tissues
staining with anti-rat IgG-HRP. |
| c Intensity of staining was compared to pan-endothelial markers MJ 7/18 and MECA 32;
- no staining; + weak; ++ moderate; +++ strong. |
| d No vascular expression was observed; however, extravascular stroma of testis was
stained by anti-VCAM-1 antibody. |
EXAMPLE II
Localization of Anti-VCAM-1 Antibody In Vivo
A. Methods
[0589] Male CB17 SCID mice (Charles River, Wilmington, MA) weighing approximately 25 g were
injected with 1 × 10
7 L540 Hodgkin's lymphoma cells subcutaneously into the right flank. Tumors were allowed
to grow to a size of 0.4-0.7 cm
3.
[0590] Mice were injected intravenously with 30 µg/25 g body weight of anti-VCAM-1 antibody,
R187 antibody or corresponding coaguligands in 200 µl of saline. Two hours later,
animals were anesthetized with metafane and their blood circulation was perfused with
heparinized saline as described (Burrows
et al., 1992). The tumor and major organs were removed and snap-frozen in liquid nitrogen.
[0591] Cryostat sections of the tissues -were cut and were stained immunohistochemically
for the presence of rat IgG or TF. Rat IgG was detected using rabbit anti-rat IgG
conjugated to HRP followed by development with carbazole (Fries
et al., 1993). Coaguligand was detected using the 10H10 antibody that recognizes human
tissue factor, followed by HRP-labeled anti-mouse IgG. 10H10 antibody does not cross-react
detectably with murine tissue factor (Morrissey
et al., 1988) or other murine proteins.
B. Results
[0592] Mice bearing subcutaneous L540 tumors were injected intravenously with anti-VCAM-1
antibody and, two hours later, the mice were exsanguinated. The tumor and normal organs
were removed and frozen sections were prepared and examined immunohistochemically
to determine the location of the antibody. Serial sections of the tissues were examined.
Localized rat IgG was detected by HRP-labeled anti-rat Ig; and murine blood vessels
were identified by pan-endothelial antibody, MECA 32.
[0593] Anti-VCAM-1 antibody was detected on endothelium of tumor, heart and lung (Table
1). The intensity and number of stained vessels was identical to that on serial sections
of the same tissues stained directly with anti-VCAM-1 antibody (Table 1). Staining
was specific as no staining of endothelium was observed in the tumor and organs of
mice injected with a species isotype matched antibody of irrelevant specificity, R187.
No localization of anti-VCAM-1 antibody was found in testis or any normal organ except
heart and lung.
EXAMPLE III
Preparation of Anti-VCAM-1•tTF Coaguligand
[0594] An anti-VCAM-1•tTF conjugate or "coaguligand" was prepared as follows. Truncated
tissue factor (tTF), with an additional added cysteine introduced at N-terminus (US-A-6093399),
was expressed in
E. coli and purified as described by Stone
et al. (1995). After purification, the sulfhydryl group of N' cysteine-tTF was protected
by reaction with Ellman's reagent. The tTF derivative was stored in small volumes
at -70°C.
[0595] To prepare the anti-VCAM-1 coaguligand, 5 ml of anti-VGAM-1 antibody IgG (2 mg/ml)
in PBS were mixed with 36 µl of SMPT (10 mM) dissolved in dry DMF and incubated at
room temperature for 1 h. The mixture was filtered through a column of Sephadex G25
equilibrated in PBS containing 1 mM EDTA. The fractions containing the SMPT-derivatized
antibody were concentrated to 4 ml by ultrafiltration in an Amicon cell equipped with
a 10,000 Da cut-off filter. Freshly thawed tTF derivative was incubated with 30 µl
of DTT (10 mM) in H
2O for 10 min. at room temperature and was filtered through a column of Sephadex G25
equilibrated in PBS containing 1 mM EDTA. The eluted fractions containing reduced
ITF were concentrated by ultrafiltration under nitrogen to a final volume of 3 ml.
[0596] The reduced tTF was mixed with the SMPT-derivatized antibody and the mixture was
allowed to react for 24 h at room temperature. At the end of the incubation, the reaction
mixture was resolved by gel filtration on a column of Superdex S200 equilibrated in
PBS. Fractions containing anti-VCAM-1•tTF having a M
r of 180,0.00 and corresponding to one molecule of antibody linked to one molecule
of tTF were collected.
EXAMPLE IV
Binding of Anti-VCAM-1 Coaguligand to Activated Endothelial Cells
A. Methods
1. Iodination of 10H10 antibody
[0597] Anti-human tissue factor antibody, 10H10, was radiolabeled with
125I using Chloramine T as described by Bocci (1964). The specific activity was approximately
10,000 cpm/µg, as calculated from protein determinations measured by a Bradford assay
(Bradford, 1976).
2. Cells
[0598] L540 Hodgkin cells (L540 Cy), derived from a patient with end-stage disease, were
prepared as described in Diehl
et al. (1985, incorporated herein by reference), and were obtained from Prof. Volker Diehl
(Klinik fur Innere Medizin der Universitaet, Köeln, Germany). bEnd.3 cells (murine
brain endothelioma) were prepared as described in Bussolino
et al. (1991) and Montesano
et al. (1990) and were obtained from Prof. Wemer Risau (Max Planck Institute, Bäd Nauheim,
Germany).
3. Tissue Culture
[0599] bEnd.3 cells and hybridomas were maintained in DMEM supplemented with 10% fetal calf
serum, 2 mM L-glutamine, 2 units/ml penicillin G and 2 µg/ml streptomycin. L540 cells
were maintained in RPMI 1640 containing the same additives. All cells were subcultured
once a week. bEnd.3 trypsinization was performed using 0.125% trypsin in PBS solution
containing 0.2% EDTA. For binding studies, cells were seeded at a density of 5 × 10
4 cells/ml in 0.5 ml of medium in 48 well plates and incubated for 48-96 h. Medium
was refreshed 24 h before each study.
4. Binding of Coaguligand to Activated Endothelial Cells
[0600] Binding of the anti-VCAM-1 antibody and coaguligand to VCAM-1 on activated bEnd.3
cells was determined using a cell based ELISA, as described by Hahne (1993). bEnd.3
cells were incubated with 10 units/ml of IL-1α for 4 h at 37°C in 96-well microtiter
plates. At the end of this incubation, medium was replaced by DPBS containing 2 mM
Ca
2- and Mg
2+ and 0.2% (w/v) gelatin as a carrier protein. The same buffer was used for dilution
of antibodies and for washing of cell monolayers between steps.
[0601] Cells were incubated with 4 µg/ml of anti-VCAM-1•tTF conjugate, anti-VCAM-1 antibody
or control reagents for 2 h, and were then washed and incubated for 1 h with rabbit
anti-rat IgG-HRP conjugate (1:500 dilution). All steps were performed at room temperature.
HRP activity was measured by adding O-phenylenediamine (0.5 mg/ml) and hydrogen peroxide
(0.03% w/v) in citrate-phosphate buffer, pH 5.5. After 30 min., 100 µl of supernatant
were transferred to 96 well plates, 100 µl of 0.18 M H
2SO
4 were added and the absorbance was measured at 492 nm. Each study was performed in
duplicate and repeated at least twice.
5. Detection of Coaguligand Bound to Endothelial cells
[0602] Anti-VCAM-1 coaguligand and appropriate controls were incubated with IL-1α stimulated
bEnd.3 cells in 96-well microtiter plates, as described above. Bound coaguligands
were detected by identifying both the tissue factor component and the rat IgG component
bound to bEnd.3 cells.
[0603] After removing the excess of unbound antibody, cells were incubated with 100 µl/well
of
125I-labeled 10H10 antibody (0.2 µg/ml) or
125I-labeled rabbit anti-rat Ig (0.2 µg/ml) in binding buffer. After 2 h incubation at
room temperature, cells were washed extensively and dissolved in 0.5 M of NaOH. The
entire volume of 0.5 ml. was transferred to plastic tubes and counted in a γ counter.
Each study was performed in duplicate and repeated at least twice.
B. Results
[0604] The ability of an anti-VCAM-1•tTF coaguligand to bind to IL-1α activated murine bEnd.3
cells was determined by measuring the binding of radioiodinated anti-TF antibody to
coaguligand-treated cells
in vitro. VCAM-1 expression by bEnd.3 cells is transiently inducible by IL-1α with a peak of
VCAM-1 expression being obtained 4-6 h after addition of the cytokine (Hahne
et al., 1993). Strong binding of the coaguligand to activated bEnd.3 cells was observed
(FIG. 1A).
[0605] At saturation, 8.7 fmoles of anti-TF antibody was bound to the cells, which is equivalent
to 540,000 molecules of anti-TF antibody per cell. Binding of the coaguligand was
specific; no detectable binding over background was observed with an isotype matched
control coaguligand of irrelevant specificity. Binding of coaguligand to unstimulated
cells was about half of that to activated cells and is probably attributable to constitutive
VCAM-1 expression by cultured endothelioma cells.
[0606] In further studies, the anti-VCAM-1•tTF coaguligand was found to bind as strongly
as unconjugated anti-VCAM-1 antibody to activated bEnd.3 cells, using detection by
peroxidase-labeled anti rat IgG in the assay. This was done at both saturating and
subsaturating concentrations. Thus, the conjugation procedure (Example III) did not
diminish antibody's capacity to bind to VCAM-1 on intact endothelial monolayers.
EXAMPLE V
Factor X Activation by Endothelial Cell-Bound Coaguligand
A. Methods
[0607] The activity of the anti-VCAM-1•tTF coaguligand bound to activated bEnd.3 cells was
determined indirectly by using a chromogenic assay to detect factor Xa (Schorer
et al., 1985; Nawroth
et al., 1985). IL-1α-stimulated and unstimulated bEnd.3 cells were incubated with specific
and control coaguligands in 96-well microtiter plates as described above. The cells
were washed with PBS containing 2 mg/ml of BSA and were incubated with 150 µl/well
of freshly prepared Proplex T solution diluted 1:20 in 50 mM Tris-HCl (pH 8.1), 150mM
NaCl, 2 mg/ml BSA (tissue culture gradc, endotoxin-free) and 2.5 mM CaCl
2. After incubation for 60 min. at 37°C, 100 µl were withdrawn from each well, transferred
to 96-well plates and mixed with 100 µl of the same buffer containing 12.5 mM EDTA
(pH 8.1).
[0608] Chromogenic substrate S2765 for measuring factor Xa proteolytic activity was added
in 50 µl, giving a final concentration of 300 µM. The breakdown of the substrate was
determined by reading the absorbance at 405 nm over a 2 h period in a microplate reader
(Molecular Devices, Palo Alto, CA).
[0609] Production of the chromogenic product was completely dependent on the presence of
Proplex T and bEnd.3 cells preincubated with the specific coaguligand. Background
hydrolysis of the substrate by Proplex T in the absence or cells was approximately
10% of the maximal value and was subtracted from each determination. Free coaguligands
diluted in Proplex T solution were unable to generate factor Xa. The amount of Xa
generated was calculated by reference to a standard curve constructed with known concentrations
of purified factor Xa.
[0610] At the end of the study, cells were detached with trypsin-EDTA and counted. The results
are expressed as the amount of factor Xa generated per 10
4 cells. Each study was performed in duplicate and was repeated at least 3 times.
B. Results
1. Factor X Activation
[0611] Anti-VCAM-1•tTF coaguligand bound to IL-1α-activated bEnd.3 cells was capable of
specifically activating factor X. The rate of generation of factor Xa by anti-VCAM-1•tTF
coated cells was 3.2 ng per 10
4 cells per hour, which is 7-10 fold higher than was observed with activated cells
treated with a control coaguligand of irrelevant specificity or with tTF alone (FIG.
1B). Anti-VCAM-1•tTF in the absence of cells had undetectable factor X activating
activity, confirming that cell binding is essential for coaguligand activity.
[0612] Anti-VCAM-1•tTF bound to unstimulated bEnd.3 cells activated factor X at a rate of
1.6 ng per 10
4 cells per hour. This rate is about half that observed with the IL-1α-stimulated cells,
in accordance with the 50% lower amount of coaguligand that binds to unstimulated
as compared with stimulated cells. Similar results to those shown in FIG. 1B were
obtained in three separate studies.
2. Effect of Endothelial Cell Permeabilization
[0613] Permeabilization of bEnd.3 monolayers with saponin after treating them with anti-VCAM-1•tTF
coaguligand increased the ability of the bound coaguligand to activate factor X by
about 30-fold (Table 2). The rate of factor Xa generation by unstimulated cells treated
with anti-VCAM-1•tTF increased from 1.6 to 49.2 ng per 10
4 cells per hour after permeabilization, while that of IL-1α stimulated cells increased
from 3.2 to 98.8 ng per 10
4 cells per hour. The factor Xa generating activity of the permeabilized cells was
due to the bound coaguligand rather than to endogenous TF since permeabilized untreated
cells or cells treated with control coaguligand of irrelevant specificity had low
factor Xa generating activity (2 ng per 10
4 cells per hour).
[0614] These results indicate that the coaguligand is able to function more efficiently
in the environment of a permeabilized cell. Possibly, permeabilization exposes negatively-charged
phospholipids from within the cell that accelerate the formation of the coagulation-initiation
complexes, or else prevents the inactivation of such complexes by TFPI.
TABLE 2
| Generation of Factor Xa by Anti-VCAM-1•tTF Bound to Intact or Permeabilized bEnd.3
cells (ng per 104 cells per 60 min.) |
| Treatmenta |
Treatmenta |
Permeabilized cellsb |
| |
Control |
IL-1α |
Control |
IL-1α |
| Buffer |
0.25c |
0.43 |
0.45 |
2.0 |
| tTF |
0.26 |
0.42 |
0.39 |
2.1 |
| Control IgG•tTF |
0.26 |
0.43 |
0.41 |
2.1 |
| Anti-VCAM-1•tTF |
1.64 |
3.17 |
49.2 |
98.8 |
| a IL-1α stimulated and unstimulated bEnd.3 cells were incubated with buffer alone or
with 4 µg/ml of tTF, control IgG•tTF or anti-VCAM-1•tTF followed by 60 min. incubation
with Proplex T solution at 37°C. |
| b Cells were treated with 0.2% saponin 5 min. before addition of Proplex T. |
| c Amount of factor Xa was determined as described above. Results are expressed as ng
of factor Xa generated per 104 cells per 60 mm. The arithmetic mean values from triplicate wells are shown. SE were
less than 5 percent of the mean values. |
EXAMPLE VI
Tumor Blood Vessel Thrombosis by Anti-VCAM-1 Coaguligand
A. Methods
[0615] SCID mice bearing L540 tumors (0.4-0.7 cm
3) were injected intravenously with 40 µg (total protein) of anti-VCAM-1•tTF or R187•tTF.
This dose corresponds to 32 µg of antibody and 8 µg of tTF. Other animals received
equivalent quantities of free antibody, free tTF or a mixture of both. Animals were
anesthetized 4 or 24 h later and their blood circulations were perfused with heparinized
saline. The tumor and major organs were removed and were fixed in formalin and paraffin-embedded
or snap-frozen for cryosectioning. Sections were cut through the center of the tissue
or tumor. The number of thrombosed and non-thrombosed blood vessels in 5 cross-sections
were counted. The percentage of thrombosed vessels was calculated.
B. Results
1. Thrombosis of Tumor Blood Vessels
[0616] This study shows that intravenous administration of the anti-VCAM-1•tTF coaguligand
induces selective thrombosis of tumor blood vessels, as opposed to vessels in normal
tissues, in tumor-bearing mice.
[0617] The anti-VCAM-1•tTF coaguligand was administered to mice bearing subcutaneous L540
tumors of 0.4 to 0.6 cm in diameter. Before coaguligand injection, tumors were healthy,
having a uniform morphology lacking regions of necrosis. The tumors were well vascularized
and had a complete absence of spontaneously thrombosed vessels or hemorrhages. Within
four hours of coaguligand injection, 40-70% of blood vessels were thrombosed, despite
the initial staining of only 20-30% of tumor blood vessels shown in Example I. The
thrombosed vessels contained occlusive platelet aggregates, packed erythrocytes and
fibrin. In several regions, the blood vessels had ruptured. spilling erythrocytes
into the tumor interstitium.
[0618] By 24 h after coaguligand injection, the blood vessels were still occluded and extensive
hemorrhage had spread throughout the tumor. Tumor cells had separated from one another,
had pyknotic nuclei and were undergoing cytolysis. By 72 h, advanced necrosis was
evident throughout the tumor. Necrosis was clearly present in the intratumoral region
of the tumor, where VCAM-1 expression on the vessels was not originally prominent.
The coaguligand binding was evidently effective to curtail blood flow in all tumor
regions, resulting in widespread tumor destruction. Furthermore, it is likely that
the initial coaguligand-induced thrombin deposition results in increased induction
of the VCAM-1 target antigen on central vessels, thus amplifying targeting and tumor
destruction.
[0619] The thrombotic action of anti-VCAM-1•tTF on tumor vessels was antigen specific. None
of the control reagents administered at equivalent quantities (tTF alone, anti-VCAM-1
antibody alone, tTF plus anti-VCAM-1 antibody or the control coaguligand of irrelevant
specificity) caused thrombosis (Table 3).
TABLE 3
| Anti-VCAM-1•tTF-Mediated Thrombosis in L540 Tumor Bearing Mice |
| Treatmenta |
Thrombosed Vessels (%)b |
| |
L540 Tumor |
Heart and Lung |
Other Organs |
| Saline |
0-2 |
|
0 |
| tTF |
0-2 |
0 |
0 |
| Anti-VCAM-1 Antibody |
0-2 |
0 |
0 |
| Anti-VCAM-1 Antibody + tTF |
0-2 |
0 |
0 |
| Control IgG•tTF |
0-2 |
0 |
0 |
| Anti-VCAM-1•tTF (< 0.3 cm3)c |
0-10 |
0 |
0 |
| Anti-VCAM-1•tTF (> 0.3 cm3) |
40-70 |
0 |
0 |
| a L540 tumor-bearing mice were injected i.v. with one of the following reagents: saline;
8 µg of unconjugated tTF; 32 µg of unconjugated anti-VCAM-1 antibody; mixture of 8
µg of tTF and 32 µg of anti-VCAM-1 antibody: 40 µg of control IgG•tTF coaguligand;
or 40 µg of anti-VCAM-1•tTF coaguligand. Animals were sacrificed 4 h after injection.
Tissues were removed and fixed in formalin. |
| b Histological quantification was performed by counting numbers of thrombosed blood
vessels in 5 cross sections of tissue. The number of thrombosed vessels is expressed
as a percentage of total vessels. The range of results from three mice is given. |
| c L540 tumor bearing mice were divided into two groups (5-8 animals per group) having
tumors smaller or larger than 0.3 cm3. |
2. Lack of Thrombosis of Normal Blood Vessels
[0620] In addition to the thrombosis of tumor blood vessels, this study also shows that
intravenous administration of the anti-VCAM-1•tTF coaguligand does not induce thrombosis
of blood vessels in normal organs.
[0621] Despite expression of VCAM-1 on vessels in the heart and lung of normal or L540 tumor-bearing
mice (Table 1). thrombosis did not occur after anti-VCAM-1•tTF coaguligand administration.
No signs of thrombosis, tissue damage or altered morphology were seen in 25 mice injected
with 5 to 45 µg of coaguligand 4 or 24 h earlier. There was a normal histological
appearance of the heart and lung from the same mouse that had major tumor thrombosis.
All other major organs (brain, liver, kidney, spleen, pancreas, intestine, testis)
also had unaltered morphology.
[0622] Frozen sections of organs and tumors from coaguligand-treated mice gave coincident
staining patterns when developed with either the anti-TF antibody. 10H10, or an anti-rat
IgG antibody and confirmed that the coaguligand had localized to vessels in the heart,
lung and tumor. The intensity of staining was equal to that seen when coaguligand
was applied directly to the sections at high concentrations followed by development
with anti-TF or anti-rat IgG, indicating that saturation of binding had been attained
in vivo.
[0623] These studies show that binding of coaguligand to VCAM-1 on normal vasculature in
heart and lung is' not sufficient to induce thrombosis, and that tumor vasculature
provides additional factors to support coagulation.
EXAMPLE VII
In Vivo Tumor Destruction by Anti-VCAM-1 Coaguligand
A. Methods
[0624] Male CB17 SCID mice were injected subcutaneously with 1 × 10
7 L540 cells as described above. When the tumors had reached a volume of 0.4-0.6 cm
3, the mice were injected intravenously with either 20 µg of anti-VCAM-1•tTF, 16 µg
anti-VCAM-1 antibody, 4 µg tTF, a mixture of 16 µg of anti-VCAM-1 antibody and 4 µg
of tTF, 20 µg control IgG•tTF or saline. In some studies, the treatment was given
3 times, on days 0, 4 and 8. A minimum of 8 animals were treated in each group.
[0625] Animals were monitored daily for tumor measurements and body weight. Mice were sacrificed
when tumors had reached a diameter of 2 cm
3, or earlier if tumors showed signs of necrosis or ulceration. Tumor volume was calculated
according to the formula: π/6 × D × d
2. where D is the larger tumor diameter and d is the smaller diameter. Differences
in tumor growth rates were tested for statistical significance using a non-parametric
test (Mann-Whitney rank sum test) that makes no assumptions about tumor size being
normally distributed (Gibbons, 1976).
B. Results
[0626] The anti-tumor activity of anti-VCAM-1•tTF coaguligand was determined in SCID mice
bearing 0.3-0.4 cm
3 L540 tumors. The drug was administered i.v. 3 times at intervals of 4 days. The pooled
results from 3 separate studies are presented in FIG. 2 and Table 4. Mean tumor volume
of anti-VCAM-1•tTF treated mice was significantly reduced at 21 days of treatment
(
P < 0.001) in comparison to all other groups. Nine of a total of 15 mice treated with
the specific coaguligand showed more than 50% reduction in tumor volume. This effect
was specific since unconjugated tTF, control IgG coaguligand and mixture of free anti-VCAM-1
antibody and tTF did not affect tumor growth.
TABLE 4
| Inhibition of Tumor Growth by Anti-VCAM-1•tTF Coaguligand |
| Treatmenta |
n |
Mean tumor volume (mm3)b |
Tumor Growth Indexc |
P versus salined |
| |
|
Day 0 |
Day 21 |
|
|
| Saline |
14 |
331 ± 61 |
2190±210 |
6.91 |
- |
| TTF |
13 |
341 ± 22 |
2015 ± 205 |
5.90 |
NS |
| Anti-VCAM-1 |
16 |
363 ± 24 |
1920 ± 272 |
5.28 |
NS |
| Anti-VCAM-1+tTF |
13 |
349 ±42 |
2069 ±362 |
5.92 |
NS |
| Control IgG•tTF |
8 |
324 ±30 |
2324 ±304 |
7.17 |
NS |
| Anti-VCAM-1•tTF |
15 |
365 ± 28 |
1280 ± 130 |
3.50 |
< 0.001 |
| a L540 tumor bearing mice were injected i.v. with one of the following reagents: saline;
8 µg of unconjugated tTF; 32 µg of unconjugated anti-VCAM-1 antibody; mixture of 8
µg of tTF and 32 µg of anti-VCAM-1 antibody; 40 µg of control IgG•tTF (R187) coaguligand;
or 40 µg of anti-VCAM-1•tTF coaguligand. The treatment was repeated on day 4 and 7
after first injection. |
| b Mean tumor volume ± SD. |
| c The tumor growth index is the ratio of mean tumor volume on day 21 to mean tumor
volume on day 0. |
| d Two tailed P values are for differences in tumor volume (day 21) for the treated
groups versus the saline group as determined by the Mann-Whitney rank sum test. |
EXAMPLE VIII
Phosphatidylserine Expression on Tumor Blood Vessels
A. Methods
1. Antibodies
[0627] Anti-phosphatidylserine (anti-PS) and anti-cardiolipin antibodies, both mouse monoclonal
IgM antibodies, were produced as described by Rote (Rote
et al., 1993). Details of the characterization of the anti-PS and anti-cardiolipin antibodies
were also reported by Rote
et al. (1993).
2. Detection of PS Expression on Vascular Endothelium
[0628] L540 tumor-bearing mice were injected i.v. with 20 µg of either anti-PS or anti-cardiolipin
mouse IgM antibodies. After 10 min., mice were anesthetized and their blood circulations
were perfused with heparinized saline. Tumors and normal tissues were removed and
snap-frozen. Serial sections of organs and tumors were stained with either HRP-labeled
anti-mouse IgM for detection of anti-PS antibody or with anti-VCAM- 1 antibody followed
by HRP-labeled anti-rat Ig.
[0629] To preserve membrane phospholipids on frozen sections, the following protocol was
developed. Animals were perfused with DPBS containing 2.5 mM Ca
2+. Tissues were mounted on 3-aminopropyltriethoxysilane-coated slides and were stained
within 24 h. No organic solvents, formaldehyde or detergents were used for fixation
or washing of the slides. Slides were re-hydrated by DPBS containing 2.5 mM Ca
2+ and 0.2% gelatin. The same solution was also used to wash sections to remove the
excess of reagents. Sections were incubated with HRP-labeled anti-mouse IgM for 3.5
h at room temperature to detect anti-PS IgM.
B. Results
[0630] To explain the lack of thrombotic effect of anti-VCAM-1•tTF on VCAM-1 positive vasculature
in heart and lungs, the inventors developed a concept of differential PS localization
between normal and tumor blood vessels. Specifically, they hypothesized that endothelial
cells in normal tissues segregate PS to the inner surface of the plasma membrane phospholipid
bilayer, where it is unable to participate in thrombotic reactions; whereas endothelial
cells in tumors translocate PS to the external surface of the plasma membrane, where
it can support the coagulation action of the coaguligand. PS expression on the cell
surface allows coagulation because it enables the attachment of coagulation factors
to the membrane and coordinates the assembly of coagulation initiation complexes (Ortel
et al., 1992).
[0631] The inventors' model of PS translocation to the surface of tumor blood vessel endothelial
cells. as developed herein, is surprising in that PS expression does not occur after,
and does not inevitably trigger, cell death. PS expression at the tumor endothelial
cell surface is thus sufficiently stable to allow PS to serve as a targetable entity
for therapeutic intervention.
[0632] To confirm the hypothesis that tumor blood vessel endothelium expresses PS on the
luminal surface of the plasma membrane, the inventors used immunohistochemistry to
determine the distribution of anti-PS antibody after intravenous injection into L540
tumor bearing mice. Anti-PS antibody localized within 10 min. to the majority of tumor
blood vessels, including vessels in the central region of the tumor that can lack
VCAM-1. Vessels that were positive for VCAM-1 were also positive for PS. Thus, there
is coincident expression of PS on VCAM-1-expressing vessels in tumors.
[0633] In the
in vivo localization studies, none of the vessels in normal organs, including VCAM-1-positive
vasculature of heart and lung, were stained, indicating that PS is absent from the
external surface of the endothelial cells. In contrast, when sections of normal tissues
and tumors were directly stained with anti-PS antibody
in vitro. no differences were visible between normal and tumor, endothelial or other cell types,
showing that PS is present within these cells but only becomes expressed on the surface
of endothelial cells in tumors.
[0634] The specificity of PS detection was confirmed by two independent studies. First,
a mouse IgM monoclonal antibody directed against a different negatively charged lipid,
cardiolipin, did not home to tumor or any organs
in vivo. Second, pretreatment of frozen sections with acetone abolished staining with anti-PS
antibody, presumably because it extracted the lipids together with the bound anti-PS
antibody.
EXAMPLE IX
Annexin V Blocks Coaguligand Activation of Factor X In Vitro
A. Methods
[0635] The ability of Annexin V to affect Factor Xa formation induced by coaguligand was
determined by a chromogenic assay described above in Example V. IL-1α-stimulated bEnd.3
cells were incubated with anti-VCAM-•tTF and permeabilized by saponin. Annexin V was
added at concentrations ranging from 0.1 to 10 µg/ml and cells were incubated for
30 min. before addition of diluted Proplex T. The amount of Factor Xa generated in
the presence or absence of Annexin V was determined as described in Example V. Each
treatment was performed in duplicate and repeated at least twice.
B. Results
[0636] The need for surface PS expression in coaguligand action is further indicated by
the inventors' finding that annexin V, which binds to PS with high affinity, blocks
the ability of anti-VCAM-1•tTF bound to bEnd.3 cells to generate factor Xa
in vitro.
[0637] Annexin V added to permeabilized cells preincubated with anti-VCAM-1•tTF inhibited
the formation of factor Xa in a dose-dependent manner (FIG. 3). In the absence of
Annexin V, cell-bound coaguligand produced 95 ng of factor Xa per 10,000 cells per
60 min. The addition of increasing amounts of Annexin V (in the µg per ml range) inhibited
factor Xa production. At 10 µg per ml, Annexin V inhibited factor Xa production by
58% (FIG. 3). No further inhibition was observed by increasing the concentration of
Annexin V during the assay, indicating that annexin V saturated all available binding
sites at 10 µg per ml.
EXAMPLE X
Annexin V Blocks Coaguligand Activity In Vivo
A. Methods
[0638] The ability of Annexin V to inhibit coaguligand-induced thrombosis
in vivo was examined in L540 Hodgkin-bearing SCID mice. Tumors were grown in mice as described
above in Example II. Two mice per group (tumor size 0.5 cm in diameter) were injected
intravenously via the tail vein with one of the following reagents: a) saline; b)
100 µg of Annexin V; c) 40 µg of anti-VCAM-1•tTF; d) 100 µg of Annexin V followed
2 hours later by 40 µg of anti-VCAM-1•tTF.
[0639] Four hours after the last injection mice were anesthetized and perfused with heparinized
saline. Tumors were removed, fixed with 4% formalin, paraffin-embedded and stained
with hematoxylene-eosin. The number of thrombosed and non-thrombosed blood vessels
were counted and the percentage of thrombosis was calculated.
B. Results
[0640] Annexin V also blocks the activity of the anti-VCAM-1·tTF coaguligand
in vivo. Groups of tumor-bearing mice were treated with one of the control or test reagents,
as described in the methods. Mice were given (a) saline; (b) 100 µg of Annexin V;
(c) 40 µg of anti-VCAM-1•tTF coaguligand; or (d) 100 µg of Annexin V followed 2 hours
later by 40 µg of anti-VCAM-1•tTF coaguligand. Identical results were obtained in
both mice per group.
[0641] No spontaneous thrombosis, hemorrhages or necrosis were observed in tumors derived
from saline-injected mice. Treatment with Annexin V alone did not alter tumor morphology.
[0642] In accordance with other data presented herein, 40 µg of anti-VCAM-1•tTF coaguligand
caused thrombosis in 70% of total tumor blood vessels. The majority of blood vessels
were occluded with packed erythrocytes and clots. and tumor cells were separated from
one another. Both coaguligand-induced anti-tumor effects,
i.e., intravascular thrombosis and changes in tumor cell morphology, were completely abolished
by pre-treating the mice with Annexin V.
[0643] These findings confirm that the anti-tumor effects of coaguligands are mediated through
the blockage of tumor vasculature. These data also demonstrate that PS is essential
for coaguligand-induced thrombosis
in vivo.
EXAMPLE XI
Externalized Phosphatidylserine is a Global Marker of Tumor Blood Vessels
A. Methods
[0644] PS exposure on tumor and normal vascular endothelium was examined in three animal
tumor models: L540 Hodgkin lymphoma, NCI-H358 non-small cell lung carcinoma, and HT
29 colon adenocarcinoma (ATCC). To grow the tumors
in vivo, 2 × 10
6 cells were injected into the right flank of SCID mice and allowed to reach 0.8-1.2
cm in diameter. Mice bearing large tumors (volume above 800 mm
3) were injected intravenously
via the tail vein with 20 µg of either anti-PS or anti-cardiolipin antibodies. The anti-cardiolipin
antibody served as a control for all studies since both antibodies are directed against
negatively charged lipids and belong to the same class of immunoglobulins (mouse IgM).
[0645] One hour after injection, mice were anesthetized and their blood circulation was
perfused with heparinized saline. Tumors and normal organs were removed and snap-frozen.
Frozen sections were stained with anti-mouse IgM-peroxidase conjugate (Jackson Immunoresearch
Labs) followed by development with carbazole.
B. Results
[0646] The anti-PS antibodies specifically homed to the vasculature of all three tumors
(HT 29, L540 and NCI-H358)
in vivo, as indicated by detection of the mouse IgM. The average percentages of vessels stained
in the tumors were 80% for HT 29, 30% for L540 and 50% for NCI-H358. Vessels in all
regions of the tumors were stained and there was staining both of small capillaries
and larger vessels.
[0647] No vessel staining was observed with anti-PS antibodies in any normal tissues. In
the kidney, tubules were stained both with anti-PS and anti-CL, and this likely relates
to the secretion of IgMs by this organ (Table 5). Anti-cardiolipin antibodies were
not detected in any tumors or normal tissues, except kidney.
[0648] These findings indicate that only tumor endothelium exposes PS to the outer site
of the plasma membrane.
TABLE 5
| Vessel Localization of Anti-PS and Anti-Cardiolipin Abs in Tumor-Bearing Mice* |
| Tissue |
Anti-PS† |
Anti-Cardiolipin† |
| L540 Cy tumor |
++ |
- |
| H358 tumor |
++ |
- |
| HT29 tumor |
+++ |
- |
| Adrenal |
- |
- |
| Brain Cerebellum |
- |
- |
| Brain Cortex |
- |
- |
| Heart |
- |
- |
| Kidney |
-‡ |
-‡ |
| Large Intestine |
- |
- |
| Liver |
- |
- |
| Lung |
- |
- |
| Pancreas |
- |
- |
| Small Intestine |
- |
- |
| Spleen |
- |
- |
| Testes |
- |
- |
| *Biodistribution in normal organs of both anti-PS and anti-cardiolipin Abs was identical
in all three tumor animal models. |
| †Anti-PS and anti-cardiolipin antibodies were detected on frozen sections using anti-mouse
IgM-peroxidase conjugate. - no staining; + weak; ++ moderate; +++ strong, equivalent
to pan endothelial marker Meca 32. |
| ‡Tubular staining was observed in the kidneys of both and-PS and anti-CL recipients. |
[0649] To estimate the time at which tumor vasculature loses the ability to segregate PS
to the inner side of the membrane, the inventors examined anti-PS localization in
L540 tumors ranging in volume from 140 to 1,600 mm
3. Mice were divided into 3 groups according to their tumor size: 140-300, 350-800
and 800-1.600 mm
3. Anti-PS Ab was not detected in three mice bearing small L540 tumors (up to 300 mm
3). Anti-PS Ab localized in 3 animals of 5 in the group of intermediate size L540 tumors
and in all mice (4 out of 4) bearing large L540 tumors (Table 6). Percent of PS-positive
blood vessels from total (identified by pan endothelial marker Meca 32) was 10-20%
in the L540 intermediate group and 20-40% in the group of large L540 tumors (Table
6).
TABLE 6
| PS Externalization Detected in Mid and Large Sized Tumors |
| Tumor Size (mm3) |
No. Positive Tumors/Total* |
%PS-Positive Vessels/Total† |
| 350-800 |
3/5 |
10-20 |
| 850-1,600 |
4/4 |
20-40 |
| *Mice bearing L540 Cy tumors were divided into three groups according to tumor size.
20 µg of anti-PS antibodies were injected i.v. and allowed to circulate for 1 hour.
Mouse antibodies were detected on frozen sections using anti-mouse IgM-peroxidase
conjugate. |
| †Total number of blood vessels was determined using pan-endothelial Ab Meca 32. PS-positive
and Meca-positive vessels were counted in 4 fields per cross section of tumor. Range
of % PS-positive vessels within the same group is shown. |
EXAMPLE XII
Anti-Tumor Effects of Unconjugated Anti-Phosphatidylserine Antibodies
A. Methods
[0650] The effects of anti-PS antibodies were examined in syngeneic and xenogeneic tumor
models. For the syngeneic model, 1x10
7 cells of murine colorectal carcinoma Colo 26 (obtained from Dr. Ian Hart, ICRF, London)
were injected subcutaneously into the right flank of Balb/c mice. In the xenogeneic
model, a human Hodgkin's lymphoma L540 xenograft was established by injecting 1x10
7 cells subcutaneously into the right flank of male CB17 SCID mice. Tumors were allowed
to grow to a size of about 0.6-0.9 cm
3 before treatment.
[0651] Tumor-bearing mice (4 animals per group) were injected i.p. with 20 µg of naked anti-PS
antibody (IgM), control mouse IgM or saline. Treatment was repeated 3 times with a
48 hour interval. Animals were monitored daily for tumor measurements and body weight.
Tumor volume was calculated as described in Example VII. Mice were sacrificed when
tumors had reached 2 cm
3, or earlier if tumors showed signs of necrosis or ulceration.
B. Results
[0652] The growth of both syngeneic and xenogeneic tumors was effectively inhibited by treatment
with naked anti-PS antibodies (FIG. 4A and FIG. 4B). Anti-PS antibodies caused tumor
vascular injury, accompanied by thrombosis, and tumor necrosis. The presence of clots
and disintegration of tumor mass surrounding blocked blood vessels was evident.
[0653] Quantitatively, the naked anti-PS antibody treatment inhibited tumor growth by up
to 60% of control tumor volume in mice bearing large Colo 26 (FIG. 4A) and L540 (FIG.
4B) tumors. No retardation of tumor growth was found in mice treated with saline or
control IgM. No toxicity was observed in mice treated with anti-PS antibodies, with
normal organs preserving unaltered morphology, indistinguishable from untreated or
saline-treated mice.
[0654] Tumor regression started 24 hours after the first treatment and tumors continue to
decline in size for the next 6 days. This was observed in both syngeneic and immunocompromised
tumor models, indicating that the effect was mediated by immune status-independent
mechanism(s). Moreover, the decline in tumor burden was associated with the increase
of alertness and generally healthy appearance of the animals, compared to control
mice bearing tumors larger than 1500 mm
3. Tumor re-growth occurred 7-8 days after the first treatment.
[0655] The results obtained with anti-PS treatment of L540 tumors are further compelling
for the following reasons. Notably, the tumor necrosis observed in L540 tumor treatment
occurred despite the fact that the percentage of vessels that stained positive for
PS in L540 tumors was less than in HT 29 and NCl-H358 tumors. This implies that even
more rapid necrosis would likely result when treating other tumor types. Furthermore,
L540 tumors are generally chosen as an experimental model because they provide clean
histological sections and they are, in fact, known to be resistant to necrosis.
EXAMPLE XIII
Anti-Tumor Effects of Annexin Conjugates
[0656] The surprising finding that aminophospholipids are stable markers of tumor vasculature
also means that antibody-therapeutic agent constructs can be used in cancer treatment.
In addition to using antibodies as targeting agents, the inventors reasoned that annexins,
and other aminophospholipid-binding proteins, could also be used to specifically deliver
therapeutic agents to tumor vasculature. The following data shows the anti-tumor effects
that result from the
in vivo administration of annexin-TF constructs.
A. Methods
[0657] An annexin V-tTF conjugate was prepared and administered to nu/nu mice with solid
tumors. The tumors were formed from human HT29 colorectal carcinoma cells that formed
tumors of at least about 1.2 cm
3. The annexin V-tTF coaguligand (10 µg) was administered intravenously and allowed
to circulate for 24 hours. Saline-treated mice were separately maintained as control
animals. After the one day treatment period, the mice were sacrificed and exsanguinated
and the tumors and major organs were harvested for analysis.
B. Results
[0658] The annexin V-tTF conjugate was found to induce specific tumor blood vessel coagulation
in HT29 tumor bearing mice. Approximately 55% of the tumor blood vessels in the annexin
V-tTF conjugate treated animals were thrombosed following a single injection. In contrast,
there was minimal evidence of thrombosis in the tumor vasculature of the control animals.
EXAMPLE XIV
Phosphatidylserine Translocation in the Tumor Environment
[0659] The discovery of PS as an
in vivo surface marker unique to tumor vascular endothelial cells prompted the inventors
to further investigate the effect of a tumor environment on PS translocation and outer
membrane expression. The present example shows that exposing endothelial cells
in vitro to certain conditions that mimic those in a tumor duplicates the observed PS surface
expression in intact, viable cells.
A. Methods
[0660] Mouse bEnd.3 endothelial cells were seeded at an initial density of 50,000 cells/well.
Twenty-fours later cells were incubated with increasing concentrations of H
2O
2 (from 10 µM to 500 µM) for 1 hour at 37°C or left untreated. At the end of the incubation,
cells were washed 3 times with PBS containing 0.2% gelatin and fixed with 0.25% glutaraldehyde.
Identical wells were either stained with anti-PS IgM or trypsinized and evaluated
for viability by the Trypan Blue exclusion test. For the anti-PS staining, after blocking
with 2% gelatin for 10 min., cells were incubated with 2 µg/ml of anti-PS antibody,
followed by detection with anti-mouse IgM-HRP conjugate.
[0661] Wells seeded with mouse bEnd.3 endothelial cells were also incubated with different
effectors and compared to control, untreated wells after the same period of incubation
at 37°C. The panel of effectors tested included TNF, LPS, bFGF, IL-1α. IL-1β and thrombin.
After incubation, cells were washed and fixed and were again either stained with anti-PS
IgM or evaluated for viability using the Trypan Blue exclusion test, as described
above.
B. Results
1. PS Induction by H2O2
[0662] Exposing endothelial cells to H
2O
2 at concentrations higher than 100 µM caused PS translocation in ∼90% cells. However,
this was accompanied by detachment of the cells from the substrate and cell viability
decreasing to about 50-60%. The association of surface PS expression with decreasing
cell viability is understandable, although it is still interesting to note that ∼90%
PS translocation is observed with only a 50-60% decrease in cell viability.
[0663] Using concentrations of H
2O
2 lower than 100 µM resulted in significant PS expression without any appreciable reduction
in cell viability. For example, PS was detected at the cell surface of about 50% of
cells in all H
2O
2 treated wells using H
2O
2 at concentrations as low as 20 µM. It is important to note that, under these low
H
2O
2 concentrations, the cells remained firmly attached to the plastic and to each other,
showed no morphological changes and had no signs of cytotoxicity. Detailed analyses
revealed essentially 100% cell-cell contact, retention of proper cell shape and an
intact cytoskeleton.
[0664] The 50% PS surface expression induced by low levels of H
2O
2 was thus observed in cell populations in which cell viability was identical to the
control, untreated cells (
i.e., 95%). The PS expression associated with high H
2O
2 concentrations was accompanied by cell damage, and the PS-positive cells exposed
to over 100 µM H
2O
2 were detached, floating and had disrupted cytoskeletons.
[0665] The maintenance of cell viability in the presence of low concentrations H
2O
2 is consistent with data from other laboratories. For example, Schorer
et al. (1985) showed that human umbilical vein endothelial cells (HUVEC) treated with 15
µM H
2O
2 averaged 90 to 95% viability (reported as 5% to 10% injury), whilst those exposed
to 1500 µM H
2O
2 were only 0%-50% viable (50% to 100% injured).
[0666] The use of H
2O
2 to mimic the tumor environment
in vitro is also appropriate in that the tumor environment is rich in inflammatory cells,
such as macrophages, PMNs and granulocytes, which produce H
2O
2 and other reactive oxygen species. Although never before connected with stable tumor
vascular markers, inflammatory cells are known to mediate endothelial cell injury
by mechanisms involving reactive oxygen species that require the presence of H
2O
2 (Weiss
et al., 1981; Yamada
et al., 1981; Schorer
et al., 1985). In fact, studies have shown that stimulation of PMNs
in vitro produces concentrations of H
2O
2 sufficient to cause sublethal endothelial cell injury without causing cell death
(measured by chromium release assays) or cellular detachment; and that these H
2O
2 concentrations are attainable locally
in vivo (Schorer
et al., 1985).
[0667] The present
in vitro translocation data correlates with the earlier results showing that anti-PS antibodies
localize specifically to tumor vascular endothelial cells
in vivo, and do not bind to cells in normal tissues. The finding that
in vivo-like concentrations of H
2O
2 induce PS translocation to the endothelial cell surface without disrupting cell integrity
has important implications in addition to validating the original
in vivo data and the inventors' therapeutic approaches.
[0668] Human, bovine and murine endothelial cells are all known to be PS-negative under
normal conditions. Any previously documented PS expression has always been associated
with cell damage and/or cell death., This is simply not the case in the present studies,
where normal viability is maintained. This shows that PS translocation in tumor vascular
endothelium is mediated by biochemical mechanisms unconnected to cell damage. This
is believed to be the first demonstration of PS surface expression in morphologically
intact endothelial cells and the first indication that PS expression can be disconnected
from the apoptosis pathway(s). Returning to the operability of the present invention,
these observations again confirm that PS is a sustainable, rather than transient,
marker of tumor blood vessels and a suitable, candidate for therapeutic intervention.
2. PS Expression Does Not Correlate with Cell Activation
[0669] The relevance of this
in vitro data to the tumor environment is also strengthened by the fact that other, general
cell activators are without effect on PS translocation in endothelial cells. For example,
the inventors tested TNF in similarly controlled studies and found it unable to induce
PS surface expression, despite the expected increases in E-selectin and VCAM expression.
Likewise, LPS, bFGF. IL-1α and IL-1β were all without effect on PS expression in appropriately
controlled studies.
3. PS Induction by Thrombin
[0670] In contrast to the lack of effects of other cell activators, thrombin was observed
to increase PS expression, although not to the same extent as H
2O
2. This data is also an integral part of the tumor-induction model of PS expression
developed by the present inventors (thrombin-induced PS surface expression in normal
tissues would also further coagulation as PS expression coordinates the assembly of
coagulation initiation complexes (Ortel
et al., 1992)).
[0671] The tumor environment is known to be prothrombotic, such that tumor vasculature is
predisposed to coagulation (U.S. Patent No. 5,877,289). As thrombin is a product of
the coagulation cascade, it is present in tumor vasculature. In fact. the presence
of thrombin induces VCAM expression, contributing to the inventors' ability to exploit
VCAM as a targetable marker of tumor vasculature (U.S. Patent Nos. 5,855,866; 5,877,289).
The present data showing that thrombin also induces PS expression is thus both relevant
to targeting aminophospholipids with naked antibodies and therapeutic conjugates,
and further explains the beneficial effects of the anti-VCAM coaguligand containing
Tissue Factor (Example VII).
REFERENCES
[0672]
Abrams and Oldham, In: Monoclonal Antibody Therapy of Human Cancer, Foon and Morgan (Eds.), Martinus Nijhoff Publishing, Boston, pp. 103-120,1985.
Anderson, Croyle, Lingrel, "Primary structure of a gene encoding rat T-kininogen,"
Gene, 81(1):119:28, 1989.
Antibodies: A Laboratory Manual, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory, 1988.
Asahara, Chen, Takahashi, Fujikawa, Kearney, Magner, Yancopoulos, Isner, "Tie2 receptor
ligands, angiopoietin-1 and angiopoietin-2, modulate VEGF-induced postnatal neovascularization"
Circ. Res., 83(3):233-40, 1998.
Barbas, Kang, Lerner, Benkovic, "Assembly of combinatorial antibody libraries on phage
surfaces: the gene III site," Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci., USA, 88(18):7978-7982, 1991.
Berard, Boffa, Karmochkine, Aillaud, Juhan-Vague, Frances, Cacoub, Piette, Harle,
"Plasma reactivity to hexagonal II phase phosphatidylethanolamine is more frequently
associated with lupus anticoagulant than with antiphosphatidylethanolamine antibodies,"
J. Lab. Clin. Med., 122(5):601-605, 1993.
Berman, Mellis, Pollock, Smith, Suh, Heinke, Kowal, Surti, Chess, Cantor, et al., "Content and organization of the human Ig VH locus: definition of three new VH families
and linkage to the Ig CH locus," EMBO J., 7(3):727-738, 1988.
Bemier and Jolles, "Purification and characterization of a basic 23 kDa cytosolic
protein from bovine brain," Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 790(2)174-181, 1984.
Bernier, Tresca, Jolles, "Ligand-binding studies with a 23 kDa protein purified from
bovine brain cytosol," Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 871(1):19-23, 1986.
Bevers, Comburius, Zwaal, "The nature of the binding site for prothrombinase at the
platelet surface as revealed by lipolytic enzymes," Eur. J. Biochem., 122:81-85, 1982.
Bevers, Comfurius, Zwaal, "Changes in membrane phospholipid distribution during platelet
activation," Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 736:57-66, 1983.
Bevers, Rosing, Zwaal, "Development of procoagulant binding sites on the platelet
surface," Adv. Exp. Med. Biol., 192:359-371, 1985.
Bevers, Galli, Barbui, Comfurius, Zwaal, "Lupus anticoagulant IgG's (LA) are not directed
to phospholipids only, but to a complex of lipid-bound human prothrombin," Thromb. Haemost., 66(6):629-632, 1991.
Bevilacqua, "Endothelial-leukocyte adhesion molecules," Ann. Rev. Immunol., 11:767-804, 1993.
Blankenberg, Katsikis, Tait, Davis, Naumovski, Ohtsuki, Kopiwoda, Abrams, Darkes,
Robbins, Maecker, Strauss, "In vivo detection and imaging of phosphatidylserine expression during programmed cell death,"
Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci., USA. 95:6349-6354, 1998.
Bocci. "Efficient labeling of serum proteins with 1311 using chloramine T," Int. J. Appl. Radiat, Isot.. 15:449-456, 1964.
Bombeli, Karsan, Tait, Harlan, "Apoptotic vascular endothelial cells become procoagulant."
Blood, 89(7):2429-2442, 1997.
Bordron, Dueymes, Levy, Jamin, Leroy, Piette, Schoenfeld, Youinou, "The binding of
some human antiendothelial cell antibodies induces endothelial cell apoptosis." J. Clin. Invest., 101(10):2029-2035. 1998.
Bornstein, "Thrombospondins: structure and regulation of expression," FASEB J, 6(14):3290-3299, 1992.
Borrebaeck and Moller, "In vitro immunization. Effect of growth and differentiation factors on antigen-specific B
cell activation and production of monoclonal antibodies to autologous antigens and
weak immunogens," J. Immunol., 136(10):3710-3715, 1986.
Bradford, "A rapid and sensitive method for the quantitation of microgram quantities
of protein utilizing the principle of protein-dye binding," Anal. Biochem., 72:248-254, 1976.
Branch, Rote, Dostal, Scott, "Association of lupus anticoagulant with antibody against
phosphatidylserine," Clin. Immun. Immunopathol., 42:63-75, 1987.
Brinkman, Mertens, Holthius, Zwart-Huinink, Grijm, Van Mourik, "The activation of
human blood coagulation factor X on the surface of endothelial cells: a comparison
with various vascular cells, platelets and monocytes," Br. J. Haematol., 87:332-342, 1994.
Bruijn and Dinklo, "Distinct patterns of expression of intercellular adhesion molecule-1,
vascular cell adhesion molecule-1, and endothelial-leukocyte adhesion molecule-1 in
renal disease," Lab. Invest., 69:329-335, 1993.
Burke et al., "Cloning of large segments of exogenous DNA into yeast by means of artificial chromosome
vectors", Science, 236, 806-812, 1987.
Burrows and Thorpe, "Eradication of large solid tumors in mice with an immunotoxin
directed against tumor vasculature," Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 90:8996-9000, 1993.
Burrows, Watanabe, Thorpe, "A murine model for antibody-directed targeting of vascular
endothelial cells in solid tumors," Cancer Res., 52:5954-5962, 1992.
Bussolino, deRossi, Sica, Colotta, Wang, Bocchietto, Martin, Padura, Bosia, Dejana.
Mantovani, "Murine endothelial cell lines transformed by polyoma middle T oncogene
as target for and producers of cytokines," J. Immunol., 147:2122-2129, 1991.
Campbell, In: Monoclonal Antibody Technology, Laboratory Techniques in Biochemistry and Molecular Biology, Vol. 13, Burden and Von Knippenberg (Eds.), Elseview, Amsterdam, pp. 75-83, 1984.
Carnemolla et al., "A tumor-associated fibronectin isoform generated by alternative splicing of messenger
RNA precursors." J. Cell Biol., 108:1139-1148, 1989.
Chamley, McKay, Pattison, "Cofactor dependent and cofactor independent anticardiolipin
antibodies." Thromb. Res., 61(3):291-299, 1991.
Clapp et al., "The 16-kilodalton N-terminal fragment of human prolactin is a potent inhibitor
of angiogenesis," Endocrinology, 133(3):292-1299, 1993.
Connor, Bucana, Fidler, Schroit, "Differentiation-dependent expression of phosphatidylserine
in mammalian plasma membranes: quantitative assessment of outer-leaflet lipid by prothrombinase
complex formation." Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 86(9):3184-3188, 1989.
Coughlin et al., "Interleukin-12 and interleukin-18 synergistically induce murine tumor regression
which involves inhibition of angiogenesis," J. Clin. Invest., 101(6):1441-1452, 1998.
Dachary-Prigent, Toti, Satta, Pasquet, Uzan, Freyssinet, "Physiopathological significance
of catalytic phospholipids in the generation of thrombin." Seminars In Thrombosis and Hemostasis. 22:157-164, 1996.
D'Amato et al., "Thalidomide is an inhibitor of angiogenesis," Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 91(9):4082-4085, 1994.
D'Angelo et al., "Activation of mitogen-activated protein kinases by vascular endothelial growth
factor and basic fibroblast growth factor in capillary endothelial cells is inhibited
by the antiangiogenic factor 16-kDa N- terminal fragment of prolactin," Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 92(14):6374-6378, 1995.
Davis and Yancopoulos, "The angiopoietins: Yin and Yang in angiogenesis", Curr. Top. Microbiol. Immunol., 237:173-85, 1999.
de Jong, Geldwerth, Kuypers, "Oxidative damage does not alter membrane phospholipid
asymmetry in human erythrocytes," Am. Chem. Soc., 1997.
Denekamp, "Vascular attack as a therapeutic strategy for cancer," Cancer Metastasis Rev., 9:267-282, 1990.
DeVore et al., "Phase I Study of the Antineovascularization Drug CM101," Clin. Cancer Res., 3(3):365-372, 1997.
"Diehl, Pfreundschuh, Fonatsch, Stein, Falk, Burrichter, Schaadt, "Phenotypic genotypic
analysis of Hodgkin's disease derived cell lines: histopathological and clinical implications,"
Cancer Surveys, 4:399-416, 1985.
Donati, "Cancer and thrombosis: from Phlegmasia alba dolens to transgenic mice," Thromb. Haemost., 74:278-281, 1995.
Drouvalakis and Buchanan, "Phospholipid specificity of autoimmune and drug induced
lupus anticoagulants; association of phosphatidylethanolamine reactivity with thrombosis
in autoimmune disease," J. Rheumatol., 25(2):290-295, 1998.
Droz, Patey, Paraf, Chretien, Gogusev, "Composition of extracellular matrix and distribution
of cell adhesion molecules in renal cell tumors," Lab. Invest., 71:710-718, 1994.
Dvorak, Nagy, Dvorak, "Structure of Solid Tumors and Their Vasculature: Implications
for Therapy with Monoclonal Antibodies," Cancer Cells, 3(3):77-85, 1991.
Edgington, Mackman, Brand, Ruf, "The Structural Biology of Expression and Function
of Tissue Factor," Thromb. Haemost., 66(1):67-79, 1991.
Ferrara, Clapp, Weiner, "The 16K fragment of prolactin specifically inhibits basal
or fibroblast growth factor stimulated growth of capillary endothelial cells." Endocrinology. 129(2):896-900, 1991.
Flynn, Byrne, Baglin, Weissberg, Bennett. "Thrombin generation by apoptotic vascular
smooth muscle cells," Blood, 89(12):4378-4384, 1997.
Folkman et al., "Angiogenesis inhibition and tumor regression caused by heparin or a heparin fragment
in the presence of cortisone," Science, 221:719-725, 1983.
Fotsis et al., "The endogenous oestrogen metabolite 2-methoxyoestradiol inhibits angiogenesis and
suppresses tumour growth," Nature, 368(6468):237-239, 1994.
Frater-Schroder et al., "Tumor necrosis factor type alpha, a potent inhibitor of endothelial cell growth
in vitro, is angiogenic in vivo," Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 84(15):5277-5281, 1987.
Frazier, "Thrombospondins," Curr. Opin. Cell Biol., 3(5):792-799, 1991.
Fries, Williams, Atkins, Newman, Lipscomb, Collins, "Expression of VCAM-1 and E-selectin
in an in vivo model of endothelial activation," Am. J. Pathol., 143:725-737. 1993.
Gaffet, Bettache, Bienvenüe, "Transverse redistribution of phospholipids during human
platelet activation: evidence for a vectorial outflux specific to aminophospholipids,"
Biochem., 34;6762-6769, 1995.
Gagliardi and Collins, "Inhibition of angiogenesis by antiestrogens," Cancer Res., 53(3):533-535, 1993.
Gagliardi, Hadd, Collins, "Inhibition of angiogenesis by suramin," Cancer Res., 52(18):5073-5075, 1992.
Gagliardi et al., "Antiangiogenic and antiproliferative activity of suramin analogues," Cancer Chemother. Pharmacol., 41(2):117-124, 1998.
Galli, Comfurius, Maassen Hernker, de Baets, van Breda-Vriesman, Barbui, Zwaal, Bevers,
"Anticardiolipin antibodies (ACA) directed not to cardiolipin but to a plasma protein
cofactor," Lancet, 335(8705):1544-1547, 1990.
Galli, Barbui, Zwaal, Comfurius, Bevers, "Antiphospholipid antibodies: involvement
of protein cofactors," Haematologica, 78(1):1-4, 1993.
Ge and Butcher, "Cloning and expression of a cDNA encoding mouse endoglin, an endothelial
cell TGF-beta ligand," Gene, 138:201-206, 1994.
Gefter et al., "A simple method for polyethylene glycol-promoted hybridization of mouse myeloma
cells," Somatic Cell Genet., 3:231-236, 1977,
Gems, Ferguson, Robertson, Nieves, Page, Blaxter, Maizels. "An abundant, trans-spliced
mRNA from Toxocara canis invective larvae encodes a 26-kDa protein with homology to
phosphatidylethanolamine-binding proteins," J. Biol. Chem., 270(31):18517-18522, 1995.
Gibbons, "Mann-Whitney-Wilcoxon test for two independent samples," In: Nonparametric methods for quantitative analysis, J.D.Gibbons (ed.), Holt, Rinehart and Winston, New York, pp. 160, 1976.
Glennie, et al., "Preparation and performance of bispecific F(ab' gamma)2 antibody containing thioether-linked
Fab' gamma fragments," J. Immunol., 139:2367-2375, 1987.
Goding, In: Monoclonal Antibodies: Principles and Practice. 2nd Edition, Academic Press, Orlando, Fl., pp. 60-61, 65-66, 71-74, 1986.
Good et al., "A tumor suppressor-dependent inhibitor of angiogenesis is immunologically and functionally
indistinguishable from a fragment of thrombospondin." Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 87(17):6624-6628, 1990.
Grant et al., "Fibronectin fragments modulate human retinal capillary cell proliferation and migration,"
Diabetes, 47(8):1335-1340, 1998.
Hagemeier et al., "A Monoclonal Antibody Reacting with Endothelial Cells of Budding Vessels in Tumors
and Inflammatory Tissues, and Non-Reactive with Normal Adult Tissues," Int. J. Cancer, 38:481-488, 1986.
Hahne, Jager, Isenmann, Hallmann, Vestweber, "Five tumor necrosis factor-inducible
cell adhesion mechanisms on the surface of mouse endothelioma cells mediate the binding
of leukocytes," J. Cell Biol., 121:655-664, 1993.
Hampton, Vanags, Porn-Ares, Orrenius, "Involvement of extracellular calcium in phosphatidylserine
exposure during apoptosis," FEBS Lett., 399(3):277-282, 1996.
Haran et al., "Tamoxifen enhances cell death in implanted MCF7 breast cancer by inhibiting endothelium
growth," Cancer Res., 54(21):5511-5514, 1994.
Hasselaar and Sage, "SPARC antagonizes the effect of basic fibroblast growth factor
on the migration of bovine aortic endothelial cells," J. Cell Biochem., 49(3):272-283, 1992.
Hellerqvist et al., "Antitumor effects of GBS toxin: a polysaccharide exotoxin from group B beta-hemolytic
streptococcus," J. Cancer Res. Clin. Oncol., 120(1. 2):63-70, 1993.
Hiscox and Jiang, "Interleukin-12, an emerging anti-tumour cytokine." In Vivo, 11(2):125-132, 1997.
Holash et al., "Vessel Cooption, Regression, and Growth in Tumors Mediated by Angiopoietins and
VEGF", Science, 284:1994-1998, 1999.
Hori et al., "Differential effects of angiostatic steroids and dexamethasone on angiogenesis
and cytokine levels in rat sponge implants," Br. J. Pharmacol., 118(7):1584-1591, 1996.
Hori, Chae, Murakawa, Matoba, Fukushima, Okubo, Matsubara, "A human cDNA sequence
homologue of bovine phospbatidylethanolamine-binding protein," Gene, 140(2):293-294, 1994.
Huang, Molema, King, Watkins, Edgington, Thorpe, "Tumor infarction in mice by antibody-directed
targeting of tissue factor to tumor vasculature," Science. 275:547-550, 1997.
Huse, Sastry, Iverson, Kang, Alting-Mees, Burton, Benkovic, Lerner, Science, 246(4935):1275-1281, 1989.
Igarashi, Umeda, Tokita, Soo Nam, Inoue, "Effective induction of anti-phospholipid
and anticoagulant antibodies in normal mouse," Thrombosis Res., 61:135-148, 1991.
Ingber et al., "Angioinhibins: Synthetic analogues of fumagillin which inhibit angiogenesis and
suppress tumor growth," Nature, 48:555-557, 1990.
Iwamoto et al., "Inhibition of angiogenesis, tumour growth and experimental metastasis of human fibrosarcoma
cells HT1080 by a multimeric form of the laminin sequence Tyr-Ile-Gly-Ser-Arg (YIGSR),"
Br. J. Cancer, 73(5):589-595, 1996.
Jackson et al., "Stimulation and inhibition of angiogenesis by placental proliferin and proliferin-related
protein," Science, 266(5190):1581-1584, 1994.
Jamasbi, Wan, Stoner, "Epitope masking of rat esophageal carcinoma tumor-associated
antigen by certain coexisting glycolipid and phospholipid molecules: a potential mechanism
for tumor cell escape from the host immune responses," Cancer Immunol. Immunother., 38(2):99-106, 1994.
Jendraschak and Sage, "Regulation of angiogenesis by SPARC and angiostatin: implications
for tumor cell biology," Semin. Cancer Biol., 7(3):139-146, 1996
Jones and Hall, :"A 23 kDa protein from rat sperm plasma membranes shows sequence
similarity and phospholipid binding properties to a bovine brain cytosolic protein,"
Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 1080(1):78-82, 1991.
Jones, Dear, Foote, Neuberger, Winter, Nature. 321(6069):522-525, 1986.
Julien, Tournier, Tocanne, "Differences in the transbilayer and lateral motions of
fluorescent analogs of phosphatidylcholine and phosphatidylethanolamine in the apical
plasma membrane of bovine aortic endothelial cells," Exp. Cell. Res., 208(2):387-389, 1993.
Julien, Tournier, Tocanne, "Basic fibroblast growth factor modulates the aminophospholipid
translocase activity present in the plasma membrane of bovine aortic endothelial cells."
Eur. J. Biochem., 230:287-297, 1995.
Julien, Millot, Tocanne. Tournier, "12-O-Tetradecanoylphorbol-13-Acetate inhibits aminophospholipid, translocase activity
and modifies the lateral motions of fluorescent phospholipid analogs in the plasma
membrane of bovine aortic endothelial cells." Experimental Cell Res., 234:125-131, 1997.
Kang, Barbas, Janda, Benkovic, Lerner, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci., U.S.A. 88(10):4363-4366, 1991.
Katsuragawa, Kanzaki, Inoue, Hirano, Mori, Rote, "Monoclonal antibody against phosphatidylscrine
inhibits in vitro human trophoblastic hormone production and invasion." Biology of Reproduction, 56:50-58, 1997.
Kellermann, Lottspeich, Henschen, Muller-Esterl. "Completion of the primary structure
of human high-molecular-mass kininogen. The amino acid sequence of the entire heavy
chain and evidence for its evolution by gene triplication," Eur. J. Biochem., 154(2):471-478, 1986.
Kenyon, Browne, D'Amato, "Effects of thalidomide and related metabolites in a mouse
corneal model of neovascularization," Exp. Eye Res., 64(6):971-978, 1997.
Kim, Kwak, Ahn, So, Liu, Koh, Koh, "Molecular cloning and characterization of a novel
angiopoietin family protein, angiopoietin-3", FEBS Lett., 443(3):353-6, 1999.
Kitamura, Takagaki, Furuto, Tanaka, Nawa, Nakanishi, "A single gene for bovine high
molecular weight and low molecular weight kininogens," Nature, 305(5934):545-549, 1983.
Kitamura, Kitagawa, Fukushima, Takagaki, Miyata, Nakanishi, "Structural organization
of the human kininogen gene and a model for its evolution." J. Biol. Chem., 260(14):8610-8617, 1985.
Kitamura, Ohkubo, Nakanishi, "Molecular biology of the angiotensinogen and kininogen
genes," J. Cardiovasc. Pharmacol., 10(Suppl 7):S49-S53, 1987.
Kitamura, Nawa, Takagaki, Furuto-Kato, Nakanishi, "Cloning of cDNAs and genomic DNAs
for high-molecular-weight and low-molecular-weight kininogens," Methods Enzymol., 163:230-240, 1988.
Kleinman et al., "The laminins: a family of basement membrane glycoproteins important in cell differentiation
and tumor metastases," Vitam. Horm., 47:161-186, 1993.
Kohler and Milstein, "Continuous cultures of fused cells secreting antibody of predefined
specificity." Nature, 256:495-497, 1975.
Kohler and Milstein, "Derivation of specific antibody-producing tissue culture and
tumor lines by cell fusion," Eur. J. Immunol., 6:511-519, 1976.
Konieczny, Bobrzecka. Laidler, Rybarska, "The combination of IgM subunits and proteolytic
IgG fragment by controlled formation of interchain disulphides." Haematologia. 14(1):95-99, 1981.
Kuzu, Bicknell, Fletcher, Gatter, "Expression of adhesion molecules on the endothelium
of normal tissue vessels and vascular tumors," Lab. Invest., 69(3):322-328, 1993.
Kyte and Doolittle. "A simple method for displaying the hydropathic character of a
protein," J. Mol. Biol., 157(1):105-132, 1982.
Lane, Iruela-Arispe, Sage, "Regulation of gene expression by SPARC during angiogenesis
in vitro. Changes in fibronectin, thrombospondin-1, and plasminogen activator inhibitor-1,"
J. Biol. Chem., 267(23):16736-16745, 1992.
Lee et al., "Inhibition of urokinase activity by the antiangiogenic factor 16K prolactin: activation
of plasminogen activator inhibitor 1 expression," Endocrinology. 139(9):3696-3703. 1998.
Leppink, Bishop, Sedmak, Henry. Ferguson, Streeter, Butcher, Orosz, "Inducible expression
of an endothelial cell antigen on murine myocardial vasculature in association with
interstitial cellular infiltration," Transplantation, 48(5):874-877, 1989.
Levy, Gharavi, Sammaritano, Habina, Lockshin, "Fatty acid chain is a critical epitope
for antiphospholipid antibody," J. Clin. Immunol., 10(3):141-145, 1990.
Lin, Shroyer, Walter, Lyden, Ng, Rote, "Monoclonal IgM antiphosphatidylserine antibody
reacts against cytoskeleton-like structures in cultured human umbilical cord endothelial
cells," Am. J. Reprod. Immnn., 33:97-107, 1995.
Lin, Buxton, Acheson, Radziejewski, Maisonpierre, Yancopoulos, Channon, Hale, Dewhirst,
George, Peters, "Anti-angiogenic gene therapy targeting the endothelium-specific receptor
tyrosine kinase Tie2", Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci., USA, 95(15):8829-34, 1998.
Lindner and Borden, "Effects of tamoxifen and interferon-beta or the combination on
tumor- induced angiogenesis," Int. J. Cancer, 71(3):456-461, 1997.
Lingen, Polverini, Bouck, "Inhibition of squamous cell carcinoma angiogenesis by direct
interaction of retinoic acid with endothelial cells," Lab. Invest.. 74(2):476-483, 1996.
Lingen, Polverini, Bouck, "Retinoic acid and interferon alpha act synergistically
as antiangiogenic and antitumor agents against human head and neck squamous cell carcinoma,"
Cancer Res., 58(23):5551-5558, 1998.
Liu, Moy, Kim, Xia, Rajasekaran, Navarro, Knudsen, Bander, "Monoclonal antibodies
to the extracellular domain of prostate-specific membrane antigen also react with
tumor vascular endothelium", Cancer Res., 57:3629-3634, 1997.
Majewski et al., "Vitamin D3 is a potent inhibitor of tumor cell-induced angiogenesis," J. Investig. Dermatol. Symp. Proc., 1(1):97-101, 1996.
Mandriota and Pepper, "Regulation of angiopoietin -2 mRNA levels in bovine microvascular
endothelial cells by cytokines and hypoxia", Circ. Res., 83(8):852-9, 1998.
Maneta-Peyret, Bessoule, Geffard, Cassagne, "Demonstration of high specificity antibodies
against phosphatidylserine," J. Immun. Meth., 108:123-127, 1988.
Maneta-Peyret, Freyburger, Bessoule, Cassagne, "Specific immunocytochemical visualization
of phosphatidylserine," J. Immun. Methods, 122:155-159, 1989.
Manetti et al., "Synthesis and binding mode of heterocyclic analogues of suramin inhibiting the
human basic fibroblast growth factor," Bioorg. Med. Chem., 6(7):947-958, 1998.
Martin, Reutelingsperger, McGahon. Rader, van Schie, LaFace, Green, "Early redistribution
of plasma membrane phosphatidylserine is a general feature of apoptosis regardless
of the initiating stimulus: inhibition by overexpression of Bcl-2 and Abl," J. Exp. Med., 182(5):1545-1556, 1995.
Matsuura, Igarashi, Yasuda, Triplett, Koike, "Anticardiolipin antibodies recognize
beta 2-glycoprotein I structure altered by interacting with an oxygen modified solid
phase surface," J. Exp. Med., 179(2):457-462, 1994.
McNeil, Simpson, Chesterman, Krilis, "Anti-phospholipid antibodies are directed against
a complex antigen that includes a lipid-binding inhibitor of coagulation: beta 2-glycoprotein
I (apolipoprotein H)." Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 87(11):4120-4124, 1990.
Mills, Brooker, Camerini-Otero, "Sequences of human immunoglobulin switch regions:
implications for recombination and transcription," Nucl. Acids Res., 18:7305-7316, 1990.
Miyake, Medina, Ishihara, Kimoto, Auerbach, Kincade, "VCAM-like adhesion molecule
on murine bone marrow stromal cells mediates binding of lymphocyte precursors in culture,"
J. Cell. Biol., 114:557-565, 1991.
Moldovan, Moldovan, Simionescu, "Binding of vascular anticoagulant alpha (annexin
V) to the aortic intima of the hypercholesterolemic rabbit. An autoradiographic study,"
Blood Coagul Fibrinolysis, 5(6):921-928, 1994.
Montesano, Pepper, Mohle-Steinlein, Risau. Wagner, Orci, "Increased proteolytic activity
is responsible for the aberrant morphogenetic behavior of endothelial cells expressing
the middle T oncogene." Cell, 62:435-445, 1990.
Moore et al., "Tumor angiogenesis is regulated by CXC chemokines," J. Lab. Clin. Med., 132(2):97-103, 1998.
Morrison, Johnson, Herzenberg, Oi, "Chimeric human antibody molecules: mouse antigen-binding
domains with human constant region domains," Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 81(21):6851-6855, 1984.
Morrison, Wims, Kobrin, Oi, "Production of novel immunoglobulin molecules by gene
transfection," Mt. Sinai J. Med., 53(3):175, 1986.
Morrissey, Fair, Edgington, "Monoclonal antibody analysis of purified and cell-associated
tissue factor," Thromb. Res., 52:247-261, 1988.
Müller, Pomorski, Müller, Zachowski, Herrmann, "Protein-dependent translocation of
aminophospholipids and asymmetric transbilayer distribution of phospholipids in the
plasma membrane of ram sperm cells," Biochemistry, 33:9968-9974, 1994.
Munro, "Endothelial-leukocyte adhesive interactions in inflammatory diseases," European. Heart Journal, 14:72-77, 1993.
Murphy, Joseph, Stephens, Horrocks, "Phospholipid composition of cultured human endothelial
cells," Lipids, 27(s):150-153, 1992.
Murray, Clauss, Thurston, Stern, "Tumour-derived factors which induce endothelial
tissue factor and enhance the procoagulant response to TNF," Int. J. Radial. Biol., 60(1-2):273-277, 1991.
Nagler, Feferman. Shoshan, "Reduction in basic fibroblast growth factor mediated angiogenesis
in vivo by linomide," Connect Tissue Res., 37(1-2):61-68, 1998.
Nakamura, Shidara, Kawaguchi, Azuma, Mitsuda, Onishi. Yamaji, Wada, "Lupus anticoagulant
autoantibody induces apoptosis in umbilical vein endothelail cells: involvement of
annexin V," Biocehm. Biophys. Res. Comm., 205(2):1488-1493, 1994.
Nakamura, Ban, Yamaji, Yoneda, Wada, "Localization of the apoptosis-inducing activity,of
lupus anticoagulant in an annexin V-binding antibody subset," J. Clin. Invest., 101(9):1951-1959, 1998.
Nakanishi, Ohkubo, Nawa, Kitamura, Kageyama, Ujihara, "Angiotensinogen and kininogen:
closing and sequence analysis of the cDNAs," Clin. Exp. Hypertens., 5(7-8):997-1003, 1983.
Nawroth and Stem, "Modulation of endothelial cell hemostatic properties,by tumor necrosis
factor," J. Exp. Med., 163:740-745, 1986.
Nawroth, Stern, Kisiel, Bach, "Cellular requirements for tissue factor generation
by bovine aortic endothelial cells in culture," Thromb. Res., 40:677-691, 1985.
Nawroth, Handley, Matsueda, DeWaal, Gerlach, Blohm, Stern, "Tumor necrosis factor/cachectin-induced
intravascular fibrin formation in meth A fibrosarcomas," J. Exp. Med., 168:637-647, 1988.
Obringer, Rote, Walter, "Antiphospholipid antibody binding to bilayer-coated glass
microspheres," J. Immun. Methods, 185:81-93, 1995.
Ogawa, Shreeniwas, Brett, Clauss, Furie, Stem, "The effect of hypoxia on capillary
endothelial cell function: modulation of barrier and coagulant function," J. Haematology, 75:517-524; 1990.
Ohizumi, Tsunoda, Taniguchi, Saito, Esaki, Makimoto, Wakai, Tsutsumi, Nakagawa, Utoguchi,
Kaiho, Ohsugi, Mayumi, "Antibody-based therapy targeting tumor vascular endothelial
cells suppresses solid tumor growth in rats." Biochem. Biophys. Res. Comm., 236:493-496, 1997.
Oikawa et al., "A highly potent antiangiogenic activity of retinoids," Cancer Lett., 48(2):157-162, 1989.
O'Reilly et al., "Angiostatin: a novel angiogenesis inhibitor that mediates the suppression of metastases
by a Lewis lung carcinoma," Cell, 79:315-328, 1994.
O'Reilly et al., "Endostatin: an endogenous inhibitor of angiogenesis and tumor growth." Cell. 88(2):277-285, 1997.
Ortel, Devore-Carter, Quinn-Allen, Kane. "Deletion analysis of recombinant human factor
V. Evidence for a phosphatidylserine binding site in the second C-type domain," J. Biol. Chem., 267:4189-4198, 1992.
Papapetropoulos, Garcia-Cardena, Dengler, Maisonpierre, Yancopoulos, Sessa. "Direct
actions of angiopoietin-1 on human endothelium: evidence for network stabilization,
cell survival, and interaction with other angiogenic growth factors", Lab. Invest., 79(2):213-23, 1999.
Parmley and Smith, "Antibody-selectable filamentous fd phage vectors: affinity purification
of target genes." Gene, 73(2):305-318, 1988.
Patey, Vazeux, Canioni, Potter, Gallatin, Brousse, "Intercellular adhesion molecule-3
on endothelial cells: Expression in tumors but not in inflammatory responses." Am. J. Pathol., 148:465-472, 1996.
Pepper et al., "Leukemia inhibitory factor (LIF) inhibits angiogenesis in vitro," J. Cell Sci., 108(Pt 1):73-83, 1995.
Perry, Hall, Bell, Jones, "Sequence analysis of a mammalian phospholipid-binding protein
from testis and epididymis and its distribution between spermatozoa and extracellular
secretions," Biochem. J., 301(Pt 1):235-242, 1994.
Qamar, Gharavi, Levy, Lockshin, "Lysophosphatidylethanolamine is the antigen to which
apparent antibody to phosphatidylethanolamine binds," J. Clin. Immunol., 10(4):200-203, 1990.
Qu, Conroy, Walker, Wooding, Lucy, "Phosphatidylserine-mediated adhesion of T-cells
to endothelial cells," J. Biochem., 317(Pt 2):343-346, 1996.
Quinn et al., CM101, a polysaccharide antitumor agent, does not inhibit wound healing in murine
models," J. Cancer Res. Clin. Oncol., 121(4):253-256, 1995.
Rao, Tait, Hoang, "Binding of annexin V to a human ovarian carcinoma cell line (OC-2008).
Contrasting effects on cell surface factor VIIa/tissue factor activity and prothrombinase
activity," Thromb. Res., 67(5):517-531, 1992.
Rauch and Janoff, "Phospholipid in the hexagonal II phase is immunogenic: evidence
for immunorecognition of nonbilayer lipid phases in vivo," Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci., USA, 87(11):4112-4114, 1990.
Rauch, Tannenbaum, Tannenbaum, Ramelson, Cullis. Tilcock, Hope, Janoff, "Human hybridoma
lupus anticoagulants distinguish between lamellar and hexagonal phase lipid systems,"
J. Biol. Chem., 261(21)9672-9677, 1986.
Ravanat, Archipoff, Beretz, Freund, Cazenave, Freyssinet, "Use of annexin-V to demonstrate
the role of phosphatidylserine exposure in the maintenance of hemostatic balance by
endothelial cells," Biochem. J., 282:7-13, 1992.
RayChaudhury and D'Amore, "Endothelial cell regulation by transforming growth factor-beta,"
J. Cell Biochem., 47(3):224-229, 1991.
Richer and Lo, "Introduction of human DNA into mouse eggs by injection of dissected
human chromosome fragments", Science 245, 175-177, 1989.
Riechmann, Clark, Waldmann, Winter, "Reshaping human antibodies for therapy," Nature, 332(6162):323-327, 1988.
Rote, "Antiphospholipid antibodies and recurrent pregnancy loss," Am. J. Reprod. Immun., 35:394-401, 1996.
Rote, Ng, Dostal-Johnson, Nicholson, Siekman, "Immunologic detection of phosphatidylserine
externalization during thrombin-induced platelet activation," Clin. Immunol. Immunopathol., 66:193-200, 1993.
Rote, Chang, Katsuragawa, Ng, Lyden, Mori, "Expression of phosphatidylserine-dependent
antigens on the surface of differentiating BeWo human choriocarcinoma cells," Am. J. Reprod Immun., 33:114-121, 1995.
Ruf and Edgington, "Structural biology of tissue factor, the initiator of thrombogenesis
in vivo," FASEB J., 8:385-390, 1994.
Ruf, Rehemtulla, Edgington, "Phospholipid-independent and -dependent interactions
required for tissue factor receptor and cofactor function," Biol. Chem., 266:2158-2166, 1991.
Sakamoto et al., "Heparin plus cortisone acetate inhibit tumor growth by blocking endothelial cell
proliferation," Canc. J., 1:55-58, 1986.
Sambrook, Fritsch, Maniatis, Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual, 2nd Ed., Cold Spring Harbor Press, Cold Spring Harbor, NY, 1989.
Sang, "Complex role of matrix metalloproteinases in angiogenesis," Cell Res., 8(3):171-177, 1998.
Schick, "The organization of aminophospholipids in human platelet membranes: selective
changes induced by thrombin". J. Lab. Clin. Med., 91(5):802-810, 1978.
Schick, Kurica, Chacko, "Location of phosphatidylethanolamine and phosphatidylserine
in the human platelet plasma membrane," J. Clin. Invest., 57:1221-1226, 1976.
Schoentgen, Saccoccio, Jolles, Bernier, Jolles. "Complete amino acid sequence of a
basic 21-kDa protein from bovine brain cytosol," Eur. J. Biochem., 166(2):333-338, 1987.
Schorer, Rick, Swaim, Moldow, "Structural features of endotoxin required for stimulation
of endothelial cell tissue factor production; exposure of preformed tissue factor
after oxidant-mediated endothelial cell injury," J. Lab. Clin. Med., 106:38-42, 1985.
Schuurmans Stekhoven, Tijmes, Umeda, Inoue, De Pont, "Monoclonal antibody to phosphatidylserine
inhibits Na-/K--ATPase activity," Biochimica et Biophysica Acta, 1194:155-165, 1994.
Sheibani and Frazier, "Thrombospondin 1 expression in transformed endothelial cells
restores a normal phenotype and suppresses their tumorigenesis," Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 92(15):6788-6792, 1995.
Sheu et al., "Inhibition of angiogenesis in vitro and in vivo: comparison of the relative activities
of triflavin, an Arg-Gly-Asp-containing peptide and anti-alpha(v)beta3 integrin monoclonal
antibody," Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 1336(3):445-454, 1997.
Shyu, Manor, Magner, Yancopoulos, Isner, "Direct intramuscular injection of plasmid
DNA encoding angiopoietin-1 but not angiopoietin-2 augments revascularization in the
rabbit ischemic hindlimb", Circulation, 98(19):2081-7, 1998.
Sideras, Mizuta, Kanamori, Suzuki, Okamoto, Kuze, Ohno, Doi, Fukuhara, Hassan, et al., "Production of sterile transcripts of C gamma genes in an IgM-producing human neoplastic
B cell line that switches to IgG-producing cells," Intl. Immunol., 1(6):631-642, 1989.
Sipos et al., "Inhibition of tumor angiogenesis," Ann. NY Acad. Sci., 732:263-272, 1994.
Sluiter, Pietersma, Lamers, Koster, "Leukocyte adhesion molecules on the vascular
endothelium: their role in the pathogenesis of cardiovascular disease and the mechanisms
underlying their expression," J. Cardiol. Pharmacol., 22:S37-S44, 1993.
Smimov, Triplett, Comp, Esmon, Esmon, "On the role of phosphatidylethanolamine in
the inhibition of activated protein C activity by antiphospholipid antibodies," J. Clin. Invest., 95(1):309-316, 1995.
Soff et al., "Expression of plasminogen activator inhibitor type 1 by human prostate carcinoma
cells inhibits primary tumor growth, tumor-associated angiogenesis, and metastasis
to lung and liver in an athymic mouse model," J. Clin. Invest.. 96(6):2593-2600, 1995.
Staal-van den Brekel, Thunnissen, Buurman, Wouters, "Expression of E-selectin, intercellular
adhesion molecule (ICAM)-1 and vascular cell adhesion molecule (VCAM)-1 in non-small-cell
lung carcinoma." Virchows Arch., 428:21-27, 1996.
Staub, Harris, Khamashta, Savidge, Chahade, Hughes, "Antibody to phosphatidylethanolamine
in a patient with lupus anticoagulant and thrombosis." Ann. Rheum. Dis., 48(2):166-169, 1989.
Stone, Ruf, Miles, Edgington, Wright, "Recombinant soluble human tissue factor secreted
by Saccharomyces cerevisiae and refolded from E. coli inclusion bodies: glycosylation of mutants, activity, and physical characterization,"
Biochem. J., 310(2):605-614, 1995.
Stout, Basse, Luhm, Weiss, Wiedmer, Sims, "Scott syndrome erythrocytes contain a membrane
protein capable of mediating Ca2--dependent transbilayer migration of membrane phospholipids," J. Clin. Invest., 99(9):2232-2238, 1997.
Stratmann, Risau, Plate, "Cell type-specific expression of angiopoietin-1 and angiopoietin-2
suggests a role in glioblastoma angiogenesis", Am. J. Pathol., 153(5):1333-9, 1998.
Sugi and McIntyre, "Autoantibodies to phosphatidylethanolamine (PE) recognize a kininogen-PE
complex, " Blood, 86(8):3083-3089, 1995.
Sugi and Mclntyre, "Phosphatidylethanolamine induces specific conformational changes
in the kininogens recognizable by antiphosphatidylethanolamine antibodies," Thromb. Haemost., 76(3):354-360; 1996a.
Sugi and McIntyre, "Autoantibodies to kininogen- phosphatidylethanolamine complexes
augment thrombin-induced platelet aggregation," Thromb. Res., 84(2):97-109, 1996b.
Sugimura, Donato, Kakar, Scully, "Annexin V as a probe of the contribution of anionic
phospholipids to the procoagulant activity of tumor cell surfaces," Blood Coagul. Fibrinolysis, 5(3):365-373, 1994.
Tada et al., "Inhibition of tubular morphogenesis in human microvascular endothelial cells by
co-culture with chondrocytes and involvement of transforming growth factor beta: a
model for avascularity in human cartilage," Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 1201(2):135-142, 1994.
Takano et al., "Suramin, an anticancer and angiosuppressive agent, inhibits endothelial cell binding
of basic fibroblast growth factor, migration, proliferation, and induction of urokinase-type
plasminogen activator," Cancer Res., 54(10):2654-2660, 1994.
Tanaka et al., "Viral vector-mediated transduction of a modified platelet factor 4 cDNA inhibits
angiogenesis and tumor growth," Nat. Med., 3(4):437-442, 1997.
Tanaka, Mori, Sakamoto, Makuuchi, Sugimachi, Wands, "Biologic significance of angiopoietin
-2 expression in human hepatocellular carcinoma", J. Clin. Invest., 103(3):341-5, 1999.
Thornhill, Kyan-Aung, Haskard, "IL-4 increases human endothelial cell adhesiveness
for T cells but not for neutrophils," J. Immunol., 144:3060-3065, 1990.
Thorpe et al., "Heparin-Steroid Conjugates: New Angiogenesis Inhibitors with Antitumor Activity
in Mice," Cancer Res., 53:3000-3007, 1993.
Tolsma et al., "Peptides derived from two separate domains of the matrix protein thrombospondin-1
have anti-angiogenic activity," J. Cell Biol., 122(2):497-511, 1993.
Toti, Satta, Fressinaud, Meyer, Freyssinet, "Scott syndrome, characterized by impaired
transmembrane migration of procoagulant phosphatidylserine and hemorrhagic complications,
is an inherited disorder," Blood, 87(4):1409-1415, 1996.
Trudell, Ardies, Anderson, "Antibodies raised against trifluoroacetyl-protein adducts
bind to N-trifluoroacetyl-phosphatidylethanolamine in hexagonal phase phospholipid
micelles." J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther., 257(2):657-662, 1991a.
Trudell, Ardies, Green, Allen, "Binding of anti-acetaldehyde IgG antibodies to hepatocytes
with an acetaldehyde-phosphatidylethanolamine adduct on their surface," Alcohol Clin. Exp. Res., 15(2):295-299, 1991b.
Tryggvason, "The laminin family," Curr. Opin. Cell Biol., 5(5):877-882, 1993.
Umeda, Igarashi, Nam. Inoue, "Effective production of monoclonal antibodies against
phosphatidylserine: Stereo-specific recognition of phosphatidylserine by monoclonal
antibody," J. Immun., 143(7):2273-2279, 1989.
Utsugi, Schroit, Connor, Bucana, Fidler, "Elevated expression of phosphatidylserine
in the outer membrane leaflet of human tumor cells and recognition by activated human
blood monocytes," Cancer Res., 51(11):3062-3066, 1991.
Valenzuela, Griffiths, Rojas, Aldrich, Jones, Zhou, McClain, Copeland, Gilbert, Jenkins,
Huang, Papadopoulos, Maisonpierre, Davis, Yancopoulos. "Angiopoietins 3 and 4: diverging
gene counterparts in mice and humans", Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci., USA, 96(5):1904-9, 1999.
van Dijk, Warnaar, van Eendenburg, Thienpont, Braakman, Boot, Fleuren, Bolhuis, "Induction
of tumor-cell lysis by bi-specific monoclonal antibodies recognizing renal-cell carcinoma
and CD3 antigen," Int. J. Cancer, 43:344-349, 1989.
Van Heerde, Poort, van T Veer. Reutelingsperger, de Groot, "Binding of recombinant
annexin V to endothelial cells: effect of annexin V binding on endothelial-cell-mediated
thrombin formation," J. Biochem., 302:305-312, 1994.
Vermes, Haanes, Steffens-Nakken, Reutelingsperger, "A novel assay for apoptosis. Flow
cytometric detection of phosphatidylserine expression on early apoptotic cells using
fluorescein labeled Annexin V," J. Immunol. Methods, 184(1):39-51, 1995.
Vitetta et al., "Phase I immunotoxin trial in patients with B-cell lymphoma," Cancer Res., 15:4052-4058, 1991.
Vlachoyiannopoulos, Beigbeder, Duelanes, Youinou, Hunt, Krilis, Moutsopoulos, "Antibodies
to phosphatidylethanolamine in antiphospholipid syndrome and systemic lupus erythematosus:
their correlation with anticardiolipin antibodies and beta 2 glycoprotein-I plasma
levels," Autoimmunity, 16(4):245-249, 1993,
Vogt, Ng, Rote, "A model for the antiphospholipid antibody syndrome: Monoclonal antiphosphatidylserine
antibody induces intrauterine growth restriction in mice," Am. J. Obstet. Gynecol., 174:700-707, 1996.
Vogt, Ng, Rote, "Antiphosphatidylserine antibody removes Annexin V and facilitates
the binding prothrombin at the surface of a choriocarcinoma model of trophoblast differentiation,"
Am. J. Obstet. Gynecol., 177:964-972, 1997.
Volpert, Lawler, Bouck, "A human fibrosarcoma inhibits systemic angiogenesis and the
growth of experimental metastases via thrombospondin-1," Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 96(11):6343-6348, 1998.
Vukanovic et al., "Antiangiogenic effects of the quinoline-3-carboxamide linomide," Cancer Res., 53(8):1833-1837, 1993.
Waltenberger et al., "Suramin is a potent inhibitor of vascular endothelial growth factor. A contribution
to the molecular basis of its antiangiogenic action." J. Mol. Cell Cardiol., 28(7):1523-1529, 1996.
Wamil et al., "Soluble E-selectin in cancer patients as a marker of the therapeutic efficacy
of CM101, a tumor-inhibiting anti-neovascularization agent. evaluated in phase I clinical
trail," J. Cancer Res. Clin. Oncol., 123(3):173-179, 1997.
Wells, "Starving cancer into submission", Chem. Biol., 5(4):R87-88, 1998.
Weiss, Young, LoBuglio, Slivka and Nimeh, "Role of Hydrogen Peroxide in Neutrophil-Mediated
Destruction of Cultured Endothelial Cells, " J. Clin. Invest., 68:714-721, 1981.
White, Handler, Smith, Hill, Lehman, In: Principles of Biochemistry, 6th Edition, McGraw-Hill, Inc. N.Y., Chapter 3, pp. 48-54, 1978.
Williamson and Schlegel, "Back and forth: the regulation and function of transbilayer
phospholipid movement in eukaryotic cells," Molec. Mem. Biol., 11:199-216, 1994.
Winter and Milstein, "Man-made antibodies,"Nature, 349:293-299, 1991.
Wolff et al., "Dexamethasone inhibits glioma-induced formation of capillary like structures in vitro and angiogenesis in vivo," Klin. Padiatr., 209(4):275-277, 1997.
Yamada, Moldow, Sacks, Craddock, Boogaens and Jacob, "Deleterious Effects of Endotoxin
on Cultured Endothelial Cells: An in vitro Model of Vascular injury," Inflammation, 5:115-116, 1981.
Yamamura et al., "Effect of Matrigel and laminin peptide YIGSR on tumor growth and metastasis," Semin. Cancer Biol., 4(4):259-265, 1993.
Yoon et al., "Inhibitory effect of Korean mistletoe (Viscum album coloratum) extract on tumour
angiogenesis and metastasis of haematogenous and non-haematogenous tumour cells in
mice," Cancer Lett, 97(1):83-91, 1995.
Yoshida et al., "Suppression of hepatoma growth and angiogenesis by a fumagillin derivative TNP470:
possible involvement of nitric oxide synthase," Cancer Res., 58(16):3751-3756, 1998.
Zacharski, Memoli, Ornstein, Rousseau, Kisiel, Kudryk, "Tumor cell procoagulant and
urokinase expression in carcinoma of the ovary," J. Natl. Cancer Inst., 85:1225-1230, 1993.
Zhao, Zhou, Wiedmer, Sims, "Level of expression of phospholipid scramblase regulates
induced movement of phosphatidylserine to the cell surface," J. Biol. Chem., 273:6603-6606, 1998.
Zhou, Zhao, Stout, Luhm, Wiedmer, Sims, "Molecular cloning of human plasma membrane
phospholipid scramblase. A protein mediating transbilayer movement of plasma membrane
phospholipids," J. Biol. Chem., 272(29):18240-18244, 1997.
Ziche et al., "Linomide blocks angiogenesis by breast carcinoma vascular endothelial growth factor
transfectants," Br. J. Cancer, 77(7):1123-1129, 1998.
Zwaal, Bevers, Comfurius, Rosing, Tilly, Verhallen, "Loss of membrane phospholipid
asymmetry during activation of blood platelets and sickled red cells; mechanisms and
physiological significance," Mol. Cell. Biochem., 91:23-31, 1989.
Zwaal, Comfurius, Bevers, "Platelet procoagulant activity and microvesicle formation.
Its putative role in hemostasis and thrombosis," Biochimica et Biophysica Acta, 1180:1-8, 1992.
SEQUENCE LISTING
[0673]
<110> THORPE, PHILIP E. RAN, SOPHIA
<120> CANCER TREATMENT USING THERAPEUTIC CONJUGATES THAT BIND TO AMINOPHOSPHOLIPIDS
<130> 4001.002310
<140> UNKNOWN
<141> 1999-07-12
<160> 5
<170> Patent In Ver. 2.0
<210> 1
<211> 2149
<212> DNA
<213> Homo sapiens
<400> 1


<210> 2
<211> 498
<212> PRT
<213> Homo sapiens
<400> 2


<210> 3
<211> 2269
<212> DNA
<213> Homo sapiens
<400> 3

<210> 4
<211> 496
<212> PRT
<213> Homo sapiens
<400> 4



<210> 5
<211> 495
<212> PRT
<213> Homo sapiens
<400> 5


